vscode/src/vscode-dts/vscode.d.ts

14569 lines
497 KiB
TypeScript
Raw Blame History

This file contains invisible Unicode characters

This file contains invisible Unicode characters that are indistinguishable to humans but may be processed differently by a computer. If you think that this is intentional, you can safely ignore this warning. Use the Escape button to reveal them.

/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
* Copyright (c) Microsoft Corporation. All rights reserved.
* Licensed under the MIT License. See License.txt in the project root for license information.
*--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/
declare module 'vscode' {
/**
* The version of the editor.
*/
export const version: string;
/**
* Represents a reference to a command. Provides a title which
* will be used to represent a command in the UI and, optionally,
* an array of arguments which will be passed to the command handler
* function when invoked.
*/
export interface Command {
/**
* Title of the command, like `save`.
*/
title: string;
/**
* The identifier of the actual command handler.
* @see {@link commands.registerCommand}
*/
command: string;
/**
* A tooltip for the command, when represented in the UI.
*/
tooltip?: string;
/**
* Arguments that the command handler should be
* invoked with.
*/
arguments?: any[];
}
/**
* Represents a line of text, such as a line of source code.
*
* TextLine objects are __immutable__. When a {@link TextDocument document} changes,
* previously retrieved lines will not represent the latest state.
*/
export interface TextLine {
/**
* The zero-based line number.
*/
readonly lineNumber: number;
/**
* The text of this line without the line separator characters.
*/
readonly text: string;
/**
* The range this line covers without the line separator characters.
*/
readonly range: Range;
/**
* The range this line covers with the line separator characters.
*/
readonly rangeIncludingLineBreak: Range;
/**
* The offset of the first character which is not a whitespace character as defined
* by `/\s/`. **Note** that if a line is all whitespace the length of the line is returned.
*/
readonly firstNonWhitespaceCharacterIndex: number;
/**
* Whether this line is whitespace only, shorthand
* for {@link TextLine.firstNonWhitespaceCharacterIndex} === {@link TextLine.text TextLine.text.length}.
*/
readonly isEmptyOrWhitespace: boolean;
}
/**
* Represents a text document, such as a source file. Text documents have
* {@link TextLine lines} and knowledge about an underlying resource like a file.
*/
export interface TextDocument {
/**
* The associated uri for this document.
*
* *Note* that most documents use the `file`-scheme, which means they are files on disk. However, **not** all documents are
* saved on disk and therefore the `scheme` must be checked before trying to access the underlying file or siblings on disk.
*
* @see {@link FileSystemProvider}
* @see {@link TextDocumentContentProvider}
*/
readonly uri: Uri;
/**
* The file system path of the associated resource. Shorthand
* notation for {@link TextDocument.uri TextDocument.uri.fsPath}. Independent of the uri scheme.
*/
readonly fileName: string;
/**
* Is this document representing an untitled file which has never been saved yet. *Note* that
* this does not mean the document will be saved to disk, use {@linkcode Uri.scheme}
* to figure out where a document will be {@link FileSystemProvider saved}, e.g. `file`, `ftp` etc.
*/
readonly isUntitled: boolean;
/**
* The identifier of the language associated with this document.
*/
readonly languageId: string;
/**
* The version number of this document (it will strictly increase after each
* change, including undo/redo).
*/
readonly version: number;
/**
* `true` if there are unpersisted changes.
*/
readonly isDirty: boolean;
/**
* `true` if the document has been closed. A closed document isn't synchronized anymore
* and won't be re-used when the same resource is opened again.
*/
readonly isClosed: boolean;
/**
* Save the underlying file.
*
* @return A promise that will resolve to true when the file
* has been saved. If the file was not dirty or the save failed,
* will return false.
*/
save(): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* The {@link EndOfLine end of line} sequence that is predominately
* used in this document.
*/
readonly eol: EndOfLine;
/**
* The number of lines in this document.
*/
readonly lineCount: number;
/**
* Returns a text line denoted by the line number. Note
* that the returned object is *not* live and changes to the
* document are not reflected.
*
* @param line A line number in [0, lineCount).
* @return A {@link TextLine line}.
*/
lineAt(line: number): TextLine;
/**
* Returns a text line denoted by the position. Note
* that the returned object is *not* live and changes to the
* document are not reflected.
*
* The position will be {@link TextDocument.validatePosition adjusted}.
*
* @see {@link TextDocument.lineAt}
*
* @param position A position.
* @return A {@link TextLine line}.
*/
lineAt(position: Position): TextLine;
/**
* Converts the position to a zero-based offset.
*
* The position will be {@link TextDocument.validatePosition adjusted}.
*
* @param position A position.
* @return A valid zero-based offset.
*/
offsetAt(position: Position): number;
/**
* Converts a zero-based offset to a position.
*
* @param offset A zero-based offset.
* @return A valid {@link Position}.
*/
positionAt(offset: number): Position;
/**
* Get the text of this document. A substring can be retrieved by providing
* a range. The range will be {@link TextDocument.validateRange adjusted}.
*
* @param range Include only the text included by the range.
* @return The text inside the provided range or the entire text.
*/
getText(range?: Range): string;
/**
* Get a word-range at the given position. By default words are defined by
* common separators, like space, -, _, etc. In addition, per language custom
* [word definitions} can be defined. It
* is also possible to provide a custom regular expression.
*
* * *Note 1:* A custom regular expression must not match the empty string and
* if it does, it will be ignored.
* * *Note 2:* A custom regular expression will fail to match multiline strings
* and in the name of speed regular expressions should not match words with
* spaces. Use {@linkcode TextLine.text} for more complex, non-wordy, scenarios.
*
* The position will be {@link TextDocument.validatePosition adjusted}.
*
* @param position A position.
* @param regex Optional regular expression that describes what a word is.
* @return A range spanning a word, or `undefined`.
*/
getWordRangeAtPosition(position: Position, regex?: RegExp): Range | undefined;
/**
* Ensure a range is completely contained in this document.
*
* @param range A range.
* @return The given range or a new, adjusted range.
*/
validateRange(range: Range): Range;
/**
* Ensure a position is contained in the range of this document.
*
* @param position A position.
* @return The given position or a new, adjusted position.
*/
validatePosition(position: Position): Position;
}
/**
* Represents a line and character position, such as
* the position of the cursor.
*
* Position objects are __immutable__. Use the {@link Position.with with} or
* {@link Position.translate translate} methods to derive new positions
* from an existing position.
*/
export class Position {
/**
* The zero-based line value.
*/
readonly line: number;
/**
* The zero-based character value.
*/
readonly character: number;
/**
* @param line A zero-based line value.
* @param character A zero-based character value.
*/
constructor(line: number, character: number);
/**
* Check if this position is before `other`.
*
* @param other A position.
* @return `true` if position is on a smaller line
* or on the same line on a smaller character.
*/
isBefore(other: Position): boolean;
/**
* Check if this position is before or equal to `other`.
*
* @param other A position.
* @return `true` if position is on a smaller line
* or on the same line on a smaller or equal character.
*/
isBeforeOrEqual(other: Position): boolean;
/**
* Check if this position is after `other`.
*
* @param other A position.
* @return `true` if position is on a greater line
* or on the same line on a greater character.
*/
isAfter(other: Position): boolean;
/**
* Check if this position is after or equal to `other`.
*
* @param other A position.
* @return `true` if position is on a greater line
* or on the same line on a greater or equal character.
*/
isAfterOrEqual(other: Position): boolean;
/**
* Check if this position is equal to `other`.
*
* @param other A position.
* @return `true` if the line and character of the given position are equal to
* the line and character of this position.
*/
isEqual(other: Position): boolean;
/**
* Compare this to `other`.
*
* @param other A position.
* @return A number smaller than zero if this position is before the given position,
* a number greater than zero if this position is after the given position, or zero when
* this and the given position are equal.
*/
compareTo(other: Position): number;
/**
* Create a new position relative to this position.
*
* @param lineDelta Delta value for the line value, default is `0`.
* @param characterDelta Delta value for the character value, default is `0`.
* @return A position which line and character is the sum of the current line and
* character and the corresponding deltas.
*/
translate(lineDelta?: number, characterDelta?: number): Position;
/**
* Derived a new position relative to this position.
*
* @param change An object that describes a delta to this position.
* @return A position that reflects the given delta. Will return `this` position if the change
* is not changing anything.
*/
translate(change: { lineDelta?: number; characterDelta?: number; }): Position;
/**
* Create a new position derived from this position.
*
* @param line Value that should be used as line value, default is the {@link Position.line existing value}
* @param character Value that should be used as character value, default is the {@link Position.character existing value}
* @return A position where line and character are replaced by the given values.
*/
with(line?: number, character?: number): Position;
/**
* Derived a new position from this position.
*
* @param change An object that describes a change to this position.
* @return A position that reflects the given change. Will return `this` position if the change
* is not changing anything.
*/
with(change: { line?: number; character?: number; }): Position;
}
/**
* A range represents an ordered pair of two positions.
* It is guaranteed that {@link Range.start start}.isBeforeOrEqual({@link Range.end end})
*
* Range objects are __immutable__. Use the {@link Range.with with},
* {@link Range.intersection intersection}, or {@link Range.union union} methods
* to derive new ranges from an existing range.
*/
export class Range {
/**
* The start position. It is before or equal to {@link Range.end end}.
*/
readonly start: Position;
/**
* The end position. It is after or equal to {@link Range.start start}.
*/
readonly end: Position;
/**
* Create a new range from two positions. If `start` is not
* before or equal to `end`, the values will be swapped.
*
* @param start A position.
* @param end A position.
*/
constructor(start: Position, end: Position);
/**
* Create a new range from number coordinates. It is a shorter equivalent of
* using `new Range(new Position(startLine, startCharacter), new Position(endLine, endCharacter))`
*
* @param startLine A zero-based line value.
* @param startCharacter A zero-based character value.
* @param endLine A zero-based line value.
* @param endCharacter A zero-based character value.
*/
constructor(startLine: number, startCharacter: number, endLine: number, endCharacter: number);
/**
* `true` if `start` and `end` are equal.
*/
isEmpty: boolean;
/**
* `true` if `start.line` and `end.line` are equal.
*/
isSingleLine: boolean;
/**
* Check if a position or a range is contained in this range.
*
* @param positionOrRange A position or a range.
* @return `true` if the position or range is inside or equal
* to this range.
*/
contains(positionOrRange: Position | Range): boolean;
/**
* Check if `other` equals this range.
*
* @param other A range.
* @return `true` when start and end are {@link Position.isEqual equal} to
* start and end of this range.
*/
isEqual(other: Range): boolean;
/**
* Intersect `range` with this range and returns a new range or `undefined`
* if the ranges have no overlap.
*
* @param range A range.
* @return A range of the greater start and smaller end positions. Will
* return undefined when there is no overlap.
*/
intersection(range: Range): Range | undefined;
/**
* Compute the union of `other` with this range.
*
* @param other A range.
* @return A range of smaller start position and the greater end position.
*/
union(other: Range): Range;
/**
* Derived a new range from this range.
*
* @param start A position that should be used as start. The default value is the {@link Range.start current start}.
* @param end A position that should be used as end. The default value is the {@link Range.end current end}.
* @return A range derived from this range with the given start and end position.
* If start and end are not different `this` range will be returned.
*/
with(start?: Position, end?: Position): Range;
/**
* Derived a new range from this range.
*
* @param change An object that describes a change to this range.
* @return A range that reflects the given change. Will return `this` range if the change
* is not changing anything.
*/
with(change: { start?: Position, end?: Position }): Range;
}
/**
* Represents a text selection in an editor.
*/
export class Selection extends Range {
/**
* The position at which the selection starts.
* This position might be before or after {@link Selection.active active}.
*/
anchor: Position;
/**
* The position of the cursor.
* This position might be before or after {@link Selection.anchor anchor}.
*/
active: Position;
/**
* Create a selection from two positions.
*
* @param anchor A position.
* @param active A position.
*/
constructor(anchor: Position, active: Position);
/**
* Create a selection from four coordinates.
*
* @param anchorLine A zero-based line value.
* @param anchorCharacter A zero-based character value.
* @param activeLine A zero-based line value.
* @param activeCharacter A zero-based character value.
*/
constructor(anchorLine: number, anchorCharacter: number, activeLine: number, activeCharacter: number);
/**
* A selection is reversed if its {@link Selection.anchor anchor} is the {@link Selection.end end} position.
*/
isReversed: boolean;
}
/**
* Represents sources that can cause {@link window.onDidChangeTextEditorSelection selection change events}.
*/
export enum TextEditorSelectionChangeKind {
/**
* Selection changed due to typing in the editor.
*/
Keyboard = 1,
/**
* Selection change due to clicking in the editor.
*/
Mouse = 2,
/**
* Selection changed because a command ran.
*/
Command = 3
}
/**
* Represents an event describing the change in a {@link TextEditor.selections text editor's selections}.
*/
export interface TextEditorSelectionChangeEvent {
/**
* The {@link TextEditor text editor} for which the selections have changed.
*/
readonly textEditor: TextEditor;
/**
* The new value for the {@link TextEditor.selections text editor's selections}.
*/
readonly selections: readonly Selection[];
/**
* The {@link TextEditorSelectionChangeKind change kind} which has triggered this
* event. Can be `undefined`.
*/
readonly kind: TextEditorSelectionChangeKind | undefined;
}
/**
* Represents an event describing the change in a {@link TextEditor.visibleRanges text editor's visible ranges}.
*/
export interface TextEditorVisibleRangesChangeEvent {
/**
* The {@link TextEditor text editor} for which the visible ranges have changed.
*/
readonly textEditor: TextEditor;
/**
* The new value for the {@link TextEditor.visibleRanges text editor's visible ranges}.
*/
readonly visibleRanges: readonly Range[];
}
/**
* Represents an event describing the change in a {@link TextEditor.options text editor's options}.
*/
export interface TextEditorOptionsChangeEvent {
/**
* The {@link TextEditor text editor} for which the options have changed.
*/
readonly textEditor: TextEditor;
/**
* The new value for the {@link TextEditor.options text editor's options}.
*/
readonly options: TextEditorOptions;
}
/**
* Represents an event describing the change of a {@link TextEditor.viewColumn text editor's view column}.
*/
export interface TextEditorViewColumnChangeEvent {
/**
* The {@link TextEditor text editor} for which the view column has changed.
*/
readonly textEditor: TextEditor;
/**
* The new value for the {@link TextEditor.viewColumn text editor's view column}.
*/
readonly viewColumn: ViewColumn;
}
/**
* Rendering style of the cursor.
*/
export enum TextEditorCursorStyle {
/**
* Render the cursor as a vertical thick line.
*/
Line = 1,
/**
* Render the cursor as a block filled.
*/
Block = 2,
/**
* Render the cursor as a thick horizontal line.
*/
Underline = 3,
/**
* Render the cursor as a vertical thin line.
*/
LineThin = 4,
/**
* Render the cursor as a block outlined.
*/
BlockOutline = 5,
/**
* Render the cursor as a thin horizontal line.
*/
UnderlineThin = 6
}
/**
* Rendering style of the line numbers.
*/
export enum TextEditorLineNumbersStyle {
/**
* Do not render the line numbers.
*/
Off = 0,
/**
* Render the line numbers.
*/
On = 1,
/**
* Render the line numbers with values relative to the primary cursor location.
*/
Relative = 2
}
/**
* Represents a {@link TextEditor text editor}'s {@link TextEditor.options options}.
*/
export interface TextEditorOptions {
/**
* The size in spaces a tab takes. This is used for two purposes:
* - the rendering width of a tab character;
* - the number of spaces to insert when {@link TextEditorOptions.insertSpaces insertSpaces} is true.
*
* When getting a text editor's options, this property will always be a number (resolved).
* When setting a text editor's options, this property is optional and it can be a number or `"auto"`.
*/
tabSize?: number | string;
/**
* When pressing Tab insert {@link TextEditorOptions.tabSize n} spaces.
* When getting a text editor's options, this property will always be a boolean (resolved).
* When setting a text editor's options, this property is optional and it can be a boolean or `"auto"`.
*/
insertSpaces?: boolean | string;
/**
* The rendering style of the cursor in this editor.
* When getting a text editor's options, this property will always be present.
* When setting a text editor's options, this property is optional.
*/
cursorStyle?: TextEditorCursorStyle;
/**
* Render relative line numbers w.r.t. the current line number.
* When getting a text editor's options, this property will always be present.
* When setting a text editor's options, this property is optional.
*/
lineNumbers?: TextEditorLineNumbersStyle;
}
/**
* Represents a handle to a set of decorations
* sharing the same {@link DecorationRenderOptions styling options} in a {@link TextEditor text editor}.
*
* To get an instance of a `TextEditorDecorationType` use
* {@link window.createTextEditorDecorationType createTextEditorDecorationType}.
*/
export interface TextEditorDecorationType {
/**
* Internal representation of the handle.
*/
readonly key: string;
/**
* Remove this decoration type and all decorations on all text editors using it.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Represents different {@link TextEditor.revealRange reveal} strategies in a text editor.
*/
export enum TextEditorRevealType {
/**
* The range will be revealed with as little scrolling as possible.
*/
Default = 0,
/**
* The range will always be revealed in the center of the viewport.
*/
InCenter = 1,
/**
* If the range is outside the viewport, it will be revealed in the center of the viewport.
* Otherwise, it will be revealed with as little scrolling as possible.
*/
InCenterIfOutsideViewport = 2,
/**
* The range will always be revealed at the top of the viewport.
*/
AtTop = 3
}
/**
* Represents different positions for rendering a decoration in an {@link DecorationRenderOptions.overviewRulerLane overview ruler}.
* The overview ruler supports three lanes.
*/
export enum OverviewRulerLane {
Left = 1,
Center = 2,
Right = 4,
Full = 7
}
/**
* Describes the behavior of decorations when typing/editing at their edges.
*/
export enum DecorationRangeBehavior {
/**
* The decoration's range will widen when edits occur at the start or end.
*/
OpenOpen = 0,
/**
* The decoration's range will not widen when edits occur at the start of end.
*/
ClosedClosed = 1,
/**
* The decoration's range will widen when edits occur at the start, but not at the end.
*/
OpenClosed = 2,
/**
* The decoration's range will widen when edits occur at the end, but not at the start.
*/
ClosedOpen = 3
}
/**
* Represents options to configure the behavior of showing a {@link TextDocument document} in an {@link TextEditor editor}.
*/
export interface TextDocumentShowOptions {
/**
* An optional view column in which the {@link TextEditor editor} should be shown.
* The default is the {@link ViewColumn.Active active}, other values are adjusted to
* be `Min(column, columnCount + 1)`, the {@link ViewColumn.Active active}-column is
* not adjusted. Use {@linkcode ViewColumn.Beside} to open the
* editor to the side of the currently active one.
*/
viewColumn?: ViewColumn;
/**
* An optional flag that when `true` will stop the {@link TextEditor editor} from taking focus.
*/
preserveFocus?: boolean;
/**
* An optional flag that controls if an {@link TextEditor editor}-tab shows as preview. Preview tabs will
* be replaced and reused until set to stay - either explicitly or through editing. The default behaviour depends
* on the `workbench.editor.enablePreview`-setting.
*/
preview?: boolean;
/**
* An optional selection to apply for the document in the {@link TextEditor editor}.
*/
selection?: Range;
}
/**
* A reference to one of the workbench colors as defined in https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/getstarted/theme-color-reference.
* Using a theme color is preferred over a custom color as it gives theme authors and users the possibility to change the color.
*/
export class ThemeColor {
/**
* Creates a reference to a theme color.
* @param id of the color. The available colors are listed in https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/getstarted/theme-color-reference.
*/
constructor(id: string);
}
/**
* A reference to a named icon. Currently, {@link ThemeIcon.File File}, {@link ThemeIcon.Folder Folder},
* and [ThemeIcon ids](https://code.visualstudio.com/api/references/icons-in-labels#icon-listing) are supported.
* Using a theme icon is preferred over a custom icon as it gives product theme authors the possibility to change the icons.
*
* *Note* that theme icons can also be rendered inside labels and descriptions. Places that support theme icons spell this out
* and they use the `$(<name>)`-syntax, for instance `quickPick.label = "Hello World $(globe)"`.
*/
export class ThemeIcon {
/**
* Reference to an icon representing a file. The icon is taken from the current file icon theme or a placeholder icon is used.
*/
static readonly File: ThemeIcon;
/**
* Reference to an icon representing a folder. The icon is taken from the current file icon theme or a placeholder icon is used.
*/
static readonly Folder: ThemeIcon;
/**
* The id of the icon. The available icons are listed in https://code.visualstudio.com/api/references/icons-in-labels#icon-listing.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The optional ThemeColor of the icon. The color is currently only used in {@link TreeItem}.
*/
readonly color?: ThemeColor;
/**
* Creates a reference to a theme icon.
* @param id id of the icon. The available icons are listed in https://code.visualstudio.com/api/references/icons-in-labels#icon-listing.
* @param color optional `ThemeColor` for the icon. The color is currently only used in {@link TreeItem}.
*/
constructor(id: string, color?: ThemeColor);
}
/**
* Represents theme specific rendering styles for a {@link TextEditorDecorationType text editor decoration}.
*/
export interface ThemableDecorationRenderOptions {
/**
* Background color of the decoration. Use rgba() and define transparent background colors to play well with other decorations.
* Alternatively a color from the color registry can be {@link ThemeColor referenced}.
*/
backgroundColor?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
outline?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'outline' for setting one or more of the individual outline properties.
*/
outlineColor?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'outline' for setting one or more of the individual outline properties.
*/
outlineStyle?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'outline' for setting one or more of the individual outline properties.
*/
outlineWidth?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
border?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'border' for setting one or more of the individual border properties.
*/
borderColor?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'border' for setting one or more of the individual border properties.
*/
borderRadius?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'border' for setting one or more of the individual border properties.
*/
borderSpacing?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'border' for setting one or more of the individual border properties.
*/
borderStyle?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
* Better use 'border' for setting one or more of the individual border properties.
*/
borderWidth?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
fontStyle?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
fontWeight?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
textDecoration?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
cursor?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
color?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
opacity?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
letterSpacing?: string;
/**
* An **absolute path** or an URI to an image to be rendered in the gutter.
*/
gutterIconPath?: string | Uri;
/**
* Specifies the size of the gutter icon.
* Available values are 'auto', 'contain', 'cover' and any percentage value.
* For further information: https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/jj127316(v=vs.85).aspx
*/
gutterIconSize?: string;
/**
* The color of the decoration in the overview ruler. Use rgba() and define transparent colors to play well with other decorations.
*/
overviewRulerColor?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* Defines the rendering options of the attachment that is inserted before the decorated text.
*/
before?: ThemableDecorationAttachmentRenderOptions;
/**
* Defines the rendering options of the attachment that is inserted after the decorated text.
*/
after?: ThemableDecorationAttachmentRenderOptions;
}
export interface ThemableDecorationAttachmentRenderOptions {
/**
* Defines a text content that is shown in the attachment. Either an icon or a text can be shown, but not both.
*/
contentText?: string;
/**
* An **absolute path** or an URI to an image to be rendered in the attachment. Either an icon
* or a text can be shown, but not both.
*/
contentIconPath?: string | Uri;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
border?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to text enclosed by a decoration.
*/
borderColor?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
fontStyle?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
fontWeight?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
textDecoration?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
color?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
backgroundColor?: string | ThemeColor;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
margin?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
width?: string;
/**
* CSS styling property that will be applied to the decoration attachment.
*/
height?: string;
}
/**
* Represents rendering styles for a {@link TextEditorDecorationType text editor decoration}.
*/
export interface DecorationRenderOptions extends ThemableDecorationRenderOptions {
/**
* Should the decoration be rendered also on the whitespace after the line text.
* Defaults to `false`.
*/
isWholeLine?: boolean;
/**
* Customize the growing behavior of the decoration when edits occur at the edges of the decoration's range.
* Defaults to `DecorationRangeBehavior.OpenOpen`.
*/
rangeBehavior?: DecorationRangeBehavior;
/**
* The position in the overview ruler where the decoration should be rendered.
*/
overviewRulerLane?: OverviewRulerLane;
/**
* Overwrite options for light themes.
*/
light?: ThemableDecorationRenderOptions;
/**
* Overwrite options for dark themes.
*/
dark?: ThemableDecorationRenderOptions;
}
/**
* Represents options for a specific decoration in a {@link TextEditorDecorationType decoration set}.
*/
export interface DecorationOptions {
/**
* Range to which this decoration is applied. The range must not be empty.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* A message that should be rendered when hovering over the decoration.
*/
hoverMessage?: MarkdownString | MarkedString | Array<MarkdownString | MarkedString>;
/**
* Render options applied to the current decoration. For performance reasons, keep the
* number of decoration specific options small, and use decoration types wherever possible.
*/
renderOptions?: DecorationInstanceRenderOptions;
}
export interface ThemableDecorationInstanceRenderOptions {
/**
* Defines the rendering options of the attachment that is inserted before the decorated text.
*/
before?: ThemableDecorationAttachmentRenderOptions;
/**
* Defines the rendering options of the attachment that is inserted after the decorated text.
*/
after?: ThemableDecorationAttachmentRenderOptions;
}
export interface DecorationInstanceRenderOptions extends ThemableDecorationInstanceRenderOptions {
/**
* Overwrite options for light themes.
*/
light?: ThemableDecorationInstanceRenderOptions;
/**
* Overwrite options for dark themes.
*/
dark?: ThemableDecorationInstanceRenderOptions;
}
/**
* Represents an editor that is attached to a {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
export interface TextEditor {
/**
* The document associated with this text editor. The document will be the same for the entire lifetime of this text editor.
*/
readonly document: TextDocument;
/**
* The primary selection on this text editor. Shorthand for `TextEditor.selections[0]`.
*/
selection: Selection;
/**
* The selections in this text editor. The primary selection is always at index 0.
*/
selections: Selection[];
/**
* The current visible ranges in the editor (vertically).
* This accounts only for vertical scrolling, and not for horizontal scrolling.
*/
readonly visibleRanges: Range[];
/**
* Text editor options.
*/
options: TextEditorOptions;
/**
* The column in which this editor shows. Will be `undefined` in case this
* isn't one of the main editors, e.g. an embedded editor, or when the editor
* column is larger than three.
*/
readonly viewColumn: ViewColumn | undefined;
/**
* Perform an edit on the document associated with this text editor.
*
* The given callback-function is invoked with an {@link TextEditorEdit edit-builder} which must
* be used to make edits. Note that the edit-builder is only valid while the
* callback executes.
*
* @param callback A function which can create edits using an {@link TextEditorEdit edit-builder}.
* @param options The undo/redo behavior around this edit. By default, undo stops will be created before and after this edit.
* @return A promise that resolves with a value indicating if the edits could be applied.
*/
edit(callback: (editBuilder: TextEditorEdit) => void, options?: { undoStopBefore: boolean; undoStopAfter: boolean; }): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* Insert a {@link SnippetString snippet} and put the editor into snippet mode. "Snippet mode"
* means the editor adds placeholders and additional cursors so that the user can complete
* or accept the snippet.
*
* @param snippet The snippet to insert in this edit.
* @param location Position or range at which to insert the snippet, defaults to the current editor selection or selections.
* @param options The undo/redo behavior around this edit. By default, undo stops will be created before and after this edit.
* @return A promise that resolves with a value indicating if the snippet could be inserted. Note that the promise does not signal
* that the snippet is completely filled-in or accepted.
*/
insertSnippet(snippet: SnippetString, location?: Position | Range | readonly Position[] | readonly Range[], options?: { undoStopBefore: boolean; undoStopAfter: boolean; }): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* Adds a set of decorations to the text editor. If a set of decorations already exists with
* the given {@link TextEditorDecorationType decoration type}, they will be replaced. If
* `rangesOrOptions` is empty, the existing decorations with the given {@link TextEditorDecorationType decoration type}
* will be removed.
*
* @see {@link window.createTextEditorDecorationType createTextEditorDecorationType}.
*
* @param decorationType A decoration type.
* @param rangesOrOptions Either {@link Range ranges} or more detailed {@link DecorationOptions options}.
*/
setDecorations(decorationType: TextEditorDecorationType, rangesOrOptions: readonly Range[] | readonly DecorationOptions[]): void;
/**
* Scroll as indicated by `revealType` in order to reveal the given range.
*
* @param range A range.
* @param revealType The scrolling strategy for revealing `range`.
*/
revealRange(range: Range, revealType?: TextEditorRevealType): void;
/**
* Show the text editor.
*
* @deprecated Use {@link window.showTextDocument} instead.
*
* @param column The {@link ViewColumn column} in which to show this editor.
* This method shows unexpected behavior and will be removed in the next major update.
*/
show(column?: ViewColumn): void;
/**
* Hide the text editor.
*
* @deprecated Use the command `workbench.action.closeActiveEditor` instead.
* This method shows unexpected behavior and will be removed in the next major update.
*/
hide(): void;
}
/**
* Represents an end of line character sequence in a {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
export enum EndOfLine {
/**
* The line feed `\n` character.
*/
LF = 1,
/**
* The carriage return line feed `\r\n` sequence.
*/
CRLF = 2
}
/**
* A complex edit that will be applied in one transaction on a TextEditor.
* This holds a description of the edits and if the edits are valid (i.e. no overlapping regions, document was not changed in the meantime, etc.)
* they can be applied on a {@link TextDocument document} associated with a {@link TextEditor text editor}.
*/
export interface TextEditorEdit {
/**
* Replace a certain text region with a new value.
* You can use \r\n or \n in `value` and they will be normalized to the current {@link TextDocument document}.
*
* @param location The range this operation should remove.
* @param value The new text this operation should insert after removing `location`.
*/
replace(location: Position | Range | Selection, value: string): void;
/**
* Insert text at a location.
* You can use \r\n or \n in `value` and they will be normalized to the current {@link TextDocument document}.
* Although the equivalent text edit can be made with {@link TextEditorEdit.replace replace}, `insert` will produce a different resulting selection (it will get moved).
*
* @param location The position where the new text should be inserted.
* @param value The new text this operation should insert.
*/
insert(location: Position, value: string): void;
/**
* Delete a certain text region.
*
* @param location The range this operation should remove.
*/
delete(location: Range | Selection): void;
/**
* Set the end of line sequence.
*
* @param endOfLine The new end of line for the {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
setEndOfLine(endOfLine: EndOfLine): void;
}
/**
* A universal resource identifier representing either a file on disk
* or another resource, like untitled resources.
*/
export class Uri {
/**
* Create an URI from a string, e.g. `http://www.msft.com/some/path`,
* `file:///usr/home`, or `scheme:with/path`.
*
* *Note* that for a while uris without a `scheme` were accepted. That is not correct
* as all uris should have a scheme. To avoid breakage of existing code the optional
* `strict`-argument has been added. We *strongly* advise to use it, e.g. `Uri.parse('my:uri', true)`
*
* @see {@link Uri.toString}
* @param value The string value of an Uri.
* @param strict Throw an error when `value` is empty or when no `scheme` can be parsed.
* @return A new Uri instance.
*/
static parse(value: string, strict?: boolean): Uri;
/**
* Create an URI from a file system path. The {@link Uri.scheme scheme}
* will be `file`.
*
* The *difference* between {@link Uri.parse} and {@link Uri.file} is that the latter treats the argument
* as path, not as stringified-uri. E.g. `Uri.file(path)` is *not* the same as
* `Uri.parse('file://' + path)` because the path might contain characters that are
* interpreted (# and ?). See the following sample:
* ```ts
* const good = URI.file('/coding/c#/project1');
* good.scheme === 'file';
* good.path === '/coding/c#/project1';
* good.fragment === '';
*
* const bad = URI.parse('file://' + '/coding/c#/project1');
* bad.scheme === 'file';
* bad.path === '/coding/c'; // path is now broken
* bad.fragment === '/project1';
* ```
*
* @param path A file system or UNC path.
* @return A new Uri instance.
*/
static file(path: string): Uri;
/**
* Create a new uri which path is the result of joining
* the path of the base uri with the provided path segments.
*
* - Note 1: `joinPath` only affects the path component
* and all other components (scheme, authority, query, and fragment) are
* left as they are.
* - Note 2: The base uri must have a path; an error is thrown otherwise.
*
* The path segments are normalized in the following ways:
* - sequences of path separators (`/` or `\`) are replaced with a single separator
* - for `file`-uris on windows, the backslash-character (`\`) is considered a path-separator
* - the `..`-segment denotes the parent segment, the `.` denotes the current segment
* - paths have a root which always remains, for instance on windows drive-letters are roots
* so that is true: `joinPath(Uri.file('file:///c:/root'), '../../other').fsPath === 'c:/other'`
*
* @param base An uri. Must have a path.
* @param pathSegments One more more path fragments
* @returns A new uri which path is joined with the given fragments
*/
static joinPath(base: Uri, ...pathSegments: string[]): Uri;
/**
* Create an URI from its component parts
*
* @see {@link Uri.toString}
* @param components The component parts of an Uri.
* @return A new Uri instance.
*/
static from(components: { scheme: string; authority?: string; path?: string; query?: string; fragment?: string }): Uri;
/**
* Use the `file` and `parse` factory functions to create new `Uri` objects.
*/
private constructor(scheme: string, authority: string, path: string, query: string, fragment: string);
/**
* Scheme is the `http` part of `http://www.msft.com/some/path?query#fragment`.
* The part before the first colon.
*/
readonly scheme: string;
/**
* Authority is the `www.msft.com` part of `http://www.msft.com/some/path?query#fragment`.
* The part between the first double slashes and the next slash.
*/
readonly authority: string;
/**
* Path is the `/some/path` part of `http://www.msft.com/some/path?query#fragment`.
*/
readonly path: string;
/**
* Query is the `query` part of `http://www.msft.com/some/path?query#fragment`.
*/
readonly query: string;
/**
* Fragment is the `fragment` part of `http://www.msft.com/some/path?query#fragment`.
*/
readonly fragment: string;
/**
* The string representing the corresponding file system path of this Uri.
*
* Will handle UNC paths and normalize windows drive letters to lower-case. Also
* uses the platform specific path separator.
*
* * Will *not* validate the path for invalid characters and semantics.
* * Will *not* look at the scheme of this Uri.
* * The resulting string shall *not* be used for display purposes but
* for disk operations, like `readFile` et al.
*
* The *difference* to the {@linkcode Uri.path path}-property is the use of the platform specific
* path separator and the handling of UNC paths. The sample below outlines the difference:
* ```ts
* const u = URI.parse('file://server/c$/folder/file.txt')
* u.authority === 'server'
* u.path === '/shares/c$/file.txt'
* u.fsPath === '\\server\c$\folder\file.txt'
* ```
*/
readonly fsPath: string;
/**
* Derive a new Uri from this Uri.
*
* ```ts
* let file = Uri.parse('before:some/file/path');
* let other = file.with({ scheme: 'after' });
* assert.ok(other.toString() === 'after:some/file/path');
* ```
*
* @param change An object that describes a change to this Uri. To unset components use `null` or
* the empty string.
* @return A new Uri that reflects the given change. Will return `this` Uri if the change
* is not changing anything.
*/
with(change: { scheme?: string; authority?: string; path?: string; query?: string; fragment?: string }): Uri;
/**
* Returns a string representation of this Uri. The representation and normalization
* of a URI depends on the scheme.
*
* * The resulting string can be safely used with {@link Uri.parse}.
* * The resulting string shall *not* be used for display purposes.
*
* *Note* that the implementation will encode _aggressive_ which often leads to unexpected,
* but not incorrect, results. For instance, colons are encoded to `%3A` which might be unexpected
* in file-uri. Also `&` and `=` will be encoded which might be unexpected for http-uris. For stability
* reasons this cannot be changed anymore. If you suffer from too aggressive encoding you should use
* the `skipEncoding`-argument: `uri.toString(true)`.
*
* @param skipEncoding Do not percentage-encode the result, defaults to `false`. Note that
* the `#` and `?` characters occurring in the path will always be encoded.
* @returns A string representation of this Uri.
*/
toString(skipEncoding?: boolean): string;
/**
* Returns a JSON representation of this Uri.
*
* @return An object.
*/
toJSON(): any;
}
/**
* A cancellation token is passed to an asynchronous or long running
* operation to request cancellation, like cancelling a request
* for completion items because the user continued to type.
*
* To get an instance of a `CancellationToken` use a
* {@link CancellationTokenSource}.
*/
export interface CancellationToken {
/**
* Is `true` when the token has been cancelled, `false` otherwise.
*/
isCancellationRequested: boolean;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires upon cancellation.
*/
onCancellationRequested: Event<any>;
}
/**
* A cancellation source creates and controls a {@link CancellationToken cancellation token}.
*/
export class CancellationTokenSource {
/**
* The cancellation token of this source.
*/
token: CancellationToken;
/**
* Signal cancellation on the token.
*/
cancel(): void;
/**
* Dispose object and free resources.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* An error type that should be used to signal cancellation of an operation.
*
* This type can be used in response to a {@link CancellationToken cancellation token}
* being cancelled or when an operation is being cancelled by the
* executor of that operation.
*/
export class CancellationError extends Error {
/**
* Creates a new cancellation error.
*/
constructor();
}
/**
* Represents a type which can release resources, such
* as event listening or a timer.
*/
export class Disposable {
/**
* Combine many disposable-likes into one. Use this method
* when having objects with a dispose function which are not
* instances of Disposable.
*
* @param disposableLikes Objects that have at least a `dispose`-function member.
* @return Returns a new disposable which, upon dispose, will
* dispose all provided disposables.
*/
static from(...disposableLikes: { dispose: () => any }[]): Disposable;
/**
* Creates a new Disposable calling the provided function
* on dispose.
* @param callOnDispose Function that disposes something.
*/
constructor(callOnDispose: Function);
/**
* Dispose this object.
*/
dispose(): any;
}
/**
* Represents a typed event.
*
* A function that represents an event to which you subscribe by calling it with
* a listener function as argument.
*
* @example
* item.onDidChange(function(event) { console.log("Event happened: " + event); });
*/
export interface Event<T> {
/**
* A function that represents an event to which you subscribe by calling it with
* a listener function as argument.
*
* @param listener The listener function will be called when the event happens.
* @param thisArgs The `this`-argument which will be used when calling the event listener.
* @param disposables An array to which a {@link Disposable} will be added.
* @return A disposable which unsubscribes the event listener.
*/
(listener: (e: T) => any, thisArgs?: any, disposables?: Disposable[]): Disposable;
}
/**
* An event emitter can be used to create and manage an {@link Event} for others
* to subscribe to. One emitter always owns one event.
*
* Use this class if you want to provide event from within your extension, for instance
* inside a {@link TextDocumentContentProvider} or when providing
* API to other extensions.
*/
export class EventEmitter<T> {
/**
* The event listeners can subscribe to.
*/
event: Event<T>;
/**
* Notify all subscribers of the {@link EventEmitter.event event}. Failure
* of one or more listener will not fail this function call.
*
* @param data The event object.
*/
fire(data: T): void;
/**
* Dispose this object and free resources.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* A file system watcher notifies about changes to files and folders
* on disk or from other {@link FileSystemProvider FileSystemProviders}.
*
* To get an instance of a `FileSystemWatcher` use
* {@link workspace.createFileSystemWatcher createFileSystemWatcher}.
*/
export interface FileSystemWatcher extends Disposable {
/**
* true if this file system watcher has been created such that
* it ignores creation file system events.
*/
ignoreCreateEvents: boolean;
/**
* true if this file system watcher has been created such that
* it ignores change file system events.
*/
ignoreChangeEvents: boolean;
/**
* true if this file system watcher has been created such that
* it ignores delete file system events.
*/
ignoreDeleteEvents: boolean;
/**
* An event which fires on file/folder creation.
*/
onDidCreate: Event<Uri>;
/**
* An event which fires on file/folder change.
*/
onDidChange: Event<Uri>;
/**
* An event which fires on file/folder deletion.
*/
onDidDelete: Event<Uri>;
}
/**
* A text document content provider allows to add readonly documents
* to the editor, such as source from a dll or generated html from md.
*
* Content providers are {@link workspace.registerTextDocumentContentProvider registered}
* for a {@link Uri.scheme uri-scheme}. When a uri with that scheme is to
* be {@link workspace.openTextDocument loaded} the content provider is
* asked.
*/
export interface TextDocumentContentProvider {
/**
* An event to signal a resource has changed.
*/
onDidChange?: Event<Uri>;
/**
* Provide textual content for a given uri.
*
* The editor will use the returned string-content to create a readonly
* {@link TextDocument document}. Resources allocated should be released when
* the corresponding document has been {@link workspace.onDidCloseTextDocument closed}.
*
* **Note**: The contents of the created {@link TextDocument document} might not be
* identical to the provided text due to end-of-line-sequence normalization.
*
* @param uri An uri which scheme matches the scheme this provider was {@link workspace.registerTextDocumentContentProvider registered} for.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A string or a thenable that resolves to such.
*/
provideTextDocumentContent(uri: Uri, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<string>;
}
/**
* Represents an item that can be selected from
* a list of items.
*/
export interface QuickPickItem {
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered prominent. Supports rendering of {@link ThemeIcon theme icons} via
* the `$(<name>)`-syntax.
*/
label: string;
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered less prominent in the same line. Supports rendering of
* {@link ThemeIcon theme icons} via the `$(<name>)`-syntax.
*/
description?: string;
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered less prominent in a separate line. Supports rendering of
* {@link ThemeIcon theme icons} via the `$(<name>)`-syntax.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* Optional flag indicating if this item is picked initially.
* (Only honored when the picker allows multiple selections.)
*
* @see {@link QuickPickOptions.canPickMany}
*/
picked?: boolean;
/**
* Always show this item.
*/
alwaysShow?: boolean;
}
/**
* Options to configure the behavior of the quick pick UI.
*/
export interface QuickPickOptions {
/**
* An optional string that represents the title of the quick pick.
*/
title?: string;
/**
* An optional flag to include the description when filtering the picks.
*/
matchOnDescription?: boolean;
/**
* An optional flag to include the detail when filtering the picks.
*/
matchOnDetail?: boolean;
/**
* An optional string to show as placeholder in the input box to guide the user what to pick on.
*/
placeHolder?: string;
/**
* Set to `true` to keep the picker open when focus moves to another part of the editor or to another window.
* This setting is ignored on iPad and is always false.
*/
ignoreFocusOut?: boolean;
/**
* An optional flag to make the picker accept multiple selections, if true the result is an array of picks.
*/
canPickMany?: boolean;
/**
* An optional function that is invoked whenever an item is selected.
*/
onDidSelectItem?(item: QuickPickItem | string): any;
}
/**
* Options to configure the behaviour of the {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder} pick UI.
*/
export interface WorkspaceFolderPickOptions {
/**
* An optional string to show as placeholder in the input box to guide the user what to pick on.
*/
placeHolder?: string;
/**
* Set to `true` to keep the picker open when focus moves to another part of the editor or to another window.
* This setting is ignored on iPad and is always false.
*/
ignoreFocusOut?: boolean;
}
/**
* Options to configure the behaviour of a file open dialog.
*
* * Note 1: On Windows and Linux, a file dialog cannot be both a file selector and a folder selector, so if you
* set both `canSelectFiles` and `canSelectFolders` to `true` on these platforms, a folder selector will be shown.
* * Note 2: Explicitly setting `canSelectFiles` and `canSelectFolders` to `false` is futile
* and the editor then silently adjusts the options to select files.
*/
export interface OpenDialogOptions {
/**
* The resource the dialog shows when opened.
*/
defaultUri?: Uri;
/**
* A human-readable string for the open button.
*/
openLabel?: string;
/**
* Allow to select files, defaults to `true`.
*/
canSelectFiles?: boolean;
/**
* Allow to select folders, defaults to `false`.
*/
canSelectFolders?: boolean;
/**
* Allow to select many files or folders.
*/
canSelectMany?: boolean;
/**
* A set of file filters that are used by the dialog. Each entry is a human-readable label,
* like "TypeScript", and an array of extensions, e.g.
* ```ts
* {
* 'Images': ['png', 'jpg']
* 'TypeScript': ['ts', 'tsx']
* }
* ```
*/
filters?: { [name: string]: string[] };
/**
* Dialog title.
*
* This parameter might be ignored, as not all operating systems display a title on open dialogs
* (for example, macOS).
*/
title?: string;
}
/**
* Options to configure the behaviour of a file save dialog.
*/
export interface SaveDialogOptions {
/**
* The resource the dialog shows when opened.
*/
defaultUri?: Uri;
/**
* A human-readable string for the save button.
*/
saveLabel?: string;
/**
* A set of file filters that are used by the dialog. Each entry is a human-readable label,
* like "TypeScript", and an array of extensions, e.g.
* ```ts
* {
* 'Images': ['png', 'jpg']
* 'TypeScript': ['ts', 'tsx']
* }
* ```
*/
filters?: { [name: string]: string[] };
/**
* Dialog title.
*
* This parameter might be ignored, as not all operating systems display a title on save dialogs
* (for example, macOS).
*/
title?: string;
}
/**
* Represents an action that is shown with an information, warning, or
* error message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
* @see {@link window.showWarningMessage showWarningMessage}
* @see {@link window.showErrorMessage showErrorMessage}
*/
export interface MessageItem {
/**
* A short title like 'Retry', 'Open Log' etc.
*/
title: string;
/**
* A hint for modal dialogs that the item should be triggered
* when the user cancels the dialog (e.g. by pressing the ESC
* key).
*
* Note: this option is ignored for non-modal messages.
*/
isCloseAffordance?: boolean;
}
/**
* Options to configure the behavior of the message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
* @see {@link window.showWarningMessage showWarningMessage}
* @see {@link window.showErrorMessage showErrorMessage}
*/
export interface MessageOptions {
/**
* Indicates that this message should be modal.
*/
modal?: boolean;
/**
* Human-readable detail message that is rendered less prominent. _Note_ that detail
* is only shown for {@link MessageOptions.modal modal} messages.
*/
detail?: string;
}
/**
* Options to configure the behavior of the input box UI.
*/
export interface InputBoxOptions {
/**
* An optional string that represents the title of the input box.
*/
title?: string;
/**
* The value to prefill in the input box.
*/
value?: string;
/**
* Selection of the prefilled {@linkcode InputBoxOptions.value value}. Defined as tuple of two number where the
* first is the inclusive start index and the second the exclusive end index. When `undefined` the whole
* word will be selected, when empty (start equals end) only the cursor will be set,
* otherwise the defined range will be selected.
*/
valueSelection?: [number, number];
/**
* The text to display underneath the input box.
*/
prompt?: string;
/**
* An optional string to show as placeholder in the input box to guide the user what to type.
*/
placeHolder?: string;
/**
* Controls if a password input is shown. Password input hides the typed text.
*/
password?: boolean;
/**
* Set to `true` to keep the input box open when focus moves to another part of the editor or to another window.
* This setting is ignored on iPad and is always false.
*/
ignoreFocusOut?: boolean;
/**
* An optional function that will be called to validate input and to give a hint
* to the user.
*
* @param value The current value of the input box.
* @return A human-readable string which is presented as diagnostic message.
* Return `undefined`, `null`, or the empty string when 'value' is valid.
*/
validateInput?(value: string): string | undefined | null | Thenable<string | undefined | null>;
}
/**
* A relative pattern is a helper to construct glob patterns that are matched
* relatively to a base file path. The base path can either be an absolute file
* path as string or uri or a {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder}, which is the
* preferred way of creating the relative pattern.
*/
export class RelativePattern {
/**
* A base file path to which this pattern will be matched against relatively.
*/
base: string;
/**
* A file glob pattern like `*.{ts,js}` that will be matched on file paths
* relative to the base path.
*
* Example: Given a base of `/home/work/folder` and a file path of `/home/work/folder/index.js`,
* the file glob pattern will match on `index.js`.
*/
pattern: string;
/**
* Creates a new relative pattern object with a base file path and pattern to match. This pattern
* will be matched on file paths relative to the base.
*
* Example:
* ```ts
* const folder = vscode.workspace.workspaceFolders?.[0];
* if (folder) {
*
* // Match any TypeScript file in the root of this workspace folder
* const pattern1 = new vscode.RelativePattern(folder, '*.ts');
*
* // Match any TypeScript file in `someFolder` inside this workspace folder
* const pattern2 = new vscode.RelativePattern(folder, 'someFolder/*.ts');
* }
* ```
*
* @param base A base to which this pattern will be matched against relatively. It is recommended
* to pass in a {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder} if the pattern should match inside the workspace.
* Otherwise, a uri or string should only be used if the pattern is for a file path outside the workspace.
* @param pattern A file glob pattern like `*.{ts,js}` that will be matched on paths relative to the base.
*/
constructor(base: WorkspaceFolder | Uri | string, pattern: string)
}
/**
* A file glob pattern to match file paths against. This can either be a glob pattern string
* (like `**/*.{ts,js}` or `*.{ts,js}`) or a {@link RelativePattern relative pattern}.
*
* Glob patterns can have the following syntax:
* * `*` to match one or more characters in a path segment
* * `?` to match on one character in a path segment
* * `**` to match any number of path segments, including none
* * `{}` to group conditions (e.g. `**/*.{ts,js}` matches all TypeScript and JavaScript files)
* * `[]` to declare a range of characters to match in a path segment (e.g., `example.[0-9]` to match on `example.0`, `example.1`, …)
* * `[!...]` to negate a range of characters to match in a path segment (e.g., `example.[!0-9]` to match on `example.a`, `example.b`, but not `example.0`)
*
* Note: a backslash (`\`) is not valid within a glob pattern. If you have an existing file
* path to match against, consider to use the {@link RelativePattern relative pattern} support
* that takes care of converting any backslash into slash. Otherwise, make sure to convert
* any backslash to slash when creating the glob pattern.
*/
export type GlobPattern = string | RelativePattern;
/**
* A document filter denotes a document by different properties like
* the {@link TextDocument.languageId language}, the {@link Uri.scheme scheme} of
* its resource, or a glob-pattern that is applied to the {@link TextDocument.fileName path}.
*
* @example <caption>A language filter that applies to typescript files on disk</caption>
* { language: 'typescript', scheme: 'file' }
*
* @example <caption>A language filter that applies to all package.json paths</caption>
* { language: 'json', pattern: '**/package.json' }
*/
export interface DocumentFilter {
/**
* A language id, like `typescript`.
*/
readonly language?: string;
/**
* A Uri {@link Uri.scheme scheme}, like `file` or `untitled`.
*/
readonly scheme?: string;
/**
* A {@link GlobPattern glob pattern} that is matched on the absolute path of the document. Use a {@link RelativePattern relative pattern}
* to filter documents to a {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder}.
*/
readonly pattern?: GlobPattern;
}
/**
* A language selector is the combination of one or many language identifiers
* and {@link DocumentFilter language filters}.
*
* *Note* that a document selector that is just a language identifier selects *all*
* documents, even those that are not saved on disk. Only use such selectors when
* a feature works without further context, e.g. without the need to resolve related
* 'files'.
*
* @example
* let sel:DocumentSelector = { scheme: 'file', language: 'typescript' };
*/
export type DocumentSelector = DocumentFilter | string | ReadonlyArray<DocumentFilter | string>;
/**
* A provider result represents the values a provider, like the {@linkcode HoverProvider},
* may return. For once this is the actual result type `T`, like `Hover`, or a thenable that resolves
* to that type `T`. In addition, `null` and `undefined` can be returned - either directly or from a
* thenable.
*
* The snippets below are all valid implementations of the {@linkcode HoverProvider}:
*
* ```ts
* let a: HoverProvider = {
* provideHover(doc, pos, token): ProviderResult<Hover> {
* return new Hover('Hello World');
* }
* }
*
* let b: HoverProvider = {
* provideHover(doc, pos, token): ProviderResult<Hover> {
* return new Promise(resolve => {
* resolve(new Hover('Hello World'));
* });
* }
* }
*
* let c: HoverProvider = {
* provideHover(doc, pos, token): ProviderResult<Hover> {
* return; // undefined
* }
* }
* ```
*/
export type ProviderResult<T> = T | undefined | null | Thenable<T | undefined | null>;
/**
* Kind of a code action.
*
* Kinds are a hierarchical list of identifiers separated by `.`, e.g. `"refactor.extract.function"`.
*
* Code action kinds are used by the editor for UI elements such as the refactoring context menu. Users
* can also trigger code actions with a specific kind with the `editor.action.codeAction` command.
*/
export class CodeActionKind {
/**
* Empty kind.
*/
static readonly Empty: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for quickfix actions: `quickfix`.
*
* Quick fix actions address a problem in the code and are shown in the normal code action context menu.
*/
static readonly QuickFix: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for refactoring actions: `refactor`
*
* Refactoring actions are shown in the refactoring context menu.
*/
static readonly Refactor: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for refactoring extraction actions: `refactor.extract`
*
* Example extract actions:
*
* - Extract method
* - Extract function
* - Extract variable
* - Extract interface from class
* - ...
*/
static readonly RefactorExtract: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for refactoring inline actions: `refactor.inline`
*
* Example inline actions:
*
* - Inline function
* - Inline variable
* - Inline constant
* - ...
*/
static readonly RefactorInline: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for refactoring rewrite actions: `refactor.rewrite`
*
* Example rewrite actions:
*
* - Convert JavaScript function to class
* - Add or remove parameter
* - Encapsulate field
* - Make method static
* - Move method to base class
* - ...
*/
static readonly RefactorRewrite: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for source actions: `source`
*
* Source code actions apply to the entire file. They must be explicitly requested and will not show in the
* normal [lightbulb](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_code-action) menu. Source actions
* can be run on save using `editor.codeActionsOnSave` and are also shown in the `source` context menu.
*/
static readonly Source: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for an organize imports source action: `source.organizeImports`.
*/
static readonly SourceOrganizeImports: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Base kind for auto-fix source actions: `source.fixAll`.
*
* Fix all actions automatically fix errors that have a clear fix that do not require user input.
* They should not suppress errors or perform unsafe fixes such as generating new types or classes.
*/
static readonly SourceFixAll: CodeActionKind;
private constructor(value: string);
/**
* String value of the kind, e.g. `"refactor.extract.function"`.
*/
readonly value: string;
/**
* Create a new kind by appending a more specific selector to the current kind.
*
* Does not modify the current kind.
*/
append(parts: string): CodeActionKind;
/**
* Checks if this code action kind intersects `other`.
*
* The kind `"refactor.extract"` for example intersects `refactor`, `"refactor.extract"` and ``"refactor.extract.function"`,
* but not `"unicorn.refactor.extract"`, or `"refactor.extractAll"`.
*
* @param other Kind to check.
*/
intersects(other: CodeActionKind): boolean;
/**
* Checks if `other` is a sub-kind of this `CodeActionKind`.
*
* The kind `"refactor.extract"` for example contains `"refactor.extract"` and ``"refactor.extract.function"`,
* but not `"unicorn.refactor.extract"`, or `"refactor.extractAll"` or `refactor`.
*
* @param other Kind to check.
*/
contains(other: CodeActionKind): boolean;
}
/**
* The reason why code actions were requested.
*/
export enum CodeActionTriggerKind {
/**
* Code actions were explicitly requested by the user or by an extension.
*/
Invoke = 1,
/**
* Code actions were requested automatically.
*
* This typically happens when current selection in a file changes, but can
* also be triggered when file content changes.
*/
Automatic = 2,
}
/**
* Contains additional diagnostic information about the context in which
* a {@link CodeActionProvider.provideCodeActions code action} is run.
*/
export interface CodeActionContext {
/**
* The reason why code actions were requested.
*/
readonly triggerKind: CodeActionTriggerKind;
/**
* An array of diagnostics.
*/
readonly diagnostics: readonly Diagnostic[];
/**
* Requested kind of actions to return.
*
* Actions not of this kind are filtered out before being shown by the [lightbulb](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_code-action).
*/
readonly only: CodeActionKind | undefined;
}
/**
* A code action represents a change that can be performed in code, e.g. to fix a problem or
* to refactor code.
*
* A CodeAction must set either {@linkcode CodeAction.edit edit} and/or a {@linkcode CodeAction.command command}. If both are supplied, the `edit` is applied first, then the command is executed.
*/
export class CodeAction {
/**
* A short, human-readable, title for this code action.
*/
title: string;
/**
* A {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit} this code action performs.
*/
edit?: WorkspaceEdit;
/**
* {@link Diagnostic Diagnostics} that this code action resolves.
*/
diagnostics?: Diagnostic[];
/**
* A {@link Command} this code action executes.
*
* If this command throws an exception, the editor displays the exception message to users in the editor at the
* current cursor position.
*/
command?: Command;
/**
* {@link CodeActionKind Kind} of the code action.
*
* Used to filter code actions.
*/
kind?: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Marks this as a preferred action. Preferred actions are used by the `auto fix` command and can be targeted
* by keybindings.
*
* A quick fix should be marked preferred if it properly addresses the underlying error.
* A refactoring should be marked preferred if it is the most reasonable choice of actions to take.
*/
isPreferred?: boolean;
/**
* Marks that the code action cannot currently be applied.
*
* - Disabled code actions are not shown in automatic [lightbulb](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_code-action)
* code action menu.
*
* - Disabled actions are shown as faded out in the code action menu when the user request a more specific type
* of code action, such as refactorings.
*
* - If the user has a [keybinding](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/refactoring#_keybindings-for-code-actions)
* that auto applies a code action and only a disabled code actions are returned, the editor will show the user an
* error message with `reason` in the editor.
*/
disabled?: {
/**
* Human readable description of why the code action is currently disabled.
*
* This is displayed in the code actions UI.
*/
readonly reason: string;
};
/**
* Creates a new code action.
*
* A code action must have at least a {@link CodeAction.title title} and {@link CodeAction.edit edits}
* and/or a {@link CodeAction.command command}.
*
* @param title The title of the code action.
* @param kind The kind of the code action.
*/
constructor(title: string, kind?: CodeActionKind);
}
/**
* The code action interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [lightbulb](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_code-action) feature.
*
* A code action can be any command that is {@link commands.getCommands known} to the system.
*/
export interface CodeActionProvider<T extends CodeAction = CodeAction> {
/**
* Provide commands for the given document and range.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param range The selector or range for which the command was invoked. This will always be a selection if
* there is a currently active editor.
* @param context Context carrying additional information.
* @param token A cancellation token.
*
* @return An array of code actions, such as quick fixes or refactorings. The lack of a result can be signaled
* by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*
* We also support returning `Command` for legacy reasons, however all new extensions should return
* `CodeAction` object instead.
*/
provideCodeActions(document: TextDocument, range: Range | Selection, context: CodeActionContext, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<(Command | T)[]>;
/**
* Given a code action fill in its {@linkcode CodeAction.edit edit}-property. Changes to
* all other properties, like title, are ignored. A code action that has an edit
* will not be resolved.
*
* *Note* that a code action provider that returns commands, not code actions, cannot successfully
* implement this function. Returning commands is deprecated and instead code actions should be
* returned.
*
* @param codeAction A code action.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved code action or a thenable that resolves to such. It is OK to return the given
* `item`. When no result is returned, the given `item` will be used.
*/
resolveCodeAction?(codeAction: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T>;
}
/**
* Metadata about the type of code actions that a {@link CodeActionProvider} provides.
*/
export interface CodeActionProviderMetadata {
/**
* List of {@link CodeActionKind CodeActionKinds} that a {@link CodeActionProvider} may return.
*
* This list is used to determine if a given `CodeActionProvider` should be invoked or not.
* To avoid unnecessary computation, every `CodeActionProvider` should list use `providedCodeActionKinds`. The
* list of kinds may either be generic, such as `[CodeActionKind.Refactor]`, or list out every kind provided,
* such as `[CodeActionKind.Refactor.Extract.append('function'), CodeActionKind.Refactor.Extract.append('constant'), ...]`.
*/
readonly providedCodeActionKinds?: readonly CodeActionKind[];
/**
* Static documentation for a class of code actions.
*
* Documentation from the provider is shown in the code actions menu if either:
*
* - Code actions of `kind` are requested by the editor. In this case, the editor will show the documentation that
* most closely matches the requested code action kind. For example, if a provider has documentation for
* both `Refactor` and `RefactorExtract`, when the user requests code actions for `RefactorExtract`,
* the editor will use the documentation for `RefactorExtract` instead of the documentation for `Refactor`.
*
* - Any code actions of `kind` are returned by the provider.
*
* At most one documentation entry will be shown per provider.
*/
readonly documentation?: ReadonlyArray<{
/**
* The kind of the code action being documented.
*
* If the kind is generic, such as `CodeActionKind.Refactor`, the documentation will be shown whenever any
* refactorings are returned. If the kind if more specific, such as `CodeActionKind.RefactorExtract`, the
* documentation will only be shown when extract refactoring code actions are returned.
*/
readonly kind: CodeActionKind;
/**
* Command that displays the documentation to the user.
*
* This can display the documentation directly in the editor or open a website using {@linkcode env.openExternal};
*
* The title of this documentation code action is taken from {@linkcode Command.title}
*/
readonly command: Command;
}>;
}
/**
* A code lens represents a {@link Command} that should be shown along with
* source text, like the number of references, a way to run tests, etc.
*
* A code lens is _unresolved_ when no command is associated to it. For performance
* reasons the creation of a code lens and resolving should be done to two stages.
*
* @see {@link CodeLensProvider.provideCodeLenses}
* @see {@link CodeLensProvider.resolveCodeLens}
*/
export class CodeLens {
/**
* The range in which this code lens is valid. Should only span a single line.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The command this code lens represents.
*/
command?: Command;
/**
* `true` when there is a command associated.
*/
readonly isResolved: boolean;
/**
* Creates a new code lens object.
*
* @param range The range to which this code lens applies.
* @param command The command associated to this code lens.
*/
constructor(range: Range, command?: Command);
}
/**
* A code lens provider adds {@link Command commands} to source text. The commands will be shown
* as dedicated horizontal lines in between the source text.
*/
export interface CodeLensProvider<T extends CodeLens = CodeLens> {
/**
* An optional event to signal that the code lenses from this provider have changed.
*/
onDidChangeCodeLenses?: Event<void>;
/**
* Compute a list of {@link CodeLens lenses}. This call should return as fast as possible and if
* computing the commands is expensive implementors should only return code lens objects with the
* range set and implement {@link CodeLensProvider.resolveCodeLens resolve}.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of code lenses or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideCodeLenses(document: TextDocument, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T[]>;
/**
* This function will be called for each visible code lens, usually when scrolling and after
* calls to {@link CodeLensProvider.provideCodeLenses compute}-lenses.
*
* @param codeLens Code lens that must be resolved.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The given, resolved code lens or thenable that resolves to such.
*/
resolveCodeLens?(codeLens: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T>;
}
/**
* Information about where a symbol is defined.
*
* Provides additional metadata over normal {@link Location} definitions, including the range of
* the defining symbol
*/
export type DefinitionLink = LocationLink;
/**
* The definition of a symbol represented as one or many {@link Location locations}.
* For most programming languages there is only one location at which a symbol is
* defined.
*/
export type Definition = Location | Location[];
/**
* The definition provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [go to definition](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_go-to-definition)
* and peek definition features.
*/
export interface DefinitionProvider {
/**
* Provide the definition of the symbol at the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A definition or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideDefinition(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Definition | DefinitionLink[]>;
}
/**
* The implementation provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the go to implementation feature.
*/
export interface ImplementationProvider {
/**
* Provide the implementations of the symbol at the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A definition or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideImplementation(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Definition | DefinitionLink[]>;
}
/**
* The type definition provider defines the contract between extensions and
* the go to type definition feature.
*/
export interface TypeDefinitionProvider {
/**
* Provide the type definition of the symbol at the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A definition or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideTypeDefinition(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Definition | DefinitionLink[]>;
}
/**
* The declaration of a symbol representation as one or many {@link Location locations}
* or {@link LocationLink location links}.
*/
export type Declaration = Location | Location[] | LocationLink[];
/**
* The declaration provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the go to declaration feature.
*/
export interface DeclarationProvider {
/**
* Provide the declaration of the symbol at the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A declaration or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideDeclaration(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Declaration>;
}
/**
* Human-readable text that supports formatting via the [markdown syntax](https://commonmark.org).
*
* Rendering of {@link ThemeIcon theme icons} via the `$(<name>)`-syntax is supported
* when the {@linkcode supportThemeIcons} is set to `true`.
*
* Rendering of embedded html is supported when {@linkcode supportHtml} is set to `true`.
*/
export class MarkdownString {
/**
* The markdown string.
*/
value: string;
/**
* Indicates that this markdown string is from a trusted source. Only *trusted*
* markdown supports links that execute commands, e.g. `[Run it](command:myCommandId)`.
*/
isTrusted?: boolean;
/**
* Indicates that this markdown string can contain {@link ThemeIcon ThemeIcons}, e.g. `$(zap)`.
*/
supportThemeIcons?: boolean;
/**
* Indicates that this markdown string can contain raw html tags. Defaults to `false`.
*
* When `supportHtml` is false, the markdown renderer will strip out any raw html tags
* that appear in the markdown text. This means you can only use markdown syntax for rendering.
*
* When `supportHtml` is true, the markdown render will also allow a safe subset of html tags
* and attributes to be rendered. See https://github.com/microsoft/vscode/blob/6d2920473c6f13759c978dd89104c4270a83422d/src/vs/base/browser/markdownRenderer.ts#L296
* for a list of all supported tags and attributes.
*/
supportHtml?: boolean;
/**
* Creates a new markdown string with the given value.
*
* @param value Optional, initial value.
* @param supportThemeIcons Optional, Specifies whether {@link ThemeIcon ThemeIcons} are supported within the {@linkcode MarkdownString}.
*/
constructor(value?: string, supportThemeIcons?: boolean);
/**
* Appends and escapes the given string to this markdown string.
* @param value Plain text.
*/
appendText(value: string): MarkdownString;
/**
* Appends the given string 'as is' to this markdown string. When {@linkcode MarkdownString.supportThemeIcons supportThemeIcons} is `true`, {@link ThemeIcon ThemeIcons} in the `value` will be iconified.
* @param value Markdown string.
*/
appendMarkdown(value: string): MarkdownString;
/**
* Appends the given string as codeblock using the provided language.
* @param value A code snippet.
* @param language An optional {@link languages.getLanguages language identifier}.
*/
appendCodeblock(value: string, language?: string): MarkdownString;
}
/**
* MarkedString can be used to render human-readable text. It is either a markdown string
* or a code-block that provides a language and a code snippet. Note that
* markdown strings will be sanitized - that means html will be escaped.
*
* @deprecated This type is deprecated, please use {@linkcode MarkdownString} instead.
*/
export type MarkedString = string | { language: string; value: string };
/**
* A hover represents additional information for a symbol or word. Hovers are
* rendered in a tooltip-like widget.
*/
export class Hover {
/**
* The contents of this hover.
*/
contents: Array<MarkdownString | MarkedString>;
/**
* The range to which this hover applies. When missing, the
* editor will use the range at the current position or the
* current position itself.
*/
range?: Range;
/**
* Creates a new hover object.
*
* @param contents The contents of the hover.
* @param range The range to which the hover applies.
*/
constructor(contents: MarkdownString | MarkedString | Array<MarkdownString | MarkedString>, range?: Range);
}
/**
* The hover provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [hover](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/intellisense)-feature.
*/
export interface HoverProvider {
/**
* Provide a hover for the given position and document. Multiple hovers at the same
* position will be merged by the editor. A hover can have a range which defaults
* to the word range at the position when omitted.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A hover or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideHover(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Hover>;
}
/**
* An EvaluatableExpression represents an expression in a document that can be evaluated by an active debugger or runtime.
* The result of this evaluation is shown in a tooltip-like widget.
* If only a range is specified, the expression will be extracted from the underlying document.
* An optional expression can be used to override the extracted expression.
* In this case the range is still used to highlight the range in the document.
*/
export class EvaluatableExpression {
/*
* The range is used to extract the evaluatable expression from the underlying document and to highlight it.
*/
readonly range: Range;
/*
* If specified the expression overrides the extracted expression.
*/
readonly expression?: string;
/**
* Creates a new evaluatable expression object.
*
* @param range The range in the underlying document from which the evaluatable expression is extracted.
* @param expression If specified overrides the extracted expression.
*/
constructor(range: Range, expression?: string);
}
/**
* The evaluatable expression provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the debug hover. In this contract the provider returns an evaluatable expression for a given position
* in a document and the editor evaluates this expression in the active debug session and shows the result in a debug hover.
*/
export interface EvaluatableExpressionProvider {
/**
* Provide an evaluatable expression for the given document and position.
* The editor will evaluate this expression in the active debug session and will show the result in the debug hover.
* The expression can be implicitly specified by the range in the underlying document or by explicitly returning an expression.
*
* @param document The document for which the debug hover is about to appear.
* @param position The line and character position in the document where the debug hover is about to appear.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An EvaluatableExpression or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideEvaluatableExpression(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<EvaluatableExpression>;
}
/**
* Provide inline value as text.
*/
export class InlineValueText {
/**
* The document range for which the inline value applies.
*/
readonly range: Range;
/**
* The text of the inline value.
*/
readonly text: string;
/**
* Creates a new InlineValueText object.
*
* @param range The document line where to show the inline value.
* @param text The value to be shown for the line.
*/
constructor(range: Range, text: string);
}
/**
* Provide inline value through a variable lookup.
* If only a range is specified, the variable name will be extracted from the underlying document.
* An optional variable name can be used to override the extracted name.
*/
export class InlineValueVariableLookup {
/**
* The document range for which the inline value applies.
* The range is used to extract the variable name from the underlying document.
*/
readonly range: Range;
/**
* If specified the name of the variable to look up.
*/
readonly variableName?: string;
/**
* How to perform the lookup.
*/
readonly caseSensitiveLookup: boolean;
/**
* Creates a new InlineValueVariableLookup object.
*
* @param range The document line where to show the inline value.
* @param variableName The name of the variable to look up.
* @param caseSensitiveLookup How to perform the lookup. If missing lookup is case sensitive.
*/
constructor(range: Range, variableName?: string, caseSensitiveLookup?: boolean);
}
/**
* Provide an inline value through an expression evaluation.
* If only a range is specified, the expression will be extracted from the underlying document.
* An optional expression can be used to override the extracted expression.
*/
export class InlineValueEvaluatableExpression {
/**
* The document range for which the inline value applies.
* The range is used to extract the evaluatable expression from the underlying document.
*/
readonly range: Range;
/**
* If specified the expression overrides the extracted expression.
*/
readonly expression?: string;
/**
* Creates a new InlineValueEvaluatableExpression object.
*
* @param range The range in the underlying document from which the evaluatable expression is extracted.
* @param expression If specified overrides the extracted expression.
*/
constructor(range: Range, expression?: string);
}
/**
* Inline value information can be provided by different means:
* - directly as a text value (class InlineValueText).
* - as a name to use for a variable lookup (class InlineValueVariableLookup)
* - as an evaluatable expression (class InlineValueEvaluatableExpression)
* The InlineValue types combines all inline value types into one type.
*/
export type InlineValue = InlineValueText | InlineValueVariableLookup | InlineValueEvaluatableExpression;
/**
* A value-object that contains contextual information when requesting inline values from a InlineValuesProvider.
*/
export interface InlineValueContext {
/**
* The stack frame (as a DAP Id) where the execution has stopped.
*/
readonly frameId: number;
/**
* The document range where execution has stopped.
* Typically the end position of the range denotes the line where the inline values are shown.
*/
readonly stoppedLocation: Range;
}
/**
* The inline values provider interface defines the contract between extensions and the editor's debugger inline values feature.
* In this contract the provider returns inline value information for a given document range
* and the editor shows this information in the editor at the end of lines.
*/
export interface InlineValuesProvider {
/**
* An optional event to signal that inline values have changed.
* @see {@link EventEmitter}
*/
onDidChangeInlineValues?: Event<void> | undefined;
/**
* Provide "inline value" information for a given document and range.
* The editor calls this method whenever debugging stops in the given document.
* The returned inline values information is rendered in the editor at the end of lines.
*
* @param document The document for which the inline values information is needed.
* @param viewPort The visible document range for which inline values should be computed.
* @param context A bag containing contextual information like the current location.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of InlineValueDescriptors or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideInlineValues(document: TextDocument, viewPort: Range, context: InlineValueContext, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<InlineValue[]>;
}
/**
* A document highlight kind.
*/
export enum DocumentHighlightKind {
/**
* A textual occurrence.
*/
Text = 0,
/**
* Read-access of a symbol, like reading a variable.
*/
Read = 1,
/**
* Write-access of a symbol, like writing to a variable.
*/
Write = 2
}
/**
* A document highlight is a range inside a text document which deserves
* special attention. Usually a document highlight is visualized by changing
* the background color of its range.
*/
export class DocumentHighlight {
/**
* The range this highlight applies to.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The highlight kind, default is {@link DocumentHighlightKind.Text text}.
*/
kind?: DocumentHighlightKind;
/**
* Creates a new document highlight object.
*
* @param range The range the highlight applies to.
* @param kind The highlight kind, default is {@link DocumentHighlightKind.Text text}.
*/
constructor(range: Range, kind?: DocumentHighlightKind);
}
/**
* The document highlight provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the word-highlight-feature.
*/
export interface DocumentHighlightProvider {
/**
* Provide a set of document highlights, like all occurrences of a variable or
* all exit-points of a function.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of document highlights or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideDocumentHighlights(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<DocumentHighlight[]>;
}
/**
* A symbol kind.
*/
export enum SymbolKind {
File = 0,
Module = 1,
Namespace = 2,
Package = 3,
Class = 4,
Method = 5,
Property = 6,
Field = 7,
Constructor = 8,
Enum = 9,
Interface = 10,
Function = 11,
Variable = 12,
Constant = 13,
String = 14,
Number = 15,
Boolean = 16,
Array = 17,
Object = 18,
Key = 19,
Null = 20,
EnumMember = 21,
Struct = 22,
Event = 23,
Operator = 24,
TypeParameter = 25
}
/**
* Symbol tags are extra annotations that tweak the rendering of a symbol.
*/
export enum SymbolTag {
/**
* Render a symbol as obsolete, usually using a strike-out.
*/
Deprecated = 1
}
/**
* Represents information about programming constructs like variables, classes,
* interfaces etc.
*/
export class SymbolInformation {
/**
* The name of this symbol.
*/
name: string;
/**
* The name of the symbol containing this symbol.
*/
containerName: string;
/**
* The kind of this symbol.
*/
kind: SymbolKind;
/**
* Tags for this symbol.
*/
tags?: readonly SymbolTag[];
/**
* The location of this symbol.
*/
location: Location;
/**
* Creates a new symbol information object.
*
* @param name The name of the symbol.
* @param kind The kind of the symbol.
* @param containerName The name of the symbol containing the symbol.
* @param location The location of the symbol.
*/
constructor(name: string, kind: SymbolKind, containerName: string, location: Location);
/**
* Creates a new symbol information object.
*
* @deprecated Please use the constructor taking a {@link Location} object.
*
* @param name The name of the symbol.
* @param kind The kind of the symbol.
* @param range The range of the location of the symbol.
* @param uri The resource of the location of symbol, defaults to the current document.
* @param containerName The name of the symbol containing the symbol.
*/
constructor(name: string, kind: SymbolKind, range: Range, uri?: Uri, containerName?: string);
}
/**
* Represents programming constructs like variables, classes, interfaces etc. that appear in a document. Document
* symbols can be hierarchical and they have two ranges: one that encloses its definition and one that points to
* its most interesting range, e.g. the range of an identifier.
*/
export class DocumentSymbol {
/**
* The name of this symbol.
*/
name: string;
/**
* More detail for this symbol, e.g. the signature of a function.
*/
detail: string;
/**
* The kind of this symbol.
*/
kind: SymbolKind;
/**
* Tags for this symbol.
*/
tags?: readonly SymbolTag[];
/**
* The range enclosing this symbol not including leading/trailing whitespace but everything else, e.g. comments and code.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The range that should be selected and reveal when this symbol is being picked, e.g. the name of a function.
* Must be contained by the {@linkcode DocumentSymbol.range range}.
*/
selectionRange: Range;
/**
* Children of this symbol, e.g. properties of a class.
*/
children: DocumentSymbol[];
/**
* Creates a new document symbol.
*
* @param name The name of the symbol.
* @param detail Details for the symbol.
* @param kind The kind of the symbol.
* @param range The full range of the symbol.
* @param selectionRange The range that should be reveal.
*/
constructor(name: string, detail: string, kind: SymbolKind, range: Range, selectionRange: Range);
}
/**
* The document symbol provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [go to symbol](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_go-to-symbol)-feature.
*/
export interface DocumentSymbolProvider {
/**
* Provide symbol information for the given document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of document highlights or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideDocumentSymbols(document: TextDocument, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<SymbolInformation[] | DocumentSymbol[]>;
}
/**
* Metadata about a document symbol provider.
*/
export interface DocumentSymbolProviderMetadata {
/**
* A human-readable string that is shown when multiple outlines trees show for one document.
*/
label?: string;
}
/**
* The workspace symbol provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [symbol search](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_open-symbol-by-name)-feature.
*/
export interface WorkspaceSymbolProvider<T extends SymbolInformation = SymbolInformation> {
/**
* Project-wide search for a symbol matching the given query string.
*
* The `query`-parameter should be interpreted in a *relaxed way* as the editor will apply its own highlighting
* and scoring on the results. A good rule of thumb is to match case-insensitive and to simply check that the
* characters of *query* appear in their order in a candidate symbol. Don't use prefix, substring, or similar
* strict matching.
*
* To improve performance implementors can implement `resolveWorkspaceSymbol` and then provide symbols with partial
* {@link SymbolInformation.location location}-objects, without a `range` defined. The editor will then call
* `resolveWorkspaceSymbol` for selected symbols only, e.g. when opening a workspace symbol.
*
* @param query A query string, can be the empty string in which case all symbols should be returned.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of document highlights or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideWorkspaceSymbols(query: string, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T[]>;
/**
* Given a symbol fill in its {@link SymbolInformation.location location}. This method is called whenever a symbol
* is selected in the UI. Providers can implement this method and return incomplete symbols from
* {@linkcode WorkspaceSymbolProvider.provideWorkspaceSymbols provideWorkspaceSymbols} which often helps to improve
* performance.
*
* @param symbol The symbol that is to be resolved. Guaranteed to be an instance of an object returned from an
* earlier call to `provideWorkspaceSymbols`.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved symbol or a thenable that resolves to that. When no result is returned,
* the given `symbol` is used.
*/
resolveWorkspaceSymbol?(symbol: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T>;
}
/**
* Value-object that contains additional information when
* requesting references.
*/
export interface ReferenceContext {
/**
* Include the declaration of the current symbol.
*/
includeDeclaration: boolean;
}
/**
* The reference provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [find references](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_peek)-feature.
*/
export interface ReferenceProvider {
/**
* Provide a set of project-wide references for the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
*
* @return An array of locations or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideReferences(document: TextDocument, position: Position, context: ReferenceContext, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Location[]>;
}
/**
* A text edit represents edits that should be applied
* to a document.
*/
export class TextEdit {
/**
* Utility to create a replace edit.
*
* @param range A range.
* @param newText A string.
* @return A new text edit object.
*/
static replace(range: Range, newText: string): TextEdit;
/**
* Utility to create an insert edit.
*
* @param position A position, will become an empty range.
* @param newText A string.
* @return A new text edit object.
*/
static insert(position: Position, newText: string): TextEdit;
/**
* Utility to create a delete edit.
*
* @param range A range.
* @return A new text edit object.
*/
static delete(range: Range): TextEdit;
/**
* Utility to create an eol-edit.
*
* @param eol An eol-sequence
* @return A new text edit object.
*/
static setEndOfLine(eol: EndOfLine): TextEdit;
/**
* The range this edit applies to.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The string this edit will insert.
*/
newText: string;
/**
* The eol-sequence used in the document.
*
* *Note* that the eol-sequence will be applied to the
* whole document.
*/
newEol?: EndOfLine;
/**
* Create a new TextEdit.
*
* @param range A range.
* @param newText A string.
*/
constructor(range: Range, newText: string);
}
/**
* Additional data for entries of a workspace edit. Supports to label entries and marks entries
* as needing confirmation by the user. The editor groups edits with equal labels into tree nodes,
* for instance all edits labelled with "Changes in Strings" would be a tree node.
*/
export interface WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata {
/**
* A flag which indicates that user confirmation is needed.
*/
needsConfirmation: boolean;
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered prominent.
*/
label: string;
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered less prominent on the same line.
*/
description?: string;
/**
* The icon path or {@link ThemeIcon} for the edit.
*/
iconPath?: Uri | { light: Uri; dark: Uri } | ThemeIcon;
}
/**
* A workspace edit is a collection of textual and files changes for
* multiple resources and documents.
*
* Use the {@link workspace.applyEdit applyEdit}-function to apply a workspace edit.
*/
export class WorkspaceEdit {
/**
* The number of affected resources of textual or resource changes.
*/
readonly size: number;
/**
* Replace the given range with given text for the given resource.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @param range A range.
* @param newText A string.
* @param metadata Optional metadata for the entry.
*/
replace(uri: Uri, range: Range, newText: string, metadata?: WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata): void;
/**
* Insert the given text at the given position.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @param position A position.
* @param newText A string.
* @param metadata Optional metadata for the entry.
*/
insert(uri: Uri, position: Position, newText: string, metadata?: WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata): void;
/**
* Delete the text at the given range.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @param range A range.
* @param metadata Optional metadata for the entry.
*/
delete(uri: Uri, range: Range, metadata?: WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata): void;
/**
* Check if a text edit for a resource exists.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @return `true` if the given resource will be touched by this edit.
*/
has(uri: Uri): boolean;
/**
* Set (and replace) text edits for a resource.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @param edits An array of text edits.
*/
set(uri: Uri, edits: TextEdit[]): void;
/**
* Get the text edits for a resource.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @return An array of text edits.
*/
get(uri: Uri): TextEdit[];
/**
* Create a regular file.
*
* @param uri Uri of the new file..
* @param options Defines if an existing file should be overwritten or be
* ignored. When overwrite and ignoreIfExists are both set overwrite wins.
* When both are unset and when the file already exists then the edit cannot
* be applied successfully.
* @param metadata Optional metadata for the entry.
*/
createFile(uri: Uri, options?: { overwrite?: boolean, ignoreIfExists?: boolean }, metadata?: WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata): void;
/**
* Delete a file or folder.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file that is to be deleted.
* @param metadata Optional metadata for the entry.
*/
deleteFile(uri: Uri, options?: { recursive?: boolean, ignoreIfNotExists?: boolean }, metadata?: WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata): void;
/**
* Rename a file or folder.
*
* @param oldUri The existing file.
* @param newUri The new location.
* @param options Defines if existing files should be overwritten or be
* ignored. When overwrite and ignoreIfExists are both set overwrite wins.
* @param metadata Optional metadata for the entry.
*/
renameFile(oldUri: Uri, newUri: Uri, options?: { overwrite?: boolean, ignoreIfExists?: boolean }, metadata?: WorkspaceEditEntryMetadata): void;
/**
* Get all text edits grouped by resource.
*
* @return A shallow copy of `[Uri, TextEdit[]]`-tuples.
*/
entries(): [Uri, TextEdit[]][];
}
/**
* A snippet string is a template which allows to insert text
* and to control the editor cursor when insertion happens.
*
* A snippet can define tab stops and placeholders with `$1`, `$2`
* and `${3:foo}`. `$0` defines the final tab stop, it defaults to
* the end of the snippet. Variables are defined with `$name` and
* `${name:default value}`. The full snippet syntax is documented
* [here](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/userdefinedsnippets#_creating-your-own-snippets).
*/
export class SnippetString {
/**
* The snippet string.
*/
value: string;
constructor(value?: string);
/**
* Builder-function that appends the given string to
* the {@linkcode SnippetString.value value} of this snippet string.
*
* @param string A value to append 'as given'. The string will be escaped.
* @return This snippet string.
*/
appendText(string: string): SnippetString;
/**
* Builder-function that appends a tabstop (`$1`, `$2` etc) to
* the {@linkcode SnippetString.value value} of this snippet string.
*
* @param number The number of this tabstop, defaults to an auto-increment
* value starting at 1.
* @return This snippet string.
*/
appendTabstop(number?: number): SnippetString;
/**
* Builder-function that appends a placeholder (`${1:value}`) to
* the {@linkcode SnippetString.value value} of this snippet string.
*
* @param value The value of this placeholder - either a string or a function
* with which a nested snippet can be created.
* @param number The number of this tabstop, defaults to an auto-increment
* value starting at 1.
* @return This snippet string.
*/
appendPlaceholder(value: string | ((snippet: SnippetString) => any), number?: number): SnippetString;
/**
* Builder-function that appends a choice (`${1|a,b,c|}`) to
* the {@linkcode SnippetString.value value} of this snippet string.
*
* @param values The values for choices - the array of strings
* @param number The number of this tabstop, defaults to an auto-increment
* value starting at 1.
* @return This snippet string.
*/
appendChoice(values: string[], number?: number): SnippetString;
/**
* Builder-function that appends a variable (`${VAR}`) to
* the {@linkcode SnippetString.value value} of this snippet string.
*
* @param name The name of the variable - excluding the `$`.
* @param defaultValue The default value which is used when the variable name cannot
* be resolved - either a string or a function with which a nested snippet can be created.
* @return This snippet string.
*/
appendVariable(name: string, defaultValue: string | ((snippet: SnippetString) => any)): SnippetString;
}
/**
* The rename provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [rename](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved#_rename-symbol)-feature.
*/
export interface RenameProvider {
/**
* Provide an edit that describes changes that have to be made to one
* or many resources to rename a symbol to a different name.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param newName The new name of the symbol. If the given name is not valid, the provider must return a rejected promise.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A workspace edit or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideRenameEdits(document: TextDocument, position: Position, newName: string, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<WorkspaceEdit>;
/**
* Optional function for resolving and validating a position *before* running rename. The result can
* be a range or a range and a placeholder text. The placeholder text should be the identifier of the symbol
* which is being renamed - when omitted the text in the returned range is used.
*
* *Note: * This function should throw an error or return a rejected thenable when the provided location
* doesn't allow for a rename.
*
* @param document The document in which rename will be invoked.
* @param position The position at which rename will be invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The range or range and placeholder text of the identifier that is to be renamed. The lack of a result can signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
prepareRename?(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Range | { range: Range, placeholder: string }>;
}
/**
* A semantic tokens legend contains the needed information to decipher
* the integer encoded representation of semantic tokens.
*/
export class SemanticTokensLegend {
/**
* The possible token types.
*/
readonly tokenTypes: string[];
/**
* The possible token modifiers.
*/
readonly tokenModifiers: string[];
constructor(tokenTypes: string[], tokenModifiers?: string[]);
}
/**
* A semantic tokens builder can help with creating a `SemanticTokens` instance
* which contains delta encoded semantic tokens.
*/
export class SemanticTokensBuilder {
constructor(legend?: SemanticTokensLegend);
/**
* Add another token.
*
* @param line The token start line number (absolute value).
* @param char The token start character (absolute value).
* @param length The token length in characters.
* @param tokenType The encoded token type.
* @param tokenModifiers The encoded token modifiers.
*/
push(line: number, char: number, length: number, tokenType: number, tokenModifiers?: number): void;
/**
* Add another token. Use only when providing a legend.
*
* @param range The range of the token. Must be single-line.
* @param tokenType The token type.
* @param tokenModifiers The token modifiers.
*/
push(range: Range, tokenType: string, tokenModifiers?: string[]): void;
/**
* Finish and create a `SemanticTokens` instance.
*/
build(resultId?: string): SemanticTokens;
}
/**
* Represents semantic tokens, either in a range or in an entire document.
* @see {@link DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokens provideDocumentSemanticTokens} for an explanation of the format.
* @see {@link SemanticTokensBuilder} for a helper to create an instance.
*/
export class SemanticTokens {
/**
* The result id of the tokens.
*
* This is the id that will be passed to `DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits` (if implemented).
*/
readonly resultId: string | undefined;
/**
* The actual tokens data.
* @see {@link DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokens provideDocumentSemanticTokens} for an explanation of the format.
*/
readonly data: Uint32Array;
constructor(data: Uint32Array, resultId?: string);
}
/**
* Represents edits to semantic tokens.
* @see {@link DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits} for an explanation of the format.
*/
export class SemanticTokensEdits {
/**
* The result id of the tokens.
*
* This is the id that will be passed to `DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits` (if implemented).
*/
readonly resultId: string | undefined;
/**
* The edits to the tokens data.
* All edits refer to the initial data state.
*/
readonly edits: SemanticTokensEdit[];
constructor(edits: SemanticTokensEdit[], resultId?: string);
}
/**
* Represents an edit to semantic tokens.
* @see {@link DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits} for an explanation of the format.
*/
export class SemanticTokensEdit {
/**
* The start offset of the edit.
*/
readonly start: number;
/**
* The count of elements to remove.
*/
readonly deleteCount: number;
/**
* The elements to insert.
*/
readonly data: Uint32Array | undefined;
constructor(start: number, deleteCount: number, data?: Uint32Array);
}
/**
* The document semantic tokens provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* semantic tokens.
*/
export interface DocumentSemanticTokensProvider {
/**
* An optional event to signal that the semantic tokens from this provider have changed.
*/
onDidChangeSemanticTokens?: Event<void>;
/**
* Tokens in a file are represented as an array of integers. The position of each token is expressed relative to
* the token before it, because most tokens remain stable relative to each other when edits are made in a file.
*
* ---
* In short, each token takes 5 integers to represent, so a specific token `i` in the file consists of the following array indices:
* - at index `5*i` - `deltaLine`: token line number, relative to the previous token
* - at index `5*i+1` - `deltaStart`: token start character, relative to the previous token (relative to 0 or the previous token's start if they are on the same line)
* - at index `5*i+2` - `length`: the length of the token. A token cannot be multiline.
* - at index `5*i+3` - `tokenType`: will be looked up in `SemanticTokensLegend.tokenTypes`. We currently ask that `tokenType` < 65536.
* - at index `5*i+4` - `tokenModifiers`: each set bit will be looked up in `SemanticTokensLegend.tokenModifiers`
*
* ---
* ### How to encode tokens
*
* Here is an example for encoding a file with 3 tokens in a uint32 array:
* ```
* { line: 2, startChar: 5, length: 3, tokenType: "property", tokenModifiers: ["private", "static"] },
* { line: 2, startChar: 10, length: 4, tokenType: "type", tokenModifiers: [] },
* { line: 5, startChar: 2, length: 7, tokenType: "class", tokenModifiers: [] }
* ```
*
* 1. First of all, a legend must be devised. This legend must be provided up-front and capture all possible token types.
* For this example, we will choose the following legend which must be passed in when registering the provider:
* ```
* tokenTypes: ['property', 'type', 'class'],
* tokenModifiers: ['private', 'static']
* ```
*
* 2. The first transformation step is to encode `tokenType` and `tokenModifiers` as integers using the legend. Token types are looked
* up by index, so a `tokenType` value of `1` means `tokenTypes[1]`. Multiple token modifiers can be set by using bit flags,
* so a `tokenModifier` value of `3` is first viewed as binary `0b00000011`, which means `[tokenModifiers[0], tokenModifiers[1]]` because
* bits 0 and 1 are set. Using this legend, the tokens now are:
* ```
* { line: 2, startChar: 5, length: 3, tokenType: 0, tokenModifiers: 3 },
* { line: 2, startChar: 10, length: 4, tokenType: 1, tokenModifiers: 0 },
* { line: 5, startChar: 2, length: 7, tokenType: 2, tokenModifiers: 0 }
* ```
*
* 3. The next step is to represent each token relative to the previous token in the file. In this case, the second token
* is on the same line as the first token, so the `startChar` of the second token is made relative to the `startChar`
* of the first token, so it will be `10 - 5`. The third token is on a different line than the second token, so the
* `startChar` of the third token will not be altered:
* ```
* { deltaLine: 2, deltaStartChar: 5, length: 3, tokenType: 0, tokenModifiers: 3 },
* { deltaLine: 0, deltaStartChar: 5, length: 4, tokenType: 1, tokenModifiers: 0 },
* { deltaLine: 3, deltaStartChar: 2, length: 7, tokenType: 2, tokenModifiers: 0 }
* ```
*
* 4. Finally, the last step is to inline each of the 5 fields for a token in a single array, which is a memory friendly representation:
* ```
* // 1st token, 2nd token, 3rd token
* [ 2,5,3,0,3, 0,5,4,1,0, 3,2,7,2,0 ]
* ```
*
* @see {@link SemanticTokensBuilder} for a helper to encode tokens as integers.
* *NOTE*: When doing edits, it is possible that multiple edits occur until the editor decides to invoke the semantic tokens provider.
* *NOTE*: If the provider cannot temporarily compute semantic tokens, it can indicate this by throwing an error with the message 'Busy'.
*/
provideDocumentSemanticTokens(document: TextDocument, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<SemanticTokens>;
/**
* Instead of always returning all the tokens in a file, it is possible for a `DocumentSemanticTokensProvider` to implement
* this method (`provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits`) and then return incremental updates to the previously provided semantic tokens.
*
* ---
* ### How tokens change when the document changes
*
* Suppose that `provideDocumentSemanticTokens` has previously returned the following semantic tokens:
* ```
* // 1st token, 2nd token, 3rd token
* [ 2,5,3,0,3, 0,5,4,1,0, 3,2,7,2,0 ]
* ```
*
* Also suppose that after some edits, the new semantic tokens in a file are:
* ```
* // 1st token, 2nd token, 3rd token
* [ 3,5,3,0,3, 0,5,4,1,0, 3,2,7,2,0 ]
* ```
* It is possible to express these new tokens in terms of an edit applied to the previous tokens:
* ```
* [ 2,5,3,0,3, 0,5,4,1,0, 3,2,7,2,0 ] // old tokens
* [ 3,5,3,0,3, 0,5,4,1,0, 3,2,7,2,0 ] // new tokens
*
* edit: { start: 0, deleteCount: 1, data: [3] } // replace integer at offset 0 with 3
* ```
*
* *NOTE*: If the provider cannot compute `SemanticTokensEdits`, it can "give up" and return all the tokens in the document again.
* *NOTE*: All edits in `SemanticTokensEdits` contain indices in the old integers array, so they all refer to the previous result state.
*/
provideDocumentSemanticTokensEdits?(document: TextDocument, previousResultId: string, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<SemanticTokens | SemanticTokensEdits>;
}
/**
* The document range semantic tokens provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* semantic tokens.
*/
export interface DocumentRangeSemanticTokensProvider {
/**
* @see {@link DocumentSemanticTokensProvider.provideDocumentSemanticTokens provideDocumentSemanticTokens}.
*/
provideDocumentRangeSemanticTokens(document: TextDocument, range: Range, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<SemanticTokens>;
}
/**
* Value-object describing what options formatting should use.
*/
export interface FormattingOptions {
/**
* Size of a tab in spaces.
*/
tabSize: number;
/**
* Prefer spaces over tabs.
*/
insertSpaces: boolean;
/**
* Signature for further properties.
*/
[key: string]: boolean | number | string;
}
/**
* The document formatting provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the formatting-feature.
*/
export interface DocumentFormattingEditProvider {
/**
* Provide formatting edits for a whole document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param options Options controlling formatting.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A set of text edits or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideDocumentFormattingEdits(document: TextDocument, options: FormattingOptions, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TextEdit[]>;
}
/**
* The document formatting provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the formatting-feature.
*/
export interface DocumentRangeFormattingEditProvider {
/**
* Provide formatting edits for a range in a document.
*
* The given range is a hint and providers can decide to format a smaller
* or larger range. Often this is done by adjusting the start and end
* of the range to full syntax nodes.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param range The range which should be formatted.
* @param options Options controlling formatting.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A set of text edits or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideDocumentRangeFormattingEdits(document: TextDocument, range: Range, options: FormattingOptions, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TextEdit[]>;
}
/**
* The document formatting provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the formatting-feature.
*/
export interface OnTypeFormattingEditProvider {
/**
* Provide formatting edits after a character has been typed.
*
* The given position and character should hint to the provider
* what range the position to expand to, like find the matching `{`
* when `}` has been entered.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param ch The character that has been typed.
* @param options Options controlling formatting.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A set of text edits or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideOnTypeFormattingEdits(document: TextDocument, position: Position, ch: string, options: FormattingOptions, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TextEdit[]>;
}
/**
* Represents a parameter of a callable-signature. A parameter can
* have a label and a doc-comment.
*/
export class ParameterInformation {
/**
* The label of this signature.
*
* Either a string or inclusive start and exclusive end offsets within its containing
* {@link SignatureInformation.label signature label}. *Note*: A label of type string must be
* a substring of its containing signature information's {@link SignatureInformation.label label}.
*/
label: string | [number, number];
/**
* The human-readable doc-comment of this signature. Will be shown
* in the UI but can be omitted.
*/
documentation?: string | MarkdownString;
/**
* Creates a new parameter information object.
*
* @param label A label string or inclusive start and exclusive end offsets within its containing signature label.
* @param documentation A doc string.
*/
constructor(label: string | [number, number], documentation?: string | MarkdownString);
}
/**
* Represents the signature of something callable. A signature
* can have a label, like a function-name, a doc-comment, and
* a set of parameters.
*/
export class SignatureInformation {
/**
* The label of this signature. Will be shown in
* the UI.
*/
label: string;
/**
* The human-readable doc-comment of this signature. Will be shown
* in the UI but can be omitted.
*/
documentation?: string | MarkdownString;
/**
* The parameters of this signature.
*/
parameters: ParameterInformation[];
/**
* The index of the active parameter.
*
* If provided, this is used in place of {@linkcode SignatureHelp.activeSignature}.
*/
activeParameter?: number;
/**
* Creates a new signature information object.
*
* @param label A label string.
* @param documentation A doc string.
*/
constructor(label: string, documentation?: string | MarkdownString);
}
/**
* Signature help represents the signature of something
* callable. There can be multiple signatures but only one
* active and only one active parameter.
*/
export class SignatureHelp {
/**
* One or more signatures.
*/
signatures: SignatureInformation[];
/**
* The active signature.
*/
activeSignature: number;
/**
* The active parameter of the active signature.
*/
activeParameter: number;
}
/**
* How a {@linkcode SignatureHelpProvider} was triggered.
*/
export enum SignatureHelpTriggerKind {
/**
* Signature help was invoked manually by the user or by a command.
*/
Invoke = 1,
/**
* Signature help was triggered by a trigger character.
*/
TriggerCharacter = 2,
/**
* Signature help was triggered by the cursor moving or by the document content changing.
*/
ContentChange = 3,
}
/**
* Additional information about the context in which a
* {@linkcode SignatureHelpProvider.provideSignatureHelp SignatureHelpProvider} was triggered.
*/
export interface SignatureHelpContext {
/**
* Action that caused signature help to be triggered.
*/
readonly triggerKind: SignatureHelpTriggerKind;
/**
* Character that caused signature help to be triggered.
*
* This is `undefined` when signature help is not triggered by typing, such as when manually invoking
* signature help or when moving the cursor.
*/
readonly triggerCharacter: string | undefined;
/**
* `true` if signature help was already showing when it was triggered.
*
* Retriggers occur when the signature help is already active and can be caused by actions such as
* typing a trigger character, a cursor move, or document content changes.
*/
readonly isRetrigger: boolean;
/**
* The currently active {@linkcode SignatureHelp}.
*
* The `activeSignatureHelp` has its [`SignatureHelp.activeSignature`] field updated based on
* the user arrowing through available signatures.
*/
readonly activeSignatureHelp: SignatureHelp | undefined;
}
/**
* The signature help provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the [parameter hints](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/intellisense)-feature.
*/
export interface SignatureHelpProvider {
/**
* Provide help for the signature at the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @param context Information about how signature help was triggered.
*
* @return Signature help or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideSignatureHelp(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken, context: SignatureHelpContext): ProviderResult<SignatureHelp>;
}
/**
* Metadata about a registered {@linkcode SignatureHelpProvider}.
*/
export interface SignatureHelpProviderMetadata {
/**
* List of characters that trigger signature help.
*/
readonly triggerCharacters: readonly string[];
/**
* List of characters that re-trigger signature help.
*
* These trigger characters are only active when signature help is already showing. All trigger characters
* are also counted as re-trigger characters.
*/
readonly retriggerCharacters: readonly string[];
}
/**
* A structured label for a {@link CompletionItem completion item}.
*/
export interface CompletionItemLabel {
/**
* The label of this completion item.
*
* By default this is also the text that is inserted when this completion is selected.
*/
label: string;
/**
* An optional string which is rendered less prominently directly after {@link CompletionItemLabel.label label},
* without any spacing. Should be used for function signatures or type annotations.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* An optional string which is rendered less prominently after {@link CompletionItemLabel.detail}. Should be used
* for fully qualified names or file path.
*/
description?: string;
}
/**
* Completion item kinds.
*/
export enum CompletionItemKind {
Text = 0,
Method = 1,
Function = 2,
Constructor = 3,
Field = 4,
Variable = 5,
Class = 6,
Interface = 7,
Module = 8,
Property = 9,
Unit = 10,
Value = 11,
Enum = 12,
Keyword = 13,
Snippet = 14,
Color = 15,
Reference = 17,
File = 16,
Folder = 18,
EnumMember = 19,
Constant = 20,
Struct = 21,
Event = 22,
Operator = 23,
TypeParameter = 24,
User = 25,
Issue = 26,
}
/**
* Completion item tags are extra annotations that tweak the rendering of a completion
* item.
*/
export enum CompletionItemTag {
/**
* Render a completion as obsolete, usually using a strike-out.
*/
Deprecated = 1
}
/**
* A completion item represents a text snippet that is proposed to complete text that is being typed.
*
* It is sufficient to create a completion item from just a {@link CompletionItem.label label}. In that
* case the completion item will replace the {@link TextDocument.getWordRangeAtPosition word}
* until the cursor with the given label or {@link CompletionItem.insertText insertText}. Otherwise the
* given {@link CompletionItem.textEdit edit} is used.
*
* When selecting a completion item in the editor its defined or synthesized text edit will be applied
* to *all* cursors/selections whereas {@link CompletionItem.additionalTextEdits additionalTextEdits} will be
* applied as provided.
*
* @see {@link CompletionItemProvider.provideCompletionItems}
* @see {@link CompletionItemProvider.resolveCompletionItem}
*/
export class CompletionItem {
/**
* The label of this completion item. By default
* this is also the text that is inserted when selecting
* this completion.
*/
label: string | CompletionItemLabel;
/**
* The kind of this completion item. Based on the kind
* an icon is chosen by the editor.
*/
kind?: CompletionItemKind;
/**
* Tags for this completion item.
*/
tags?: readonly CompletionItemTag[];
/**
* A human-readable string with additional information
* about this item, like type or symbol information.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* A human-readable string that represents a doc-comment.
*/
documentation?: string | MarkdownString;
/**
* A string that should be used when comparing this item
* with other items. When `falsy` the {@link CompletionItem.label label}
* is used.
*
* Note that `sortText` is only used for the initial ordering of completion
* items. When having a leading word (prefix) ordering is based on how
* well completions match that prefix and the initial ordering is only used
* when completions match equally well. The prefix is defined by the
* {@linkcode CompletionItem.range range}-property and can therefore be different
* for each completion.
*/
sortText?: string;
/**
* A string that should be used when filtering a set of
* completion items. When `falsy` the {@link CompletionItem.label label}
* is used.
*
* Note that the filter text is matched against the leading word (prefix) which is defined
* by the {@linkcode CompletionItem.range range}-property.
*/
filterText?: string;
/**
* Select this item when showing. *Note* that only one completion item can be selected and
* that the editor decides which item that is. The rule is that the *first* item of those
* that match best is selected.
*/
preselect?: boolean;
/**
* A string or snippet that should be inserted in a document when selecting
* this completion. When `falsy` the {@link CompletionItem.label label}
* is used.
*/
insertText?: string | SnippetString;
/**
* A range or a insert and replace range selecting the text that should be replaced by this completion item.
*
* When omitted, the range of the {@link TextDocument.getWordRangeAtPosition current word} is used as replace-range
* and as insert-range the start of the {@link TextDocument.getWordRangeAtPosition current word} to the
* current position is used.
*
* *Note 1:* A range must be a {@link Range.isSingleLine single line} and it must
* {@link Range.contains contain} the position at which completion has been {@link CompletionItemProvider.provideCompletionItems requested}.
* *Note 2:* A insert range must be a prefix of a replace range, that means it must be contained and starting at the same position.
*/
range?: Range | { inserting: Range; replacing: Range; };
/**
* An optional set of characters that when pressed while this completion is active will accept it first and
* then type that character. *Note* that all commit characters should have `length=1` and that superfluous
* characters will be ignored.
*/
commitCharacters?: string[];
/**
* Keep whitespace of the {@link CompletionItem.insertText insertText} as is. By default, the editor adjusts leading
* whitespace of new lines so that they match the indentation of the line for which the item is accepted - setting
* this to `true` will prevent that.
*/
keepWhitespace?: boolean;
/**
* @deprecated Use `CompletionItem.insertText` and `CompletionItem.range` instead.
*
* An {@link TextEdit edit} which is applied to a document when selecting
* this completion. When an edit is provided the value of
* {@link CompletionItem.insertText insertText} is ignored.
*
* The {@link Range} of the edit must be single-line and on the same
* line completions were {@link CompletionItemProvider.provideCompletionItems requested} at.
*/
textEdit?: TextEdit;
/**
* An optional array of additional {@link TextEdit text edits} that are applied when
* selecting this completion. Edits must not overlap with the main {@link CompletionItem.textEdit edit}
* nor with themselves.
*/
additionalTextEdits?: TextEdit[];
/**
* An optional {@link Command} that is executed *after* inserting this completion. *Note* that
* additional modifications to the current document should be described with the
* {@link CompletionItem.additionalTextEdits additionalTextEdits}-property.
*/
command?: Command;
/**
* Creates a new completion item.
*
* Completion items must have at least a {@link CompletionItem.label label} which then
* will be used as insert text as well as for sorting and filtering.
*
* @param label The label of the completion.
* @param kind The {@link CompletionItemKind kind} of the completion.
*/
constructor(label: string | CompletionItemLabel, kind?: CompletionItemKind);
}
/**
* Represents a collection of {@link CompletionItem completion items} to be presented
* in the editor.
*/
export class CompletionList<T extends CompletionItem = CompletionItem> {
/**
* This list is not complete. Further typing should result in recomputing
* this list.
*/
isIncomplete?: boolean;
/**
* The completion items.
*/
items: T[];
/**
* Creates a new completion list.
*
* @param items The completion items.
* @param isIncomplete The list is not complete.
*/
constructor(items?: T[], isIncomplete?: boolean);
}
/**
* How a {@link CompletionItemProvider completion provider} was triggered
*/
export enum CompletionTriggerKind {
/**
* Completion was triggered normally.
*/
Invoke = 0,
/**
* Completion was triggered by a trigger character.
*/
TriggerCharacter = 1,
/**
* Completion was re-triggered as current completion list is incomplete
*/
TriggerForIncompleteCompletions = 2
}
/**
* Contains additional information about the context in which
* {@link CompletionItemProvider.provideCompletionItems completion provider} is triggered.
*/
export interface CompletionContext {
/**
* How the completion was triggered.
*/
readonly triggerKind: CompletionTriggerKind;
/**
* Character that triggered the completion item provider.
*
* `undefined` if the provider was not triggered by a character.
*
* The trigger character is already in the document when the completion provider is triggered.
*/
readonly triggerCharacter: string | undefined;
}
/**
* The completion item provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* [IntelliSense](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/intellisense).
*
* Providers can delay the computation of the {@linkcode CompletionItem.detail detail}
* and {@linkcode CompletionItem.documentation documentation} properties by implementing the
* {@linkcode CompletionItemProvider.resolveCompletionItem resolveCompletionItem}-function. However, properties that
* are needed for the initial sorting and filtering, like `sortText`, `filterText`, `insertText`, and `range`, must
* not be changed during resolve.
*
* Providers are asked for completions either explicitly by a user gesture or -depending on the configuration-
* implicitly when typing words or trigger characters.
*/
export interface CompletionItemProvider<T extends CompletionItem = CompletionItem> {
/**
* Provide completion items for the given position and document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @param context How the completion was triggered.
*
* @return An array of completions, a {@link CompletionList completion list}, or a thenable that resolves to either.
* The lack of a result can be signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideCompletionItems(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken, context: CompletionContext): ProviderResult<T[] | CompletionList<T>>;
/**
* Given a completion item fill in more data, like {@link CompletionItem.documentation doc-comment}
* or {@link CompletionItem.detail details}.
*
* The editor will only resolve a completion item once.
*
* *Note* that this function is called when completion items are already showing in the UI or when an item has been
* selected for insertion. Because of that, no property that changes the presentation (label, sorting, filtering etc)
* or the (primary) insert behaviour ({@link CompletionItem.insertText insertText}) can be changed.
*
* This function may fill in {@link CompletionItem.additionalTextEdits additionalTextEdits}. However, that means an item might be
* inserted *before* resolving is done and in that case the editor will do a best effort to still apply those additional
* text edits.
*
* @param item A completion item currently active in the UI.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved completion item or a thenable that resolves to of such. It is OK to return the given
* `item`. When no result is returned, the given `item` will be used.
*/
resolveCompletionItem?(item: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T>;
}
/**
* A document link is a range in a text document that links to an internal or external resource, like another
* text document or a web site.
*/
export class DocumentLink {
/**
* The range this link applies to.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The uri this link points to.
*/
target?: Uri;
/**
* The tooltip text when you hover over this link.
*
* If a tooltip is provided, is will be displayed in a string that includes instructions on how to
* trigger the link, such as `{0} (ctrl + click)`. The specific instructions vary depending on OS,
* user settings, and localization.
*/
tooltip?: string;
/**
* Creates a new document link.
*
* @param range The range the document link applies to. Must not be empty.
* @param target The uri the document link points to.
*/
constructor(range: Range, target?: Uri);
}
/**
* The document link provider defines the contract between extensions and feature of showing
* links in the editor.
*/
export interface DocumentLinkProvider<T extends DocumentLink = DocumentLink> {
/**
* Provide links for the given document. Note that the editor ships with a default provider that detects
* `http(s)` and `file` links.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of {@link DocumentLink document links} or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result
* can be signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideDocumentLinks(document: TextDocument, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T[]>;
/**
* Given a link fill in its {@link DocumentLink.target target}. This method is called when an incomplete
* link is selected in the UI. Providers can implement this method and return incomplete links
* (without target) from the {@linkcode DocumentLinkProvider.provideDocumentLinks provideDocumentLinks} method which
* often helps to improve performance.
*
* @param link The link that is to be resolved.
* @param token A cancellation token.
*/
resolveDocumentLink?(link: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T>;
}
/**
* Represents a color in RGBA space.
*/
export class Color {
/**
* The red component of this color in the range [0-1].
*/
readonly red: number;
/**
* The green component of this color in the range [0-1].
*/
readonly green: number;
/**
* The blue component of this color in the range [0-1].
*/
readonly blue: number;
/**
* The alpha component of this color in the range [0-1].
*/
readonly alpha: number;
/**
* Creates a new color instance.
*
* @param red The red component.
* @param green The green component.
* @param blue The blue component.
* @param alpha The alpha component.
*/
constructor(red: number, green: number, blue: number, alpha: number);
}
/**
* Represents a color range from a document.
*/
export class ColorInformation {
/**
* The range in the document where this color appears.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The actual color value for this color range.
*/
color: Color;
/**
* Creates a new color range.
*
* @param range The range the color appears in. Must not be empty.
* @param color The value of the color.
* @param format The format in which this color is currently formatted.
*/
constructor(range: Range, color: Color);
}
/**
* A color presentation object describes how a {@linkcode Color} should be represented as text and what
* edits are required to refer to it from source code.
*
* For some languages one color can have multiple presentations, e.g. css can represent the color red with
* the constant `Red`, the hex-value `#ff0000`, or in rgba and hsla forms. In csharp other representations
* apply, e.g. `System.Drawing.Color.Red`.
*/
export class ColorPresentation {
/**
* The label of this color presentation. It will be shown on the color
* picker header. By default this is also the text that is inserted when selecting
* this color presentation.
*/
label: string;
/**
* An {@link TextEdit edit} which is applied to a document when selecting
* this presentation for the color. When `falsy` the {@link ColorPresentation.label label}
* is used.
*/
textEdit?: TextEdit;
/**
* An optional array of additional {@link TextEdit text edits} that are applied when
* selecting this color presentation. Edits must not overlap with the main {@link ColorPresentation.textEdit edit} nor with themselves.
*/
additionalTextEdits?: TextEdit[];
/**
* Creates a new color presentation.
*
* @param label The label of this color presentation.
*/
constructor(label: string);
}
/**
* The document color provider defines the contract between extensions and feature of
* picking and modifying colors in the editor.
*/
export interface DocumentColorProvider {
/**
* Provide colors for the given document.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of {@link ColorInformation color information} or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result
* can be signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideDocumentColors(document: TextDocument, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<ColorInformation[]>;
/**
* Provide {@link ColorPresentation representations} for a color.
*
* @param color The color to show and insert.
* @param context A context object with additional information
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of color presentations or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result
* can be signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
provideColorPresentations(color: Color, context: { document: TextDocument, range: Range }, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<ColorPresentation[]>;
}
/**
* A line based folding range. To be valid, start and end line must be bigger than zero and smaller than the number of lines in the document.
* Invalid ranges will be ignored.
*/
export class FoldingRange {
/**
* The zero-based start line of the range to fold. The folded area starts after the line's last character.
* To be valid, the end must be zero or larger and smaller than the number of lines in the document.
*/
start: number;
/**
* The zero-based end line of the range to fold. The folded area ends with the line's last character.
* To be valid, the end must be zero or larger and smaller than the number of lines in the document.
*/
end: number;
/**
* Describes the {@link FoldingRangeKind Kind} of the folding range such as {@link FoldingRangeKind.Comment Comment} or
* {@link FoldingRangeKind.Region Region}. The kind is used to categorize folding ranges and used by commands
* like 'Fold all comments'. See
* {@link FoldingRangeKind} for an enumeration of all kinds.
* If not set, the range is originated from a syntax element.
*/
kind?: FoldingRangeKind;
/**
* Creates a new folding range.
*
* @param start The start line of the folded range.
* @param end The end line of the folded range.
* @param kind The kind of the folding range.
*/
constructor(start: number, end: number, kind?: FoldingRangeKind);
}
/**
* An enumeration of specific folding range kinds. The kind is an optional field of a {@link FoldingRange}
* and is used to distinguish specific folding ranges such as ranges originated from comments. The kind is used by commands like
* `Fold all comments` or `Fold all regions`.
* If the kind is not set on the range, the range originated from a syntax element other than comments, imports or region markers.
*/
export enum FoldingRangeKind {
/**
* Kind for folding range representing a comment.
*/
Comment = 1,
/**
* Kind for folding range representing a import.
*/
Imports = 2,
/**
* Kind for folding range representing regions originating from folding markers like `#region` and `#endregion`.
*/
Region = 3
}
/**
* Folding context (for future use)
*/
export interface FoldingContext {
}
/**
* The folding range provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* [Folding](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/codebasics#_folding) in the editor.
*/
export interface FoldingRangeProvider {
/**
* An optional event to signal that the folding ranges from this provider have changed.
*/
onDidChangeFoldingRanges?: Event<void>;
/**
* Returns a list of folding ranges or null and undefined if the provider
* does not want to participate or was cancelled.
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param context Additional context information (for future use)
* @param token A cancellation token.
*/
provideFoldingRanges(document: TextDocument, context: FoldingContext, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<FoldingRange[]>;
}
/**
* A selection range represents a part of a selection hierarchy. A selection range
* may have a parent selection range that contains it.
*/
export class SelectionRange {
/**
* The {@link Range} of this selection range.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The parent selection range containing this range.
*/
parent?: SelectionRange;
/**
* Creates a new selection range.
*
* @param range The range of the selection range.
* @param parent The parent of the selection range.
*/
constructor(range: Range, parent?: SelectionRange);
}
export interface SelectionRangeProvider {
/**
* Provide selection ranges for the given positions.
*
* Selection ranges should be computed individually and independent for each position. The editor will merge
* and deduplicate ranges but providers must return hierarchies of selection ranges so that a range
* is {@link Range.contains contained} by its parent.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param positions The positions at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return Selection ranges or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideSelectionRanges(document: TextDocument, positions: Position[], token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<SelectionRange[]>;
}
/**
* Represents programming constructs like functions or constructors in the context
* of call hierarchy.
*/
export class CallHierarchyItem {
/**
* The name of this item.
*/
name: string;
/**
* The kind of this item.
*/
kind: SymbolKind;
/**
* Tags for this item.
*/
tags?: readonly SymbolTag[];
/**
* More detail for this item, e.g. the signature of a function.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* The resource identifier of this item.
*/
uri: Uri;
/**
* The range enclosing this symbol not including leading/trailing whitespace but everything else, e.g. comments and code.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The range that should be selected and revealed when this symbol is being picked, e.g. the name of a function.
* Must be contained by the {@linkcode CallHierarchyItem.range range}.
*/
selectionRange: Range;
/**
* Creates a new call hierarchy item.
*/
constructor(kind: SymbolKind, name: string, detail: string, uri: Uri, range: Range, selectionRange: Range);
}
/**
* Represents an incoming call, e.g. a caller of a method or constructor.
*/
export class CallHierarchyIncomingCall {
/**
* The item that makes the call.
*/
from: CallHierarchyItem;
/**
* The range at which at which the calls appears. This is relative to the caller
* denoted by {@linkcode CallHierarchyIncomingCall.from this.from}.
*/
fromRanges: Range[];
/**
* Create a new call object.
*
* @param item The item making the call.
* @param fromRanges The ranges at which the calls appear.
*/
constructor(item: CallHierarchyItem, fromRanges: Range[]);
}
/**
* Represents an outgoing call, e.g. calling a getter from a method or a method from a constructor etc.
*/
export class CallHierarchyOutgoingCall {
/**
* The item that is called.
*/
to: CallHierarchyItem;
/**
* The range at which this item is called. This is the range relative to the caller, e.g the item
* passed to {@linkcode CallHierarchyProvider.provideCallHierarchyOutgoingCalls provideCallHierarchyOutgoingCalls}
* and not {@linkcode CallHierarchyOutgoingCall.to this.to}.
*/
fromRanges: Range[];
/**
* Create a new call object.
*
* @param item The item being called
* @param fromRanges The ranges at which the calls appear.
*/
constructor(item: CallHierarchyItem, fromRanges: Range[]);
}
/**
* The call hierarchy provider interface describes the contract between extensions
* and the call hierarchy feature which allows to browse calls and caller of function,
* methods, constructor etc.
*/
export interface CallHierarchyProvider {
/**
* Bootstraps call hierarchy by returning the item that is denoted by the given document
* and position. This item will be used as entry into the call graph. Providers should
* return `undefined` or `null` when there is no item at the given location.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns One or multiple call hierarchy items or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
prepareCallHierarchy(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<CallHierarchyItem | CallHierarchyItem[]>;
/**
* Provide all incoming calls for an item, e.g all callers for a method. In graph terms this describes directed
* and annotated edges inside the call graph, e.g the given item is the starting node and the result is the nodes
* that can be reached.
*
* @param item The hierarchy item for which incoming calls should be computed.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns A set of incoming calls or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideCallHierarchyIncomingCalls(item: CallHierarchyItem, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<CallHierarchyIncomingCall[]>;
/**
* Provide all outgoing calls for an item, e.g call calls to functions, methods, or constructors from the given item. In
* graph terms this describes directed and annotated edges inside the call graph, e.g the given item is the starting
* node and the result is the nodes that can be reached.
*
* @param item The hierarchy item for which outgoing calls should be computed.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns A set of outgoing calls or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideCallHierarchyOutgoingCalls(item: CallHierarchyItem, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<CallHierarchyOutgoingCall[]>;
}
/**
* Represents an item of a type hierarchy, like a class or an interface.
*/
export class TypeHierarchyItem {
/**
* The name of this item.
*/
name: string;
/**
* The kind of this item.
*/
kind: SymbolKind;
/**
* Tags for this item.
*/
tags?: ReadonlyArray<SymbolTag>;
/**
* More detail for this item, e.g. the signature of a function.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* The resource identifier of this item.
*/
uri: Uri;
/**
* The range enclosing this symbol not including leading/trailing whitespace
* but everything else, e.g. comments and code.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The range that should be selected and revealed when this symbol is being
* picked, e.g. the name of a class. Must be contained by the {@link TypeHierarchyItem.range range}-property.
*/
selectionRange: Range;
/**
* Creates a new type hierarchy item.
*
* @param kind The kind of the item.
* @param name The name of the item.
* @param detail The details of the item.
* @param uri The Uri of the item.
* @param range The whole range of the item.
* @param selectionRange The selection range of the item.
*/
constructor(kind: SymbolKind, name: string, detail: string, uri: Uri, range: Range, selectionRange: Range);
}
/**
* The type hierarchy provider interface describes the contract between extensions
* and the type hierarchy feature.
*/
export interface TypeHierarchyProvider {
/**
* Bootstraps type hierarchy by returning the item that is denoted by the given document
* and position. This item will be used as entry into the type graph. Providers should
* return `undefined` or `null` when there is no item at the given location.
*
* @param document The document in which the command was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the command was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns One or multiple type hierarchy items or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined`, `null`, or an empty array.
*/
prepareTypeHierarchy(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TypeHierarchyItem | TypeHierarchyItem[]>;
/**
* Provide all supertypes for an item, e.g all types from which a type is derived/inherited. In graph terms this describes directed
* and annotated edges inside the type graph, e.g the given item is the starting node and the result is the nodes
* that can be reached.
*
* @param item The hierarchy item for which super types should be computed.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns A set of direct supertypes or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideTypeHierarchySupertypes(item: TypeHierarchyItem, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TypeHierarchyItem[]>;
/**
* Provide all subtypes for an item, e.g all types which are derived/inherited from the given item. In
* graph terms this describes directed and annotated edges inside the type graph, e.g the given item is the starting
* node and the result is the nodes that can be reached.
*
* @param item The hierarchy item for which subtypes should be computed.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns A set of direct subtypes or a thenable that resolves to such. The lack of a result can be
* signaled by returning `undefined` or `null`.
*/
provideTypeHierarchySubtypes(item: TypeHierarchyItem, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TypeHierarchyItem[]>;
}
/**
* Represents a list of ranges that can be edited together along with a word pattern to describe valid range contents.
*/
export class LinkedEditingRanges {
/**
* Create a new linked editing ranges object.
*
* @param ranges A list of ranges that can be edited together
* @param wordPattern An optional word pattern that describes valid contents for the given ranges
*/
constructor(ranges: Range[], wordPattern?: RegExp);
/**
* A list of ranges that can be edited together. The ranges must have
* identical length and text content. The ranges cannot overlap.
*/
readonly ranges: Range[];
/**
* An optional word pattern that describes valid contents for the given ranges.
* If no pattern is provided, the language configuration's word pattern will be used.
*/
readonly wordPattern?: RegExp;
}
/**
* The linked editing range provider interface defines the contract between extensions and
* the linked editing feature.
*/
export interface LinkedEditingRangeProvider {
/**
* For a given position in a document, returns the range of the symbol at the position and all ranges
* that have the same content. A change to one of the ranges can be applied to all other ranges if the new content
* is valid. An optional word pattern can be returned with the result to describe valid contents.
* If no result-specific word pattern is provided, the word pattern from the language configuration is used.
*
* @param document The document in which the provider was invoked.
* @param position The position at which the provider was invoked.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A list of ranges that can be edited together
*/
provideLinkedEditingRanges(document: TextDocument, position: Position, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<LinkedEditingRanges>;
}
/**
* A tuple of two characters, like a pair of
* opening and closing brackets.
*/
export type CharacterPair = [string, string];
/**
* Describes how comments for a language work.
*/
export interface CommentRule {
/**
* The line comment token, like `// this is a comment`
*/
lineComment?: string;
/**
* The block comment character pair, like `/* block comment *&#47;`
*/
blockComment?: CharacterPair;
}
/**
* Describes indentation rules for a language.
*/
export interface IndentationRule {
/**
* If a line matches this pattern, then all the lines after it should be unindented once (until another rule matches).
*/
decreaseIndentPattern: RegExp;
/**
* If a line matches this pattern, then all the lines after it should be indented once (until another rule matches).
*/
increaseIndentPattern: RegExp;
/**
* If a line matches this pattern, then **only the next line** after it should be indented once.
*/
indentNextLinePattern?: RegExp;
/**
* If a line matches this pattern, then its indentation should not be changed and it should not be evaluated against the other rules.
*/
unIndentedLinePattern?: RegExp;
}
/**
* Describes what to do with the indentation when pressing Enter.
*/
export enum IndentAction {
/**
* Insert new line and copy the previous line's indentation.
*/
None = 0,
/**
* Insert new line and indent once (relative to the previous line's indentation).
*/
Indent = 1,
/**
* Insert two new lines:
* - the first one indented which will hold the cursor
* - the second one at the same indentation level
*/
IndentOutdent = 2,
/**
* Insert new line and outdent once (relative to the previous line's indentation).
*/
Outdent = 3
}
/**
* Describes what to do when pressing Enter.
*/
export interface EnterAction {
/**
* Describe what to do with the indentation.
*/
indentAction: IndentAction;
/**
* Describes text to be appended after the new line and after the indentation.
*/
appendText?: string;
/**
* Describes the number of characters to remove from the new line's indentation.
*/
removeText?: number;
}
/**
* Describes a rule to be evaluated when pressing Enter.
*/
export interface OnEnterRule {
/**
* This rule will only execute if the text before the cursor matches this regular expression.
*/
beforeText: RegExp;
/**
* This rule will only execute if the text after the cursor matches this regular expression.
*/
afterText?: RegExp;
/**
* This rule will only execute if the text above the current line matches this regular expression.
*/
previousLineText?: RegExp;
/**
* The action to execute.
*/
action: EnterAction;
}
/**
* The language configuration interfaces defines the contract between extensions
* and various editor features, like automatic bracket insertion, automatic indentation etc.
*/
export interface LanguageConfiguration {
/**
* The language's comment settings.
*/
comments?: CommentRule;
/**
* The language's brackets.
* This configuration implicitly affects pressing Enter around these brackets.
*/
brackets?: CharacterPair[];
/**
* The language's word definition.
* If the language supports Unicode identifiers (e.g. JavaScript), it is preferable
* to provide a word definition that uses exclusion of known separators.
* e.g.: A regex that matches anything except known separators (and dot is allowed to occur in a floating point number):
* /(-?\d*\.\d\w*)|([^\`\~\!\@\#\%\^\&\*\(\)\-\=\+\[\{\]\}\\\|\;\:\'\"\,\.\<\>\/\?\s]+)/g
*/
wordPattern?: RegExp;
/**
* The language's indentation settings.
*/
indentationRules?: IndentationRule;
/**
* The language's rules to be evaluated when pressing Enter.
*/
onEnterRules?: OnEnterRule[];
/**
* **Deprecated** Do not use.
*
* @deprecated Will be replaced by a better API soon.
*/
__electricCharacterSupport?: {
/**
* This property is deprecated and will be **ignored** from
* the editor.
* @deprecated
*/
brackets?: any;
/**
* This property is deprecated and not fully supported anymore by
* the editor (scope and lineStart are ignored).
* Use the autoClosingPairs property in the language configuration file instead.
* @deprecated
*/
docComment?: {
scope: string;
open: string;
lineStart: string;
close?: string;
};
};
/**
* **Deprecated** Do not use.
*
* @deprecated * Use the autoClosingPairs property in the language configuration file instead.
*/
__characterPairSupport?: {
autoClosingPairs: {
open: string;
close: string;
notIn?: string[];
}[];
};
}
/**
* The configuration target
*/
export enum ConfigurationTarget {
/**
* Global configuration
*/
Global = 1,
/**
* Workspace configuration
*/
Workspace = 2,
/**
* Workspace folder configuration
*/
WorkspaceFolder = 3
}
/**
* Represents the configuration. It is a merged view of
*
* - *Default Settings*
* - *Global (User) Settings*
* - *Workspace settings*
* - *Workspace Folder settings* - From one of the {@link workspace.workspaceFolders Workspace Folders} under which requested resource belongs to.
* - *Language settings* - Settings defined under requested language.
*
* The *effective* value (returned by {@linkcode WorkspaceConfiguration.get get}) is computed by overriding or merging the values in the following order:
*
* 1. `defaultValue` (if defined in `package.json` otherwise derived from the value's type)
* 1. `globalValue` (if defined)
* 1. `workspaceValue` (if defined)
* 1. `workspaceFolderValue` (if defined)
* 1. `defaultLanguageValue` (if defined)
* 1. `globalLanguageValue` (if defined)
* 1. `workspaceLanguageValue` (if defined)
* 1. `workspaceFolderLanguageValue` (if defined)
*
* **Note:** Only `object` value types are merged and all other value types are overridden.
*
* Example 1: Overriding
*
* ```ts
* defaultValue = 'on';
* globalValue = 'relative'
* workspaceFolderValue = 'off'
* value = 'off'
* ```
*
* Example 2: Language Values
*
* ```ts
* defaultValue = 'on';
* globalValue = 'relative'
* workspaceFolderValue = 'off'
* globalLanguageValue = 'on'
* value = 'on'
* ```
*
* Example 3: Object Values
*
* ```ts
* defaultValue = { "a": 1, "b": 2 };
* globalValue = { "b": 3, "c": 4 };
* value = { "a": 1, "b": 3, "c": 4 };
* ```
*
* *Note:* Workspace and Workspace Folder configurations contains `launch` and `tasks` settings. Their basename will be
* part of the section identifier. The following snippets shows how to retrieve all configurations
* from `launch.json`:
*
* ```ts
* // launch.json configuration
* const config = workspace.getConfiguration('launch', vscode.workspace.workspaceFolders[0].uri);
*
* // retrieve values
* const values = config.get('configurations');
* ```
*
* Refer to [Settings](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/getstarted/settings) for more information.
*/
export interface WorkspaceConfiguration {
/**
* Return a value from this configuration.
*
* @param section Configuration name, supports _dotted_ names.
* @return The value `section` denotes or `undefined`.
*/
get<T>(section: string): T | undefined;
/**
* Return a value from this configuration.
*
* @param section Configuration name, supports _dotted_ names.
* @param defaultValue A value should be returned when no value could be found, is `undefined`.
* @return The value `section` denotes or the default.
*/
get<T>(section: string, defaultValue: T): T;
/**
* Check if this configuration has a certain value.
*
* @param section Configuration name, supports _dotted_ names.
* @return `true` if the section doesn't resolve to `undefined`.
*/
has(section: string): boolean;
/**
* Retrieve all information about a configuration setting. A configuration value
* often consists of a *default* value, a global or installation-wide value,
* a workspace-specific value, folder-specific value
* and language-specific values (if {@link WorkspaceConfiguration} is scoped to a language).
*
* Also provides all language ids under which the given configuration setting is defined.
*
* *Note:* The configuration name must denote a leaf in the configuration tree
* (`editor.fontSize` vs `editor`) otherwise no result is returned.
*
* @param section Configuration name, supports _dotted_ names.
* @return Information about a configuration setting or `undefined`.
*/
inspect<T>(section: string): {
key: string;
defaultValue?: T;
globalValue?: T;
workspaceValue?: T,
workspaceFolderValue?: T,
defaultLanguageValue?: T;
globalLanguageValue?: T;
workspaceLanguageValue?: T;
workspaceFolderLanguageValue?: T;
languageIds?: string[];
} | undefined;
/**
* Update a configuration value. The updated configuration values are persisted.
*
* A value can be changed in
*
* - {@link ConfigurationTarget.Global Global settings}: Changes the value for all instances of the editor.
* - {@link ConfigurationTarget.Workspace Workspace settings}: Changes the value for current workspace, if available.
* - {@link ConfigurationTarget.WorkspaceFolder Workspace folder settings}: Changes the value for settings from one of the {@link workspace.workspaceFolders Workspace Folders} under which the requested resource belongs to.
* - Language settings: Changes the value for the requested languageId.
*
* *Note:* To remove a configuration value use `undefined`, like so: `config.update('somekey', undefined)`
*
* @param section Configuration name, supports _dotted_ names.
* @param value The new value.
* @param configurationTarget The {@link ConfigurationTarget configuration target} or a boolean value.
* - If `true` updates {@link ConfigurationTarget.Global Global settings}.
* - If `false` updates {@link ConfigurationTarget.Workspace Workspace settings}.
* - If `undefined` or `null` updates to {@link ConfigurationTarget.WorkspaceFolder Workspace folder settings} if configuration is resource specific,
* otherwise to {@link ConfigurationTarget.Workspace Workspace settings}.
* @param overrideInLanguage Whether to update the value in the scope of requested languageId or not.
* - If `true` updates the value under the requested languageId.
* - If `undefined` updates the value under the requested languageId only if the configuration is defined for the language.
* @throws error while updating
* - configuration which is not registered.
* - window configuration to workspace folder
* - configuration to workspace or workspace folder when no workspace is opened.
* - configuration to workspace folder when there is no workspace folder settings.
* - configuration to workspace folder when {@link WorkspaceConfiguration} is not scoped to a resource.
*/
update(section: string, value: any, configurationTarget?: ConfigurationTarget | boolean | null, overrideInLanguage?: boolean): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Readable dictionary that backs this configuration.
*/
readonly [key: string]: any;
}
/**
* Represents a location inside a resource, such as a line
* inside a text file.
*/
export class Location {
/**
* The resource identifier of this location.
*/
uri: Uri;
/**
* The document range of this location.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* Creates a new location object.
*
* @param uri The resource identifier.
* @param rangeOrPosition The range or position. Positions will be converted to an empty range.
*/
constructor(uri: Uri, rangeOrPosition: Range | Position);
}
/**
* Represents the connection of two locations. Provides additional metadata over normal {@link Location locations},
* including an origin range.
*/
export interface LocationLink {
/**
* Span of the origin of this link.
*
* Used as the underlined span for mouse definition hover. Defaults to the word range at
* the definition position.
*/
originSelectionRange?: Range;
/**
* The target resource identifier of this link.
*/
targetUri: Uri;
/**
* The full target range of this link.
*/
targetRange: Range;
/**
* The span of this link.
*/
targetSelectionRange?: Range;
}
/**
* The event that is fired when diagnostics change.
*/
export interface DiagnosticChangeEvent {
/**
* An array of resources for which diagnostics have changed.
*/
readonly uris: readonly Uri[];
}
/**
* Represents the severity of diagnostics.
*/
export enum DiagnosticSeverity {
/**
* Something not allowed by the rules of a language or other means.
*/
Error = 0,
/**
* Something suspicious but allowed.
*/
Warning = 1,
/**
* Something to inform about but not a problem.
*/
Information = 2,
/**
* Something to hint to a better way of doing it, like proposing
* a refactoring.
*/
Hint = 3
}
/**
* Represents a related message and source code location for a diagnostic. This should be
* used to point to code locations that cause or related to a diagnostics, e.g. when duplicating
* a symbol in a scope.
*/
export class DiagnosticRelatedInformation {
/**
* The location of this related diagnostic information.
*/
location: Location;
/**
* The message of this related diagnostic information.
*/
message: string;
/**
* Creates a new related diagnostic information object.
*
* @param location The location.
* @param message The message.
*/
constructor(location: Location, message: string);
}
/**
* Additional metadata about the type of a diagnostic.
*/
export enum DiagnosticTag {
/**
* Unused or unnecessary code.
*
* Diagnostics with this tag are rendered faded out. The amount of fading
* is controlled by the `"editorUnnecessaryCode.opacity"` theme color. For
* example, `"editorUnnecessaryCode.opacity": "#000000c0"` will render the
* code with 75% opacity. For high contrast themes, use the
* `"editorUnnecessaryCode.border"` theme color to underline unnecessary code
* instead of fading it out.
*/
Unnecessary = 1,
/**
* Deprecated or obsolete code.
*
* Diagnostics with this tag are rendered with a strike through.
*/
Deprecated = 2,
}
/**
* Represents a diagnostic, such as a compiler error or warning. Diagnostic objects
* are only valid in the scope of a file.
*/
export class Diagnostic {
/**
* The range to which this diagnostic applies.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The human-readable message.
*/
message: string;
/**
* The severity, default is {@link DiagnosticSeverity.Error error}.
*/
severity: DiagnosticSeverity;
/**
* A human-readable string describing the source of this
* diagnostic, e.g. 'typescript' or 'super lint'.
*/
source?: string;
/**
* A code or identifier for this diagnostic.
* Should be used for later processing, e.g. when providing {@link CodeActionContext code actions}.
*/
code?: string | number | {
/**
* A code or identifier for this diagnostic.
* Should be used for later processing, e.g. when providing {@link CodeActionContext code actions}.
*/
value: string | number;
/**
* A target URI to open with more information about the diagnostic error.
*/
target: Uri;
};
/**
* An array of related diagnostic information, e.g. when symbol-names within
* a scope collide all definitions can be marked via this property.
*/
relatedInformation?: DiagnosticRelatedInformation[];
/**
* Additional metadata about the diagnostic.
*/
tags?: DiagnosticTag[];
/**
* Creates a new diagnostic object.
*
* @param range The range to which this diagnostic applies.
* @param message The human-readable message.
* @param severity The severity, default is {@link DiagnosticSeverity.Error error}.
*/
constructor(range: Range, message: string, severity?: DiagnosticSeverity);
}
/**
* A diagnostics collection is a container that manages a set of
* {@link Diagnostic diagnostics}. Diagnostics are always scopes to a
* diagnostics collection and a resource.
*
* To get an instance of a `DiagnosticCollection` use
* {@link languages.createDiagnosticCollection createDiagnosticCollection}.
*/
export interface DiagnosticCollection {
/**
* The name of this diagnostic collection, for instance `typescript`. Every diagnostic
* from this collection will be associated with this name. Also, the task framework uses this
* name when defining [problem matchers](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/tasks#_defining-a-problem-matcher).
*/
readonly name: string;
/**
* Assign diagnostics for given resource. Will replace
* existing diagnostics for that resource.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @param diagnostics Array of diagnostics or `undefined`
*/
set(uri: Uri, diagnostics: readonly Diagnostic[] | undefined): void;
/**
* Replace diagnostics for multiple resources in this collection.
*
* _Note_ that multiple tuples of the same uri will be merged, e.g
* `[[file1, [d1]], [file1, [d2]]]` is equivalent to `[[file1, [d1, d2]]]`.
* If a diagnostics item is `undefined` as in `[file1, undefined]`
* all previous but not subsequent diagnostics are removed.
*
* @param entries An array of tuples, like `[[file1, [d1, d2]], [file2, [d3, d4, d5]]]`, or `undefined`.
*/
set(entries: ReadonlyArray<[Uri, readonly Diagnostic[] | undefined]>): void;
/**
* Remove all diagnostics from this collection that belong
* to the provided `uri`. The same as `#set(uri, undefined)`.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
*/
delete(uri: Uri): void;
/**
* Remove all diagnostics from this collection. The same
* as calling `#set(undefined)`;
*/
clear(): void;
/**
* Iterate over each entry in this collection.
*
* @param callback Function to execute for each entry.
* @param thisArg The `this` context used when invoking the handler function.
*/
forEach(callback: (uri: Uri, diagnostics: readonly Diagnostic[], collection: DiagnosticCollection) => any, thisArg?: any): void;
/**
* Get the diagnostics for a given resource. *Note* that you cannot
* modify the diagnostics-array returned from this call.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @returns An immutable array of {@link Diagnostic diagnostics} or `undefined`.
*/
get(uri: Uri): readonly Diagnostic[] | undefined;
/**
* Check if this collection contains diagnostics for a
* given resource.
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @returns `true` if this collection has diagnostic for the given resource.
*/
has(uri: Uri): boolean;
/**
* Dispose and free associated resources. Calls
* {@link DiagnosticCollection.clear clear}.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Denotes a location of an editor in the window. Editors can be arranged in a grid
* and each column represents one editor location in that grid by counting the editors
* in order of their appearance.
*/
export enum ViewColumn {
/**
* A *symbolic* editor column representing the currently active column. This value
* can be used when opening editors, but the *resolved* {@link TextEditor.viewColumn viewColumn}-value
* of editors will always be `One`, `Two`, `Three`,... or `undefined` but never `Active`.
*/
Active = -1,
/**
* A *symbolic* editor column representing the column to the side of the active one. This value
* can be used when opening editors, but the *resolved* {@link TextEditor.viewColumn viewColumn}-value
* of editors will always be `One`, `Two`, `Three`,... or `undefined` but never `Beside`.
*/
Beside = -2,
/**
* The first editor column.
*/
One = 1,
/**
* The second editor column.
*/
Two = 2,
/**
* The third editor column.
*/
Three = 3,
/**
* The fourth editor column.
*/
Four = 4,
/**
* The fifth editor column.
*/
Five = 5,
/**
* The sixth editor column.
*/
Six = 6,
/**
* The seventh editor column.
*/
Seven = 7,
/**
* The eighth editor column.
*/
Eight = 8,
/**
* The ninth editor column.
*/
Nine = 9
}
/**
* An output channel is a container for readonly textual information.
*
* To get an instance of an `OutputChannel` use
* {@link window.createOutputChannel createOutputChannel}.
*/
export interface OutputChannel {
/**
* The human-readable name of this output channel.
*/
readonly name: string;
/**
* Append the given value to the channel.
*
* @param value A string, falsy values will not be printed.
*/
append(value: string): void;
/**
* Append the given value and a line feed character
* to the channel.
*
* @param value A string, falsy values will be printed.
*/
appendLine(value: string): void;
/**
* Removes all output from the channel.
*/
clear(): void;
/**
* Reveal this channel in the UI.
*
* @param preserveFocus When `true` the channel will not take focus.
*/
show(preserveFocus?: boolean): void;
/**
* Reveal this channel in the UI.
*
* @deprecated Use the overload with just one parameter (`show(preserveFocus?: boolean): void`).
*
* @param column This argument is **deprecated** and will be ignored.
* @param preserveFocus When `true` the channel will not take focus.
*/
show(column?: ViewColumn, preserveFocus?: boolean): void;
/**
* Hide this channel from the UI.
*/
hide(): void;
/**
* Dispose and free associated resources.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Accessibility information which controls screen reader behavior.
*/
export interface AccessibilityInformation {
/**
* Label to be read out by a screen reader once the item has focus.
*/
label: string;
/**
* Role of the widget which defines how a screen reader interacts with it.
* The role should be set in special cases when for example a tree-like element behaves like a checkbox.
* If role is not specified the editor will pick the appropriate role automatically.
* More about aria roles can be found here https://w3c.github.io/aria/#widget_roles
*/
role?: string;
}
/**
* Represents the alignment of status bar items.
*/
export enum StatusBarAlignment {
/**
* Aligned to the left side.
*/
Left = 1,
/**
* Aligned to the right side.
*/
Right = 2
}
/**
* A status bar item is a status bar contribution that can
* show text and icons and run a command on click.
*/
export interface StatusBarItem {
/**
* The identifier of this item.
*
* *Note*: if no identifier was provided by the {@linkcode window.createStatusBarItem}
* method, the identifier will match the {@link Extension.id extension identifier}.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The alignment of this item.
*/
readonly alignment: StatusBarAlignment;
/**
* The priority of this item. Higher value means the item should
* be shown more to the left.
*/
readonly priority: number | undefined;
/**
* The name of the entry, like 'Python Language Indicator', 'Git Status' etc.
* Try to keep the length of the name short, yet descriptive enough that
* users can understand what the status bar item is about.
*/
name: string | undefined;
/**
* The text to show for the entry. You can embed icons in the text by leveraging the syntax:
*
* `My text $(icon-name) contains icons like $(icon-name) this one.`
*
* Where the icon-name is taken from the ThemeIcon [icon set](https://code.visualstudio.com/api/references/icons-in-labels#icon-listing), e.g.
* `light-bulb`, `thumbsup`, `zap` etc.
*/
text: string;
/**
* The tooltip text when you hover over this entry.
*/
tooltip: string | MarkdownString | undefined;
/**
* The foreground color for this entry.
*/
color: string | ThemeColor | undefined;
/**
* The background color for this entry.
*
* *Note*: only the following colors are supported:
* * `new ThemeColor('statusBarItem.errorBackground')`
* * `new ThemeColor('statusBarItem.warningBackground')`
*
* More background colors may be supported in the future.
*
* *Note*: when a background color is set, the statusbar may override
* the `color` choice to ensure the entry is readable in all themes.
*/
backgroundColor: ThemeColor | undefined;
/**
* {@linkcode Command} or identifier of a command to run on click.
*
* The command must be {@link commands.getCommands known}.
*
* Note that if this is a {@linkcode Command} object, only the {@linkcode Command.command command} and {@linkcode Command.arguments arguments}
* are used by the editor.
*/
command: string | Command | undefined;
/**
* Accessibility information used when a screen reader interacts with this StatusBar item
*/
accessibilityInformation: AccessibilityInformation | undefined;
/**
* Shows the entry in the status bar.
*/
show(): void;
/**
* Hide the entry in the status bar.
*/
hide(): void;
/**
* Dispose and free associated resources. Call
* {@link StatusBarItem.hide hide}.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Defines a generalized way of reporting progress updates.
*/
export interface Progress<T> {
/**
* Report a progress update.
* @param value A progress item, like a message and/or an
* report on how much work finished
*/
report(value: T): void;
}
/**
* An individual terminal instance within the integrated terminal.
*/
export interface Terminal {
/**
* The name of the terminal.
*/
readonly name: string;
/**
* The process ID of the shell process.
*/
readonly processId: Thenable<number | undefined>;
/**
* The object used to initialize the terminal, this is useful for example to detecting the
* shell type of when the terminal was not launched by this extension or for detecting what
* folder the shell was launched in.
*/
readonly creationOptions: Readonly<TerminalOptions | ExtensionTerminalOptions>;
/**
* The exit status of the terminal, this will be undefined while the terminal is active.
*
* **Example:** Show a notification with the exit code when the terminal exits with a
* non-zero exit code.
* ```typescript
* window.onDidCloseTerminal(t => {
* if (t.exitStatus && t.exitStatus.code) {
* vscode.window.showInformationMessage(`Exit code: ${t.exitStatus.code}`);
* }
* });
* ```
*/
readonly exitStatus: TerminalExitStatus | undefined;
/**
* The current state of the {@link Terminal}.
*/
readonly state: TerminalState;
/**
* Send text to the terminal. The text is written to the stdin of the underlying pty process
* (shell) of the terminal.
*
* @param text The text to send.
* @param addNewLine Whether to add a new line to the text being sent, this is normally
* required to run a command in the terminal. The character(s) added are \n or \r\n
* depending on the platform. This defaults to `true`.
*/
sendText(text: string, addNewLine?: boolean): void;
/**
* Show the terminal panel and reveal this terminal in the UI.
*
* @param preserveFocus When `true` the terminal will not take focus.
*/
show(preserveFocus?: boolean): void;
/**
* Hide the terminal panel if this terminal is currently showing.
*/
hide(): void;
/**
* Dispose and free associated resources.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Represents the state of a {@link Terminal}.
*/
export interface TerminalState {
/**
* Whether the {@link Terminal} has been interacted with. Interaction means that the
* terminal has sent data to the process which depending on the terminal's _mode_. By
* default input is sent when a key is pressed or when a command or extension sends text,
* but based on the terminal's mode it can also happen on:
*
* - a pointer click event
* - a pointer scroll event
* - a pointer move event
* - terminal focus in/out
*
* For more information on events that can send data see "DEC Private Mode Set (DECSET)" on
* https://invisible-island.net/xterm/ctlseqs/ctlseqs.html
*/
readonly isInteractedWith: boolean;
}
/**
* Provides information on a line in a terminal in order to provide links for it.
*/
export interface TerminalLinkContext {
/**
* This is the text from the unwrapped line in the terminal.
*/
line: string;
/**
* The terminal the link belongs to.
*/
terminal: Terminal;
}
/**
* A provider that enables detection and handling of links within terminals.
*/
export interface TerminalLinkProvider<T extends TerminalLink = TerminalLink> {
/**
* Provide terminal links for the given context. Note that this can be called multiple times
* even before previous calls resolve, make sure to not share global objects (eg. `RegExp`)
* that could have problems when asynchronous usage may overlap.
* @param context Information about what links are being provided for.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A list of terminal links for the given line.
*/
provideTerminalLinks(context: TerminalLinkContext, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T[]>;
/**
* Handle an activated terminal link.
* @param link The link to handle.
*/
handleTerminalLink(link: T): ProviderResult<void>;
}
/**
* A link on a terminal line.
*/
export class TerminalLink {
/**
* The start index of the link on {@link TerminalLinkContext.line}.
*/
startIndex: number;
/**
* The length of the link on {@link TerminalLinkContext.line}.
*/
length: number;
/**
* The tooltip text when you hover over this link.
*
* If a tooltip is provided, is will be displayed in a string that includes instructions on
* how to trigger the link, such as `{0} (ctrl + click)`. The specific instructions vary
* depending on OS, user settings, and localization.
*/
tooltip?: string;
/**
* Creates a new terminal link.
* @param startIndex The start index of the link on {@link TerminalLinkContext.line}.
* @param length The length of the link on {@link TerminalLinkContext.line}.
* @param tooltip The tooltip text when you hover over this link.
*
* If a tooltip is provided, is will be displayed in a string that includes instructions on
* how to trigger the link, such as `{0} (ctrl + click)`. The specific instructions vary
* depending on OS, user settings, and localization.
*/
constructor(startIndex: number, length: number, tooltip?: string);
}
/**
* Provides a terminal profile for the contributed terminal profile when launched via the UI or
* command.
*/
export interface TerminalProfileProvider {
/**
* Provide the terminal profile.
* @param token A cancellation token that indicates the result is no longer needed.
* @returns The terminal profile.
*/
provideTerminalProfile(token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TerminalProfile>;
}
/**
* A terminal profile defines how a terminal will be launched.
*/
export class TerminalProfile {
/**
* The options that the terminal will launch with.
*/
options: TerminalOptions | ExtensionTerminalOptions;
/**
* Creates a new terminal profile.
* @param options The options that the terminal will launch with.
*/
constructor(options: TerminalOptions | ExtensionTerminalOptions);
}
/**
* A file decoration represents metadata that can be rendered with a file.
*/
export class FileDecoration {
/**
* A very short string that represents this decoration.
*/
badge?: string;
/**
* A human-readable tooltip for this decoration.
*/
tooltip?: string;
/**
* The color of this decoration.
*/
color?: ThemeColor;
/**
* A flag expressing that this decoration should be
* propagated to its parents.
*/
propagate?: boolean;
/**
* Creates a new decoration.
*
* @param badge A letter that represents the decoration.
* @param tooltip The tooltip of the decoration.
* @param color The color of the decoration.
*/
constructor(badge?: string, tooltip?: string, color?: ThemeColor);
}
/**
* The decoration provider interfaces defines the contract between extensions and
* file decorations.
*/
export interface FileDecorationProvider {
/**
* An optional event to signal that decorations for one or many files have changed.
*
* *Note* that this event should be used to propagate information about children.
*
* @see {@link EventEmitter}
*/
onDidChangeFileDecorations?: Event<undefined | Uri | Uri[]>;
/**
* Provide decorations for a given uri.
*
* *Note* that this function is only called when a file gets rendered in the UI.
* This means a decoration from a descendent that propagates upwards must be signaled
* to the editor via the {@link FileDecorationProvider.onDidChangeFileDecorations onDidChangeFileDecorations}-event.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file to provide a decoration for.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns A decoration or a thenable that resolves to such.
*/
provideFileDecoration(uri: Uri, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<FileDecoration>;
}
/**
* In a remote window the extension kind describes if an extension
* runs where the UI (window) runs or if an extension runs remotely.
*/
export enum ExtensionKind {
/**
* Extension runs where the UI runs.
*/
UI = 1,
/**
* Extension runs where the remote extension host runs.
*/
Workspace = 2
}
/**
* Represents an extension.
*
* To get an instance of an `Extension` use {@link extensions.getExtension getExtension}.
*/
export interface Extension<T> {
/**
* The canonical extension identifier in the form of: `publisher.name`.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The uri of the directory containing the extension.
*/
readonly extensionUri: Uri;
/**
* The absolute file path of the directory containing this extension. Shorthand
* notation for {@link Extension.extensionUri Extension.extensionUri.fsPath} (independent of the uri scheme).
*/
readonly extensionPath: string;
/**
* `true` if the extension has been activated.
*/
readonly isActive: boolean;
/**
* The parsed contents of the extension's package.json.
*/
readonly packageJSON: any;
/**
* The extension kind describes if an extension runs where the UI runs
* or if an extension runs where the remote extension host runs. The extension kind
* is defined in the `package.json`-file of extensions but can also be refined
* via the `remote.extensionKind`-setting. When no remote extension host exists,
* the value is {@linkcode ExtensionKind.UI}.
*/
extensionKind: ExtensionKind;
/**
* The public API exported by this extension. It is an invalid action
* to access this field before this extension has been activated.
*/
readonly exports: T;
/**
* Activates this extension and returns its public API.
*
* @return A promise that will resolve when this extension has been activated.
*/
activate(): Thenable<T>;
}
/**
* The ExtensionMode is provided on the `ExtensionContext` and indicates the
* mode the specific extension is running in.
*/
export enum ExtensionMode {
/**
* The extension is installed normally (for example, from the marketplace
* or VSIX) in the editor.
*/
Production = 1,
/**
* The extension is running from an `--extensionDevelopmentPath` provided
* when launching the editor.
*/
Development = 2,
/**
* The extension is running from an `--extensionTestsPath` and
* the extension host is running unit tests.
*/
Test = 3,
}
/**
* An extension context is a collection of utilities private to an
* extension.
*
* An instance of an `ExtensionContext` is provided as the first
* parameter to the `activate`-call of an extension.
*/
export interface ExtensionContext {
/**
* An array to which disposables can be added. When this
* extension is deactivated the disposables will be disposed.
*/
readonly subscriptions: { dispose(): any }[];
/**
* A memento object that stores state in the context
* of the currently opened {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace}.
*/
readonly workspaceState: Memento;
/**
* A memento object that stores state independent
* of the current opened {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace}.
*/
readonly globalState: Memento & {
/**
* Set the keys whose values should be synchronized across devices when synchronizing user-data
* like configuration, extensions, and mementos.
*
* Note that this function defines the whole set of keys whose values are synchronized:
* - calling it with an empty array stops synchronization for this memento
* - calling it with a non-empty array replaces all keys whose values are synchronized
*
* For any given set of keys this function needs to be called only once but there is no harm in
* repeatedly calling it.
*
* @param keys The set of keys whose values are synced.
*/
setKeysForSync(keys: readonly string[]): void;
};
/**
* A storage utility for secrets. Secrets are persisted across reloads and are independent of the
* current opened {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace}.
*/
readonly secrets: SecretStorage;
/**
* The uri of the directory containing the extension.
*/
readonly extensionUri: Uri;
/**
* The absolute file path of the directory containing the extension. Shorthand
* notation for {@link TextDocument.uri ExtensionContext.extensionUri.fsPath} (independent of the uri scheme).
*/
readonly extensionPath: string;
/**
* Gets the extension's environment variable collection for this workspace, enabling changes
* to be applied to terminal environment variables.
*/
readonly environmentVariableCollection: EnvironmentVariableCollection;
/**
* Get the absolute path of a resource contained in the extension.
*
* *Note* that an absolute uri can be constructed via {@linkcode Uri.joinPath} and
* {@linkcode ExtensionContext.extensionUri extensionUri}, e.g. `vscode.Uri.joinPath(context.extensionUri, relativePath);`
*
* @param relativePath A relative path to a resource contained in the extension.
* @return The absolute path of the resource.
*/
asAbsolutePath(relativePath: string): string;
/**
* The uri of a workspace specific directory in which the extension
* can store private state. The directory might not exist and creation is
* up to the extension. However, the parent directory is guaranteed to be existent.
* The value is `undefined` when no workspace nor folder has been opened.
*
* Use {@linkcode ExtensionContext.workspaceState workspaceState} or
* {@linkcode ExtensionContext.globalState globalState} to store key value data.
*
* @see {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs} for how to read and write files and folders from
* an uri.
*/
readonly storageUri: Uri | undefined;
/**
* An absolute file path of a workspace specific directory in which the extension
* can store private state. The directory might not exist on disk and creation is
* up to the extension. However, the parent directory is guaranteed to be existent.
*
* Use {@linkcode ExtensionContext.workspaceState workspaceState} or
* {@linkcode ExtensionContext.globalState globalState} to store key value data.
*
* @deprecated Use {@link ExtensionContext.storageUri storageUri} instead.
*/
readonly storagePath: string | undefined;
/**
* The uri of a directory in which the extension can store global state.
* The directory might not exist on disk and creation is
* up to the extension. However, the parent directory is guaranteed to be existent.
*
* Use {@linkcode ExtensionContext.globalState globalState} to store key value data.
*
* @see {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs} for how to read and write files and folders from
* an uri.
*/
readonly globalStorageUri: Uri;
/**
* An absolute file path in which the extension can store global state.
* The directory might not exist on disk and creation is
* up to the extension. However, the parent directory is guaranteed to be existent.
*
* Use {@linkcode ExtensionContext.globalState globalState} to store key value data.
*
* @deprecated Use {@link ExtensionContext.globalStorageUri globalStorageUri} instead.
*/
readonly globalStoragePath: string;
/**
* The uri of a directory in which the extension can create log files.
* The directory might not exist on disk and creation is up to the extension. However,
* the parent directory is guaranteed to be existent.
*
* @see {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs} for how to read and write files and folders from
* an uri.
*/
readonly logUri: Uri;
/**
* An absolute file path of a directory in which the extension can create log files.
* The directory might not exist on disk and creation is up to the extension. However,
* the parent directory is guaranteed to be existent.
*
* @deprecated Use {@link ExtensionContext.logUri logUri} instead.
*/
readonly logPath: string;
/**
* The mode the extension is running in. This is specific to the current
* extension. One extension may be in `ExtensionMode.Development` while
* other extensions in the host run in `ExtensionMode.Release`.
*/
readonly extensionMode: ExtensionMode;
/**
* The current `Extension` instance.
*/
readonly extension: Extension<any>;
}
/**
* A memento represents a storage utility. It can store and retrieve
* values.
*/
export interface Memento {
/**
* Returns the stored keys.
*
* @return The stored keys.
*/
keys(): readonly string[];
/**
* Return a value.
*
* @param key A string.
* @return The stored value or `undefined`.
*/
get<T>(key: string): T | undefined;
/**
* Return a value.
*
* @param key A string.
* @param defaultValue A value that should be returned when there is no
* value (`undefined`) with the given key.
* @return The stored value or the defaultValue.
*/
get<T>(key: string, defaultValue: T): T;
/**
* Store a value. The value must be JSON-stringifyable.
*
* *Note* that using `undefined` as value removes the key from the underlying
* storage.
*
* @param key A string.
* @param value A value. MUST not contain cyclic references.
*/
update(key: string, value: any): Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* The event data that is fired when a secret is added or removed.
*/
export interface SecretStorageChangeEvent {
/**
* The key of the secret that has changed.
*/
readonly key: string;
}
/**
* Represents a storage utility for secrets, information that is
* sensitive.
*/
export interface SecretStorage {
/**
* Retrieve a secret that was stored with key. Returns undefined if there
* is no password matching that key.
* @param key The key the secret was stored under.
* @returns The stored value or `undefined`.
*/
get(key: string): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Store a secret under a given key.
* @param key The key to store the secret under.
* @param value The secret.
*/
store(key: string, value: string): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Remove a secret from storage.
* @param key The key the secret was stored under.
*/
delete(key: string): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Fires when a secret is stored or deleted.
*/
onDidChange: Event<SecretStorageChangeEvent>;
}
/**
* Represents a color theme kind.
*/
export enum ColorThemeKind {
Light = 1,
Dark = 2,
HighContrast = 3
}
/**
* Represents a color theme.
*/
export interface ColorTheme {
/**
* The kind of this color theme: light, dark or high contrast.
*/
readonly kind: ColorThemeKind;
}
/**
* Controls the behaviour of the terminal's visibility.
*/
export enum TaskRevealKind {
/**
* Always brings the terminal to front if the task is executed.
*/
Always = 1,
/**
* Only brings the terminal to front if a problem is detected executing the task
* (e.g. the task couldn't be started because).
*/
Silent = 2,
/**
* The terminal never comes to front when the task is executed.
*/
Never = 3
}
/**
* Controls how the task channel is used between tasks
*/
export enum TaskPanelKind {
/**
* Shares a panel with other tasks. This is the default.
*/
Shared = 1,
/**
* Uses a dedicated panel for this tasks. The panel is not
* shared with other tasks.
*/
Dedicated = 2,
/**
* Creates a new panel whenever this task is executed.
*/
New = 3
}
/**
* Controls how the task is presented in the UI.
*/
export interface TaskPresentationOptions {
/**
* Controls whether the task output is reveal in the user interface.
* Defaults to `RevealKind.Always`.
*/
reveal?: TaskRevealKind;
/**
* Controls whether the command associated with the task is echoed
* in the user interface.
*/
echo?: boolean;
/**
* Controls whether the panel showing the task output is taking focus.
*/
focus?: boolean;
/**
* Controls if the task panel is used for this task only (dedicated),
* shared between tasks (shared) or if a new panel is created on
* every task execution (new). Defaults to `TaskInstanceKind.Shared`
*/
panel?: TaskPanelKind;
/**
* Controls whether to show the "Terminal will be reused by tasks, press any key to close it" message.
*/
showReuseMessage?: boolean;
/**
* Controls whether the terminal is cleared before executing the task.
*/
clear?: boolean;
}
/**
* A grouping for tasks. The editor by default supports the
* 'Clean', 'Build', 'RebuildAll' and 'Test' group.
*/
export class TaskGroup {
/**
* The clean task group;
*/
static Clean: TaskGroup;
/**
* The build task group;
*/
static Build: TaskGroup;
/**
* The rebuild all task group;
*/
static Rebuild: TaskGroup;
/**
* The test all task group;
*/
static Test: TaskGroup;
/**
* Whether the task that is part of this group is the default for the group.
* This property cannot be set through API, and is controlled by a user's task configurations.
*/
readonly isDefault?: boolean;
/**
* The ID of the task group. Is one of TaskGroup.Clean.id, TaskGroup.Build.id, TaskGroup.Rebuild.id, or TaskGroup.Test.id.
*/
readonly id: string;
private constructor(id: string, label: string);
}
/**
* A structure that defines a task kind in the system.
* The value must be JSON-stringifyable.
*/
export interface TaskDefinition {
/**
* The task definition describing the task provided by an extension.
* Usually a task provider defines more properties to identify
* a task. They need to be defined in the package.json of the
* extension under the 'taskDefinitions' extension point. The npm
* task definition for example looks like this
* ```typescript
* interface NpmTaskDefinition extends TaskDefinition {
* script: string;
* }
* ```
*
* Note that type identifier starting with a '$' are reserved for internal
* usages and shouldn't be used by extensions.
*/
readonly type: string;
/**
* Additional attributes of a concrete task definition.
*/
[name: string]: any;
}
/**
* Options for a process execution
*/
export interface ProcessExecutionOptions {
/**
* The current working directory of the executed program or shell.
* If omitted the tools current workspace root is used.
*/
cwd?: string;
/**
* The additional environment of the executed program or shell. If omitted
* the parent process' environment is used. If provided it is merged with
* the parent process' environment.
*/
env?: { [key: string]: string };
}
/**
* The execution of a task happens as an external process
* without shell interaction.
*/
export class ProcessExecution {
/**
* Creates a process execution.
*
* @param process The process to start.
* @param options Optional options for the started process.
*/
constructor(process: string, options?: ProcessExecutionOptions);
/**
* Creates a process execution.
*
* @param process The process to start.
* @param args Arguments to be passed to the process.
* @param options Optional options for the started process.
*/
constructor(process: string, args: string[], options?: ProcessExecutionOptions);
/**
* The process to be executed.
*/
process: string;
/**
* The arguments passed to the process. Defaults to an empty array.
*/
args: string[];
/**
* The process options used when the process is executed.
* Defaults to undefined.
*/
options?: ProcessExecutionOptions;
}
/**
* The shell quoting options.
*/
export interface ShellQuotingOptions {
/**
* The character used to do character escaping. If a string is provided only spaces
* are escaped. If a `{ escapeChar, charsToEscape }` literal is provide all characters
* in `charsToEscape` are escaped using the `escapeChar`.
*/
escape?: string | {
/**
* The escape character.
*/
escapeChar: string;
/**
* The characters to escape.
*/
charsToEscape: string;
};
/**
* The character used for strong quoting. The string's length must be 1.
*/
strong?: string;
/**
* The character used for weak quoting. The string's length must be 1.
*/
weak?: string;
}
/**
* Options for a shell execution
*/
export interface ShellExecutionOptions {
/**
* The shell executable.
*/
executable?: string;
/**
* The arguments to be passed to the shell executable used to run the task. Most shells
* require special arguments to execute a command. For example `bash` requires the `-c`
* argument to execute a command, `PowerShell` requires `-Command` and `cmd` requires both
* `/d` and `/c`.
*/
shellArgs?: string[];
/**
* The shell quotes supported by this shell.
*/
shellQuoting?: ShellQuotingOptions;
/**
* The current working directory of the executed shell.
* If omitted the tools current workspace root is used.
*/
cwd?: string;
/**
* The additional environment of the executed shell. If omitted
* the parent process' environment is used. If provided it is merged with
* the parent process' environment.
*/
env?: { [key: string]: string };
}
/**
* Defines how an argument should be quoted if it contains
* spaces or unsupported characters.
*/
export enum ShellQuoting {
/**
* Character escaping should be used. This for example
* uses \ on bash and ` on PowerShell.
*/
Escape = 1,
/**
* Strong string quoting should be used. This for example
* uses " for Windows cmd and ' for bash and PowerShell.
* Strong quoting treats arguments as literal strings.
* Under PowerShell echo 'The value is $(2 * 3)' will
* print `The value is $(2 * 3)`
*/
Strong = 2,
/**
* Weak string quoting should be used. This for example
* uses " for Windows cmd, bash and PowerShell. Weak quoting
* still performs some kind of evaluation inside the quoted
* string. Under PowerShell echo "The value is $(2 * 3)"
* will print `The value is 6`
*/
Weak = 3
}
/**
* A string that will be quoted depending on the used shell.
*/
export interface ShellQuotedString {
/**
* The actual string value.
*/
value: string;
/**
* The quoting style to use.
*/
quoting: ShellQuoting;
}
export class ShellExecution {
/**
* Creates a shell execution with a full command line.
*
* @param commandLine The command line to execute.
* @param options Optional options for the started the shell.
*/
constructor(commandLine: string, options?: ShellExecutionOptions);
/**
* Creates a shell execution with a command and arguments. For the real execution the editor will
* construct a command line from the command and the arguments. This is subject to interpretation
* especially when it comes to quoting. If full control over the command line is needed please
* use the constructor that creates a `ShellExecution` with the full command line.
*
* @param command The command to execute.
* @param args The command arguments.
* @param options Optional options for the started the shell.
*/
constructor(command: string | ShellQuotedString, args: (string | ShellQuotedString)[], options?: ShellExecutionOptions);
/**
* The shell command line. Is `undefined` if created with a command and arguments.
*/
commandLine: string | undefined;
/**
* The shell command. Is `undefined` if created with a full command line.
*/
command: string | ShellQuotedString;
/**
* The shell args. Is `undefined` if created with a full command line.
*/
args: (string | ShellQuotedString)[];
/**
* The shell options used when the command line is executed in a shell.
* Defaults to undefined.
*/
options?: ShellExecutionOptions;
}
/**
* Class used to execute an extension callback as a task.
*/
export class CustomExecution {
/**
* Constructs a CustomExecution task object. The callback will be executed when the task is run, at which point the
* extension should return the Pseudoterminal it will "run in". The task should wait to do further execution until
* {@link Pseudoterminal.open} is called. Task cancellation should be handled using
* {@link Pseudoterminal.close}. When the task is complete fire
* {@link Pseudoterminal.onDidClose}.
* @param callback The callback that will be called when the task is started by a user. Any ${} style variables that
* were in the task definition will be resolved and passed into the callback as `resolvedDefinition`.
*/
constructor(callback: (resolvedDefinition: TaskDefinition) => Thenable<Pseudoterminal>);
}
/**
* The scope of a task.
*/
export enum TaskScope {
/**
* The task is a global task. Global tasks are currently not supported.
*/
Global = 1,
/**
* The task is a workspace task
*/
Workspace = 2
}
/**
* Run options for a task.
*/
export interface RunOptions {
/**
* Controls whether task variables are re-evaluated on rerun.
*/
reevaluateOnRerun?: boolean;
}
/**
* A task to execute
*/
export class Task {
/**
* Creates a new task.
*
* @param definition The task definition as defined in the taskDefinitions extension point.
* @param scope Specifies the task's scope. It is either a global or a workspace task or a task for a specific workspace folder. Global tasks are currently not supported.
* @param name The task's name. Is presented in the user interface.
* @param source The task's source (e.g. 'gulp', 'npm', ...). Is presented in the user interface.
* @param execution The process or shell execution.
* @param problemMatchers the names of problem matchers to use, like '$tsc'
* or '$eslint'. Problem matchers can be contributed by an extension using
* the `problemMatchers` extension point.
*/
constructor(taskDefinition: TaskDefinition, scope: WorkspaceFolder | TaskScope.Global | TaskScope.Workspace, name: string, source: string, execution?: ProcessExecution | ShellExecution | CustomExecution, problemMatchers?: string | string[]);
/**
* Creates a new task.
*
* @deprecated Use the new constructors that allow specifying a scope for the task.
*
* @param definition The task definition as defined in the taskDefinitions extension point.
* @param name The task's name. Is presented in the user interface.
* @param source The task's source (e.g. 'gulp', 'npm', ...). Is presented in the user interface.
* @param execution The process or shell execution.
* @param problemMatchers the names of problem matchers to use, like '$tsc'
* or '$eslint'. Problem matchers can be contributed by an extension using
* the `problemMatchers` extension point.
*/
constructor(taskDefinition: TaskDefinition, name: string, source: string, execution?: ProcessExecution | ShellExecution, problemMatchers?: string | string[]);
/**
* The task's definition.
*/
definition: TaskDefinition;
/**
* The task's scope.
*/
readonly scope?: TaskScope.Global | TaskScope.Workspace | WorkspaceFolder;
/**
* The task's name
*/
name: string;
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered less prominently on a separate line in places
* where the task's name is displayed. Supports rendering of {@link ThemeIcon theme icons}
* via the `$(<name>)`-syntax.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* The task's execution engine
*/
execution?: ProcessExecution | ShellExecution | CustomExecution;
/**
* Whether the task is a background task or not.
*/
isBackground: boolean;
/**
* A human-readable string describing the source of this shell task, e.g. 'gulp'
* or 'npm'. Supports rendering of {@link ThemeIcon theme icons} via the `$(<name>)`-syntax.
*/
source: string;
/**
* The task group this tasks belongs to. See TaskGroup
* for a predefined set of available groups.
* Defaults to undefined meaning that the task doesn't
* belong to any special group.
*/
group?: TaskGroup;
/**
* The presentation options. Defaults to an empty literal.
*/
presentationOptions: TaskPresentationOptions;
/**
* The problem matchers attached to the task. Defaults to an empty
* array.
*/
problemMatchers: string[];
/**
* Run options for the task
*/
runOptions: RunOptions;
}
/**
* A task provider allows to add tasks to the task service.
* A task provider is registered via {@link tasks.registerTaskProvider}.
*/
export interface TaskProvider<T extends Task = Task> {
/**
* Provides tasks.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return an array of tasks
*/
provideTasks(token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T[]>;
/**
* Resolves a task that has no {@linkcode Task.execution execution} set. Tasks are
* often created from information found in the `tasks.json`-file. Such tasks miss
* the information on how to execute them and a task provider must fill in
* the missing information in the `resolveTask`-method. This method will not be
* called for tasks returned from the above `provideTasks` method since those
* tasks are always fully resolved. A valid default implementation for the
* `resolveTask` method is to return `undefined`.
*
* Note that when filling in the properties of `task`, you _must_ be sure to
* use the exact same `TaskDefinition` and not create a new one. Other properties
* may be changed.
*
* @param task The task to resolve.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved task
*/
resolveTask(task: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<T>;
}
/**
* An object representing an executed Task. It can be used
* to terminate a task.
*
* This interface is not intended to be implemented.
*/
export interface TaskExecution {
/**
* The task that got started.
*/
task: Task;
/**
* Terminates the task execution.
*/
terminate(): void;
}
/**
* An event signaling the start of a task execution.
*
* This interface is not intended to be implemented.
*/
interface TaskStartEvent {
/**
* The task item representing the task that got started.
*/
readonly execution: TaskExecution;
}
/**
* An event signaling the end of an executed task.
*
* This interface is not intended to be implemented.
*/
interface TaskEndEvent {
/**
* The task item representing the task that finished.
*/
readonly execution: TaskExecution;
}
/**
* An event signaling the start of a process execution
* triggered through a task
*/
export interface TaskProcessStartEvent {
/**
* The task execution for which the process got started.
*/
readonly execution: TaskExecution;
/**
* The underlying process id.
*/
readonly processId: number;
}
/**
* An event signaling the end of a process execution
* triggered through a task
*/
export interface TaskProcessEndEvent {
/**
* The task execution for which the process got started.
*/
readonly execution: TaskExecution;
/**
* The process's exit code. Will be `undefined` when the task is terminated.
*/
readonly exitCode: number | undefined;
}
export interface TaskFilter {
/**
* The task version as used in the tasks.json file.
* The string support the package.json semver notation.
*/
version?: string;
/**
* The task type to return;
*/
type?: string;
}
/**
* Namespace for tasks functionality.
*/
export namespace tasks {
/**
* Register a task provider.
*
* @param type The task kind type this provider is registered for.
* @param provider A task provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerTaskProvider(type: string, provider: TaskProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Fetches all tasks available in the systems. This includes tasks
* from `tasks.json` files as well as tasks from task providers
* contributed through extensions.
*
* @param filter Optional filter to select tasks of a certain type or version.
*/
export function fetchTasks(filter?: TaskFilter): Thenable<Task[]>;
/**
* Executes a task that is managed by the editor. The returned
* task execution can be used to terminate the task.
*
* @throws When running a ShellExecution or a ProcessExecution
* task in an environment where a new process cannot be started.
* In such an environment, only CustomExecution tasks can be run.
*
* @param task the task to execute
*/
export function executeTask(task: Task): Thenable<TaskExecution>;
/**
* The currently active task executions or an empty array.
*/
export const taskExecutions: readonly TaskExecution[];
/**
* Fires when a task starts.
*/
export const onDidStartTask: Event<TaskStartEvent>;
/**
* Fires when a task ends.
*/
export const onDidEndTask: Event<TaskEndEvent>;
/**
* Fires when the underlying process has been started.
* This event will not fire for tasks that don't
* execute an underlying process.
*/
export const onDidStartTaskProcess: Event<TaskProcessStartEvent>;
/**
* Fires when the underlying process has ended.
* This event will not fire for tasks that don't
* execute an underlying process.
*/
export const onDidEndTaskProcess: Event<TaskProcessEndEvent>;
}
/**
* Enumeration of file types. The types `File` and `Directory` can also be
* a symbolic links, in that case use `FileType.File | FileType.SymbolicLink` and
* `FileType.Directory | FileType.SymbolicLink`.
*/
export enum FileType {
/**
* The file type is unknown.
*/
Unknown = 0,
/**
* A regular file.
*/
File = 1,
/**
* A directory.
*/
Directory = 2,
/**
* A symbolic link to a file.
*/
SymbolicLink = 64
}
export enum FilePermission {
/**
* The file is readonly.
*
* *Note:* All `FileStat` from a `FileSystemProvider` that is registered with
* the option `isReadonly: true` will be implicitly handled as if `FilePermission.Readonly`
* is set. As a consequence, it is not possible to have a readonly file system provider
* registered where some `FileStat` are not readonly.
*/
Readonly = 1
}
/**
* The `FileStat`-type represents metadata about a file
*/
export interface FileStat {
/**
* The type of the file, e.g. is a regular file, a directory, or symbolic link
* to a file.
*
* *Note:* This value might be a bitmask, e.g. `FileType.File | FileType.SymbolicLink`.
*/
type: FileType;
/**
* The creation timestamp in milliseconds elapsed since January 1, 1970 00:00:00 UTC.
*/
ctime: number;
/**
* The modification timestamp in milliseconds elapsed since January 1, 1970 00:00:00 UTC.
*
* *Note:* If the file changed, it is important to provide an updated `mtime` that advanced
* from the previous value. Otherwise there may be optimizations in place that will not show
* the updated file contents in an editor for example.
*/
mtime: number;
/**
* The size in bytes.
*
* *Note:* If the file changed, it is important to provide an updated `size`. Otherwise there
* may be optimizations in place that will not show the updated file contents in an editor for
* example.
*/
size: number;
/**
* The permissions of the file, e.g. whether the file is readonly.
*
* *Note:* This value might be a bitmask, e.g. `FilePermission.Readonly | FilePermission.Other`.
*/
permissions?: FilePermission;
}
/**
* A type that filesystem providers should use to signal errors.
*
* This class has factory methods for common error-cases, like `FileNotFound` when
* a file or folder doesn't exist, use them like so: `throw vscode.FileSystemError.FileNotFound(someUri);`
*/
export class FileSystemError extends Error {
/**
* Create an error to signal that a file or folder wasn't found.
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
static FileNotFound(messageOrUri?: string | Uri): FileSystemError;
/**
* Create an error to signal that a file or folder already exists, e.g. when
* creating but not overwriting a file.
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
static FileExists(messageOrUri?: string | Uri): FileSystemError;
/**
* Create an error to signal that a file is not a folder.
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
static FileNotADirectory(messageOrUri?: string | Uri): FileSystemError;
/**
* Create an error to signal that a file is a folder.
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
static FileIsADirectory(messageOrUri?: string | Uri): FileSystemError;
/**
* Create an error to signal that an operation lacks required permissions.
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
static NoPermissions(messageOrUri?: string | Uri): FileSystemError;
/**
* Create an error to signal that the file system is unavailable or too busy to
* complete a request.
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
static Unavailable(messageOrUri?: string | Uri): FileSystemError;
/**
* Creates a new filesystem error.
*
* @param messageOrUri Message or uri.
*/
constructor(messageOrUri?: string | Uri);
/**
* A code that identifies this error.
*
* Possible values are names of errors, like {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound},
* or `Unknown` for unspecified errors.
*/
readonly code: string;
}
/**
* Enumeration of file change types.
*/
export enum FileChangeType {
/**
* The contents or metadata of a file have changed.
*/
Changed = 1,
/**
* A file has been created.
*/
Created = 2,
/**
* A file has been deleted.
*/
Deleted = 3,
}
/**
* The event filesystem providers must use to signal a file change.
*/
export interface FileChangeEvent {
/**
* The type of change.
*/
readonly type: FileChangeType;
/**
* The uri of the file that has changed.
*/
readonly uri: Uri;
}
/**
* The filesystem provider defines what the editor needs to read, write, discover,
* and to manage files and folders. It allows extensions to serve files from remote places,
* like ftp-servers, and to seamlessly integrate those into the editor.
*
* * *Note 1:* The filesystem provider API works with {@link Uri uris} and assumes hierarchical
* paths, e.g. `foo:/my/path` is a child of `foo:/my/` and a parent of `foo:/my/path/deeper`.
* * *Note 2:* There is an activation event `onFileSystem:<scheme>` that fires when a file
* or folder is being accessed.
* * *Note 3:* The word 'file' is often used to denote all {@link FileType kinds} of files, e.g.
* folders, symbolic links, and regular files.
*/
export interface FileSystemProvider {
/**
* An event to signal that a resource has been created, changed, or deleted. This
* event should fire for resources that are being {@link FileSystemProvider.watch watched}
* by clients of this provider.
*
* *Note:* It is important that the metadata of the file that changed provides an
* updated `mtime` that advanced from the previous value in the {@link FileStat stat} and a
* correct `size` value. Otherwise there may be optimizations in place that will not show
* the change in an editor for example.
*/
readonly onDidChangeFile: Event<FileChangeEvent[]>;
/**
* Subscribe to events in the file or folder denoted by `uri`.
*
* The editor will call this function for files and folders. In the latter case, the
* options differ from defaults, e.g. what files/folders to exclude from watching
* and if subfolders, sub-subfolder, etc. should be watched (`recursive`).
*
* @param uri The uri of the file to be watched.
* @param options Configures the watch.
* @returns A disposable that tells the provider to stop watching the `uri`.
*/
watch(uri: Uri, options: { recursive: boolean; excludes: string[] }): Disposable;
/**
* Retrieve metadata about a file.
*
* Note that the metadata for symbolic links should be the metadata of the file they refer to.
* Still, the {@link FileType.SymbolicLink SymbolicLink}-type must be used in addition to the actual type, e.g.
* `FileType.SymbolicLink | FileType.Directory`.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file to retrieve metadata about.
* @return The file metadata about the file.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `uri` doesn't exist.
*/
stat(uri: Uri): FileStat | Thenable<FileStat>;
/**
* Retrieve all entries of a {@link FileType.Directory directory}.
*
* @param uri The uri of the folder.
* @return An array of name/type-tuples or a thenable that resolves to such.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `uri` doesn't exist.
*/
readDirectory(uri: Uri): [string, FileType][] | Thenable<[string, FileType][]>;
/**
* Create a new directory (Note, that new files are created via `write`-calls).
*
* @param uri The uri of the new folder.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when the parent of `uri` doesn't exist, e.g. no mkdirp-logic required.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileExists FileExists} when `uri` already exists.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.NoPermissions NoPermissions} when permissions aren't sufficient.
*/
createDirectory(uri: Uri): void | Thenable<void>;
/**
* Read the entire contents of a file.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file.
* @return An array of bytes or a thenable that resolves to such.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `uri` doesn't exist.
*/
readFile(uri: Uri): Uint8Array | Thenable<Uint8Array>;
/**
* Write data to a file, replacing its entire contents.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file.
* @param content The new content of the file.
* @param options Defines if missing files should or must be created.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `uri` doesn't exist and `create` is not set.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when the parent of `uri` doesn't exist and `create` is set, e.g. no mkdirp-logic required.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileExists FileExists} when `uri` already exists, `create` is set but `overwrite` is not set.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.NoPermissions NoPermissions} when permissions aren't sufficient.
*/
writeFile(uri: Uri, content: Uint8Array, options: { create: boolean, overwrite: boolean }): void | Thenable<void>;
/**
* Delete a file.
*
* @param uri The resource that is to be deleted.
* @param options Defines if deletion of folders is recursive.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `uri` doesn't exist.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.NoPermissions NoPermissions} when permissions aren't sufficient.
*/
delete(uri: Uri, options: { recursive: boolean }): void | Thenable<void>;
/**
* Rename a file or folder.
*
* @param oldUri The existing file.
* @param newUri The new location.
* @param options Defines if existing files should be overwritten.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `oldUri` doesn't exist.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when parent of `newUri` doesn't exist, e.g. no mkdirp-logic required.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileExists FileExists} when `newUri` exists and when the `overwrite` option is not `true`.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.NoPermissions NoPermissions} when permissions aren't sufficient.
*/
rename(oldUri: Uri, newUri: Uri, options: { overwrite: boolean }): void | Thenable<void>;
/**
* Copy files or folders. Implementing this function is optional but it will speedup
* the copy operation.
*
* @param source The existing file.
* @param destination The destination location.
* @param options Defines if existing files should be overwritten.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when `source` doesn't exist.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileNotFound FileNotFound} when parent of `destination` doesn't exist, e.g. no mkdirp-logic required.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.FileExists FileExists} when `destination` exists and when the `overwrite` option is not `true`.
* @throws {@linkcode FileSystemError.NoPermissions NoPermissions} when permissions aren't sufficient.
*/
copy?(source: Uri, destination: Uri, options: { overwrite: boolean }): void | Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* The file system interface exposes the editor's built-in and contributed
* {@link FileSystemProvider file system providers}. It allows extensions to work
* with files from the local disk as well as files from remote places, like the
* remote extension host or ftp-servers.
*
* *Note* that an instance of this interface is available as {@linkcode workspace.fs}.
*/
export interface FileSystem {
/**
* Retrieve metadata about a file.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file to retrieve metadata about.
* @return The file metadata about the file.
*/
stat(uri: Uri): Thenable<FileStat>;
/**
* Retrieve all entries of a {@link FileType.Directory directory}.
*
* @param uri The uri of the folder.
* @return An array of name/type-tuples or a thenable that resolves to such.
*/
readDirectory(uri: Uri): Thenable<[string, FileType][]>;
/**
* Create a new directory (Note, that new files are created via `write`-calls).
*
* *Note* that missing directories are created automatically, e.g this call has
* `mkdirp` semantics.
*
* @param uri The uri of the new folder.
*/
createDirectory(uri: Uri): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Read the entire contents of a file.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file.
* @return An array of bytes or a thenable that resolves to such.
*/
readFile(uri: Uri): Thenable<Uint8Array>;
/**
* Write data to a file, replacing its entire contents.
*
* @param uri The uri of the file.
* @param content The new content of the file.
*/
writeFile(uri: Uri, content: Uint8Array): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Delete a file.
*
* @param uri The resource that is to be deleted.
* @param options Defines if trash can should be used and if deletion of folders is recursive
*/
delete(uri: Uri, options?: { recursive?: boolean, useTrash?: boolean }): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Rename a file or folder.
*
* @param oldUri The existing file.
* @param newUri The new location.
* @param options Defines if existing files should be overwritten.
*/
rename(source: Uri, target: Uri, options?: { overwrite?: boolean }): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Copy files or folders.
*
* @param source The existing file.
* @param destination The destination location.
* @param options Defines if existing files should be overwritten.
*/
copy(source: Uri, target: Uri, options?: { overwrite?: boolean }): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Check if a given file system supports writing files.
*
* Keep in mind that just because a file system supports writing, that does
* not mean that writes will always succeed. There may be permissions issues
* or other errors that prevent writing a file.
*
* @param scheme The scheme of the filesystem, for example `file` or `git`.
*
* @return `true` if the file system supports writing, `false` if it does not
* support writing (i.e. it is readonly), and `undefined` if the editor does not
* know about the filesystem.
*/
isWritableFileSystem(scheme: string): boolean | undefined;
}
/**
* Defines a port mapping used for localhost inside the webview.
*/
export interface WebviewPortMapping {
/**
* Localhost port to remap inside the webview.
*/
readonly webviewPort: number;
/**
* Destination port. The `webviewPort` is resolved to this port.
*/
readonly extensionHostPort: number;
}
/**
* Content settings for a webview.
*/
export interface WebviewOptions {
/**
* Controls whether scripts are enabled in the webview content or not.
*
* Defaults to false (scripts-disabled).
*/
readonly enableScripts?: boolean;
/**
* Controls whether forms are enabled in the webview content or not.
*
* Defaults to true if {@link enableScripts scripts are enabled}. Otherwise defaults to false.
* Explicitly setting this property to either true or false overrides the default.
*/
readonly enableForms?: boolean;
/**
* Controls whether command uris are enabled in webview content or not.
*
* Defaults to false.
*/
readonly enableCommandUris?: boolean;
/**
* Root paths from which the webview can load local (filesystem) resources using uris from `asWebviewUri`
*
* Default to the root folders of the current workspace plus the extension's install directory.
*
* Pass in an empty array to disallow access to any local resources.
*/
readonly localResourceRoots?: readonly Uri[];
/**
* Mappings of localhost ports used inside the webview.
*
* Port mapping allow webviews to transparently define how localhost ports are resolved. This can be used
* to allow using a static localhost port inside the webview that is resolved to random port that a service is
* running on.
*
* If a webview accesses localhost content, we recommend that you specify port mappings even if
* the `webviewPort` and `extensionHostPort` ports are the same.
*
* *Note* that port mappings only work for `http` or `https` urls. Websocket urls (e.g. `ws://localhost:3000`)
* cannot be mapped to another port.
*/
readonly portMapping?: readonly WebviewPortMapping[];
}
/**
* Displays html content, similarly to an iframe.
*/
export interface Webview {
/**
* Content settings for the webview.
*/
options: WebviewOptions;
/**
* HTML contents of the webview.
*
* This should be a complete, valid html document. Changing this property causes the webview to be reloaded.
*
* Webviews are sandboxed from normal extension process, so all communication with the webview must use
* message passing. To send a message from the extension to the webview, use {@linkcode Webview.postMessage postMessage}.
* To send message from the webview back to an extension, use the `acquireVsCodeApi` function inside the webview
* to get a handle to the editor's api and then call `.postMessage()`:
*
* ```html
* <script>
* const vscode = acquireVsCodeApi(); // acquireVsCodeApi can only be invoked once
* vscode.postMessage({ message: 'hello!' });
* </script>
* ```
*
* To load a resources from the workspace inside a webview, use the {@linkcode Webview.asWebviewUri asWebviewUri} method
* and ensure the resource's directory is listed in {@linkcode WebviewOptions.localResourceRoots}.
*
* Keep in mind that even though webviews are sandboxed, they still allow running scripts and loading arbitrary content,
* so extensions must follow all standard web security best practices when working with webviews. This includes
* properly sanitizing all untrusted input (including content from the workspace) and
* setting a [content security policy](https://aka.ms/vscode-api-webview-csp).
*/
html: string;
/**
* Fired when the webview content posts a message.
*
* Webview content can post strings or json serializable objects back to an extension. They cannot
* post `Blob`, `File`, `ImageData` and other DOM specific objects since the extension that receives the
* message does not run in a browser environment.
*/
readonly onDidReceiveMessage: Event<any>;
/**
* Post a message to the webview content.
*
* Messages are only delivered if the webview is live (either visible or in the
* background with `retainContextWhenHidden`).
*
* @param message Body of the message. This must be a string or other json serializable object.
*
* For older versions of vscode, if an `ArrayBuffer` is included in `message`,
* it will not be serialized properly and will not be received by the webview.
* Similarly any TypedArrays, such as a `Uint8Array`, will be very inefficiently
* serialized and will also not be recreated as a typed array inside the webview.
*
* However if your extension targets vscode 1.57+ in the `engines` field of its
* `package.json`, any `ArrayBuffer` values that appear in `message` will be more
* efficiently transferred to the webview and will also be correctly recreated inside
* of the webview.
*/
postMessage(message: any): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* Convert a uri for the local file system to one that can be used inside webviews.
*
* Webviews cannot directly load resources from the workspace or local file system using `file:` uris. The
* `asWebviewUri` function takes a local `file:` uri and converts it into a uri that can be used inside of
* a webview to load the same resource:
*
* ```ts
* webview.html = `<img src="${webview.asWebviewUri(vscode.Uri.file('/Users/codey/workspace/cat.gif'))}">`
* ```
*/
asWebviewUri(localResource: Uri): Uri;
/**
* Content security policy source for webview resources.
*
* This is the origin that should be used in a content security policy rule:
*
* ```ts
* `img-src https: ${webview.cspSource} ...;`
* ```
*/
readonly cspSource: string;
}
/**
* Content settings for a webview panel.
*/
export interface WebviewPanelOptions {
/**
* Controls if the find widget is enabled in the panel.
*
* Defaults to `false`.
*/
readonly enableFindWidget?: boolean;
/**
* Controls if the webview panel's content (iframe) is kept around even when the panel
* is no longer visible.
*
* Normally the webview panel's html context is created when the panel becomes visible
* and destroyed when it is hidden. Extensions that have complex state
* or UI can set the `retainContextWhenHidden` to make the editor keep the webview
* context around, even when the webview moves to a background tab. When a webview using
* `retainContextWhenHidden` becomes hidden, its scripts and other dynamic content are suspended.
* When the panel becomes visible again, the context is automatically restored
* in the exact same state it was in originally. You cannot send messages to a
* hidden webview, even with `retainContextWhenHidden` enabled.
*
* `retainContextWhenHidden` has a high memory overhead and should only be used if
* your panel's context cannot be quickly saved and restored.
*/
readonly retainContextWhenHidden?: boolean;
}
/**
* A panel that contains a webview.
*/
interface WebviewPanel {
/**
* Identifies the type of the webview panel, such as `'markdown.preview'`.
*/
readonly viewType: string;
/**
* Title of the panel shown in UI.
*/
title: string;
/**
* Icon for the panel shown in UI.
*/
iconPath?: Uri | { readonly light: Uri; readonly dark: Uri };
/**
* {@linkcode Webview} belonging to the panel.
*/
readonly webview: Webview;
/**
* Content settings for the webview panel.
*/
readonly options: WebviewPanelOptions;
/**
* Editor position of the panel. This property is only set if the webview is in
* one of the editor view columns.
*/
readonly viewColumn: ViewColumn | undefined;
/**
* Whether the panel is active (focused by the user).
*/
readonly active: boolean;
/**
* Whether the panel is visible.
*/
readonly visible: boolean;
/**
* Fired when the panel's view state changes.
*/
readonly onDidChangeViewState: Event<WebviewPanelOnDidChangeViewStateEvent>;
/**
* Fired when the panel is disposed.
*
* This may be because the user closed the panel or because `.dispose()` was
* called on it.
*
* Trying to use the panel after it has been disposed throws an exception.
*/
readonly onDidDispose: Event<void>;
/**
* Show the webview panel in a given column.
*
* A webview panel may only show in a single column at a time. If it is already showing, this
* method moves it to a new column.
*
* @param viewColumn View column to show the panel in. Shows in the current `viewColumn` if undefined.
* @param preserveFocus When `true`, the webview will not take focus.
*/
reveal(viewColumn?: ViewColumn, preserveFocus?: boolean): void;
/**
* Dispose of the webview panel.
*
* This closes the panel if it showing and disposes of the resources owned by the webview.
* Webview panels are also disposed when the user closes the webview panel. Both cases
* fire the `onDispose` event.
*/
dispose(): any;
}
/**
* Event fired when a webview panel's view state changes.
*/
export interface WebviewPanelOnDidChangeViewStateEvent {
/**
* Webview panel whose view state changed.
*/
readonly webviewPanel: WebviewPanel;
}
/**
* Restore webview panels that have been persisted when vscode shuts down.
*
* There are two types of webview persistence:
*
* - Persistence within a session.
* - Persistence across sessions (across restarts of the editor).
*
* A `WebviewPanelSerializer` is only required for the second case: persisting a webview across sessions.
*
* Persistence within a session allows a webview to save its state when it becomes hidden
* and restore its content from this state when it becomes visible again. It is powered entirely
* by the webview content itself. To save off a persisted state, call `acquireVsCodeApi().setState()` with
* any json serializable object. To restore the state again, call `getState()`
*
* ```js
* // Within the webview
* const vscode = acquireVsCodeApi();
*
* // Get existing state
* const oldState = vscode.getState() || { value: 0 };
*
* // Update state
* setState({ value: oldState.value + 1 })
* ```
*
* A `WebviewPanelSerializer` extends this persistence across restarts of the editor. When the editor is shutdown,
* it will save off the state from `setState` of all webviews that have a serializer. When the
* webview first becomes visible after the restart, this state is passed to `deserializeWebviewPanel`.
* The extension can then restore the old `WebviewPanel` from this state.
*
* @param T Type of the webview's state.
*/
interface WebviewPanelSerializer<T = unknown> {
/**
* Restore a webview panel from its serialized `state`.
*
* Called when a serialized webview first becomes visible.
*
* @param webviewPanel Webview panel to restore. The serializer should take ownership of this panel. The
* serializer must restore the webview's `.html` and hook up all webview events.
* @param state Persisted state from the webview content.
*
* @return Thenable indicating that the webview has been fully restored.
*/
deserializeWebviewPanel(webviewPanel: WebviewPanel, state: T): Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* A webview based view.
*/
export interface WebviewView {
/**
* Identifies the type of the webview view, such as `'hexEditor.dataView'`.
*/
readonly viewType: string;
/**
* The underlying webview for the view.
*/
readonly webview: Webview;
/**
* View title displayed in the UI.
*
* The view title is initially taken from the extension `package.json` contribution.
*/
title?: string;
/**
* Human-readable string which is rendered less prominently in the title.
*/
description?: string;
/**
* Event fired when the view is disposed.
*
* Views are disposed when they are explicitly hidden by a user (this happens when a user
* right clicks in a view and unchecks the webview view).
*
* Trying to use the view after it has been disposed throws an exception.
*/
readonly onDidDispose: Event<void>;
/**
* Tracks if the webview is currently visible.
*
* Views are visible when they are on the screen and expanded.
*/
readonly visible: boolean;
/**
* Event fired when the visibility of the view changes.
*
* Actions that trigger a visibility change:
*
* - The view is collapsed or expanded.
* - The user switches to a different view group in the sidebar or panel.
*
* Note that hiding a view using the context menu instead disposes of the view and fires `onDidDispose`.
*/
readonly onDidChangeVisibility: Event<void>;
/**
* Reveal the view in the UI.
*
* If the view is collapsed, this will expand it.
*
* @param preserveFocus When `true` the view will not take focus.
*/
show(preserveFocus?: boolean): void;
}
/**
* Additional information the webview view being resolved.
*
* @param T Type of the webview's state.
*/
interface WebviewViewResolveContext<T = unknown> {
/**
* Persisted state from the webview content.
*
* To save resources, the editor normally deallocates webview documents (the iframe content) that are not visible.
* For example, when the user collapse a view or switches to another top level activity in the sidebar, the
* `WebviewView` itself is kept alive but the webview's underlying document is deallocated. It is recreated when
* the view becomes visible again.
*
* You can prevent this behavior by setting `retainContextWhenHidden` in the `WebviewOptions`. However this
* increases resource usage and should be avoided wherever possible. Instead, you can use persisted state to
* save off a webview's state so that it can be quickly recreated as needed.
*
* To save off a persisted state, inside the webview call `acquireVsCodeApi().setState()` with
* any json serializable object. To restore the state again, call `getState()`. For example:
*
* ```js
* // Within the webview
* const vscode = acquireVsCodeApi();
*
* // Get existing state
* const oldState = vscode.getState() || { value: 0 };
*
* // Update state
* setState({ value: oldState.value + 1 })
* ```
*
* The editor ensures that the persisted state is saved correctly when a webview is hidden and across
* editor restarts.
*/
readonly state: T | undefined;
}
/**
* Provider for creating `WebviewView` elements.
*/
export interface WebviewViewProvider {
/**
* Revolves a webview view.
*
* `resolveWebviewView` is called when a view first becomes visible. This may happen when the view is
* first loaded or when the user hides and then shows a view again.
*
* @param webviewView Webview view to restore. The provider should take ownership of this view. The
* provider must set the webview's `.html` and hook up all webview events it is interested in.
* @param context Additional metadata about the view being resolved.
* @param token Cancellation token indicating that the view being provided is no longer needed.
*
* @return Optional thenable indicating that the view has been fully resolved.
*/
resolveWebviewView(webviewView: WebviewView, context: WebviewViewResolveContext, token: CancellationToken): Thenable<void> | void;
}
/**
* Provider for text based custom editors.
*
* Text based custom editors use a {@linkcode TextDocument} as their data model. This considerably simplifies
* implementing a custom editor as it allows the editor to handle many common operations such as
* undo and backup. The provider is responsible for synchronizing text changes between the webview and the `TextDocument`.
*/
export interface CustomTextEditorProvider {
/**
* Resolve a custom editor for a given text resource.
*
* This is called when a user first opens a resource for a `CustomTextEditorProvider`, or if they reopen an
* existing editor using this `CustomTextEditorProvider`.
*
*
* @param document Document for the resource to resolve.
*
* @param webviewPanel The webview panel used to display the editor UI for this resource.
*
* During resolve, the provider must fill in the initial html for the content webview panel and hook up all
* the event listeners on it that it is interested in. The provider can also hold onto the `WebviewPanel` to
* use later for example in a command. See {@linkcode WebviewPanel} for additional details.
*
* @param token A cancellation token that indicates the result is no longer needed.
*
* @return Thenable indicating that the custom editor has been resolved.
*/
resolveCustomTextEditor(document: TextDocument, webviewPanel: WebviewPanel, token: CancellationToken): Thenable<void> | void;
}
/**
* Represents a custom document used by a {@linkcode CustomEditorProvider}.
*
* Custom documents are only used within a given `CustomEditorProvider`. The lifecycle of a `CustomDocument` is
* managed by the editor. When no more references remain to a `CustomDocument`, it is disposed of.
*/
interface CustomDocument {
/**
* The associated uri for this document.
*/
readonly uri: Uri;
/**
* Dispose of the custom document.
*
* This is invoked by the editor when there are no more references to a given `CustomDocument` (for example when
* all editors associated with the document have been closed.)
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Event triggered by extensions to signal to the editor that an edit has occurred on an {@linkcode CustomDocument}.
*
* @see {@linkcode CustomEditorProvider.onDidChangeCustomDocument}.
*/
interface CustomDocumentEditEvent<T extends CustomDocument = CustomDocument> {
/**
* The document that the edit is for.
*/
readonly document: T;
/**
* Undo the edit operation.
*
* This is invoked by the editor when the user undoes this edit. To implement `undo`, your
* extension should restore the document and editor to the state they were in just before this
* edit was added to the editor's internal edit stack by `onDidChangeCustomDocument`.
*/
undo(): Thenable<void> | void;
/**
* Redo the edit operation.
*
* This is invoked by the editor when the user redoes this edit. To implement `redo`, your
* extension should restore the document and editor to the state they were in just after this
* edit was added to the editor's internal edit stack by `onDidChangeCustomDocument`.
*/
redo(): Thenable<void> | void;
/**
* Display name describing the edit.
*
* This will be shown to users in the UI for undo/redo operations.
*/
readonly label?: string;
}
/**
* Event triggered by extensions to signal to the editor that the content of a {@linkcode CustomDocument}
* has changed.
*
* @see {@linkcode CustomEditorProvider.onDidChangeCustomDocument}.
*/
interface CustomDocumentContentChangeEvent<T extends CustomDocument = CustomDocument> {
/**
* The document that the change is for.
*/
readonly document: T;
}
/**
* A backup for an {@linkcode CustomDocument}.
*/
interface CustomDocumentBackup {
/**
* Unique identifier for the backup.
*
* This id is passed back to your extension in `openCustomDocument` when opening a custom editor from a backup.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* Delete the current backup.
*
* This is called by the editor when it is clear the current backup is no longer needed, such as when a new backup
* is made or when the file is saved.
*/
delete(): void;
}
/**
* Additional information used to implement {@linkcode CustomEditableDocument.backup}.
*/
interface CustomDocumentBackupContext {
/**
* Suggested file location to write the new backup.
*
* Note that your extension is free to ignore this and use its own strategy for backup.
*
* If the editor is for a resource from the current workspace, `destination` will point to a file inside
* `ExtensionContext.storagePath`. The parent folder of `destination` may not exist, so make sure to created it
* before writing the backup to this location.
*/
readonly destination: Uri;
}
/**
* Additional information about the opening custom document.
*/
interface CustomDocumentOpenContext {
/**
* The id of the backup to restore the document from or `undefined` if there is no backup.
*
* If this is provided, your extension should restore the editor from the backup instead of reading the file
* from the user's workspace.
*/
readonly backupId: string | undefined;
/**
* If the URI is an untitled file, this will be populated with the byte data of that file
*
* If this is provided, your extension should utilize this byte data rather than executing fs APIs on the URI passed in
*/
readonly untitledDocumentData: Uint8Array | undefined;
}
/**
* Provider for readonly custom editors that use a custom document model.
*
* Custom editors use {@linkcode CustomDocument} as their document model instead of a {@linkcode TextDocument}.
*
* You should use this type of custom editor when dealing with binary files or more complex scenarios. For simple
* text based documents, use {@linkcode CustomTextEditorProvider} instead.
*
* @param T Type of the custom document returned by this provider.
*/
export interface CustomReadonlyEditorProvider<T extends CustomDocument = CustomDocument> {
/**
* Create a new document for a given resource.
*
* `openCustomDocument` is called when the first time an editor for a given resource is opened. The opened
* document is then passed to `resolveCustomEditor` so that the editor can be shown to the user.
*
* Already opened `CustomDocument` are re-used if the user opened additional editors. When all editors for a
* given resource are closed, the `CustomDocument` is disposed of. Opening an editor at this point will
* trigger another call to `openCustomDocument`.
*
* @param uri Uri of the document to open.
* @param openContext Additional information about the opening custom document.
* @param token A cancellation token that indicates the result is no longer needed.
*
* @return The custom document.
*/
openCustomDocument(uri: Uri, openContext: CustomDocumentOpenContext, token: CancellationToken): Thenable<T> | T;
/**
* Resolve a custom editor for a given resource.
*
* This is called whenever the user opens a new editor for this `CustomEditorProvider`.
*
* @param document Document for the resource being resolved.
*
* @param webviewPanel The webview panel used to display the editor UI for this resource.
*
* During resolve, the provider must fill in the initial html for the content webview panel and hook up all
* the event listeners on it that it is interested in. The provider can also hold onto the `WebviewPanel` to
* use later for example in a command. See {@linkcode WebviewPanel} for additional details.
*
* @param token A cancellation token that indicates the result is no longer needed.
*
* @return Optional thenable indicating that the custom editor has been resolved.
*/
resolveCustomEditor(document: T, webviewPanel: WebviewPanel, token: CancellationToken): Thenable<void> | void;
}
/**
* Provider for editable custom editors that use a custom document model.
*
* Custom editors use {@linkcode CustomDocument} as their document model instead of a {@linkcode TextDocument}.
* This gives extensions full control over actions such as edit, save, and backup.
*
* You should use this type of custom editor when dealing with binary files or more complex scenarios. For simple
* text based documents, use {@linkcode CustomTextEditorProvider} instead.
*
* @param T Type of the custom document returned by this provider.
*/
export interface CustomEditorProvider<T extends CustomDocument = CustomDocument> extends CustomReadonlyEditorProvider<T> {
/**
* Signal that an edit has occurred inside a custom editor.
*
* This event must be fired by your extension whenever an edit happens in a custom editor. An edit can be
* anything from changing some text, to cropping an image, to reordering a list. Your extension is free to
* define what an edit is and what data is stored on each edit.
*
* Firing `onDidChange` causes the editors to be marked as being dirty. This is cleared when the user either
* saves or reverts the file.
*
* Editors that support undo/redo must fire a `CustomDocumentEditEvent` whenever an edit happens. This allows
* users to undo and redo the edit using the editor's standard keyboard shortcuts. The editor will also mark
* the editor as no longer being dirty if the user undoes all edits to the last saved state.
*
* Editors that support editing but cannot use the editor's standard undo/redo mechanism must fire a `CustomDocumentContentChangeEvent`.
* The only way for a user to clear the dirty state of an editor that does not support undo/redo is to either
* `save` or `revert` the file.
*
* An editor should only ever fire `CustomDocumentEditEvent` events, or only ever fire `CustomDocumentContentChangeEvent` events.
*/
readonly onDidChangeCustomDocument: Event<CustomDocumentEditEvent<T>> | Event<CustomDocumentContentChangeEvent<T>>;
/**
* Save a custom document.
*
* This method is invoked by the editor when the user saves a custom editor. This can happen when the user
* triggers save while the custom editor is active, by commands such as `save all`, or by auto save if enabled.
*
* To implement `save`, the implementer must persist the custom editor. This usually means writing the
* file data for the custom document to disk. After `save` completes, any associated editor instances will
* no longer be marked as dirty.
*
* @param document Document to save.
* @param cancellation Token that signals the save is no longer required (for example, if another save was triggered).
*
* @return Thenable signaling that saving has completed.
*/
saveCustomDocument(document: T, cancellation: CancellationToken): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Save a custom document to a different location.
*
* This method is invoked by the editor when the user triggers 'save as' on a custom editor. The implementer must
* persist the custom editor to `destination`.
*
* When the user accepts save as, the current editor is be replaced by an non-dirty editor for the newly saved file.
*
* @param document Document to save.
* @param destination Location to save to.
* @param cancellation Token that signals the save is no longer required.
*
* @return Thenable signaling that saving has completed.
*/
saveCustomDocumentAs(document: T, destination: Uri, cancellation: CancellationToken): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Revert a custom document to its last saved state.
*
* This method is invoked by the editor when the user triggers `File: Revert File` in a custom editor. (Note that
* this is only used using the editor's `File: Revert File` command and not on a `git revert` of the file).
*
* To implement `revert`, the implementer must make sure all editor instances (webviews) for `document`
* are displaying the document in the same state is saved in. This usually means reloading the file from the
* workspace.
*
* @param document Document to revert.
* @param cancellation Token that signals the revert is no longer required.
*
* @return Thenable signaling that the change has completed.
*/
revertCustomDocument(document: T, cancellation: CancellationToken): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Back up a dirty custom document.
*
* Backups are used for hot exit and to prevent data loss. Your `backup` method should persist the resource in
* its current state, i.e. with the edits applied. Most commonly this means saving the resource to disk in
* the `ExtensionContext.storagePath`. When the editor reloads and your custom editor is opened for a resource,
* your extension should first check to see if any backups exist for the resource. If there is a backup, your
* extension should load the file contents from there instead of from the resource in the workspace.
*
* `backup` is triggered approximately one second after the user stops editing the document. If the user
* rapidly edits the document, `backup` will not be invoked until the editing stops.
*
* `backup` is not invoked when `auto save` is enabled (since auto save already persists the resource).
*
* @param document Document to backup.
* @param context Information that can be used to backup the document.
* @param cancellation Token that signals the current backup since a new backup is coming in. It is up to your
* extension to decided how to respond to cancellation. If for example your extension is backing up a large file
* in an operation that takes time to complete, your extension may decide to finish the ongoing backup rather
* than cancelling it to ensure that the editor has some valid backup.
*/
backupCustomDocument(document: T, context: CustomDocumentBackupContext, cancellation: CancellationToken): Thenable<CustomDocumentBackup>;
}
/**
* The clipboard provides read and write access to the system's clipboard.
*/
export interface Clipboard {
/**
* Read the current clipboard contents as text.
* @returns A thenable that resolves to a string.
*/
readText(): Thenable<string>;
/**
* Writes text into the clipboard.
* @returns A thenable that resolves when writing happened.
*/
writeText(value: string): Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* Possible kinds of UI that can use extensions.
*/
export enum UIKind {
/**
* Extensions are accessed from a desktop application.
*/
Desktop = 1,
/**
* Extensions are accessed from a web browser.
*/
Web = 2
}
/**
* Namespace describing the environment the editor runs in.
*/
export namespace env {
/**
* The application name of the editor, like 'VS Code'.
*/
export const appName: string;
/**
* The application root folder from which the editor is running.
*
* *Note* that the value is the empty string when running in an
* environment that has no representation of an application root folder.
*/
export const appRoot: string;
/**
* The hosted location of the application
* On desktop this is 'desktop'
* In the web this is the specified embedder i.e. 'github.dev', 'codespaces', or 'web' if the embedder
* does not provide that information
*/
export const appHost: string;
/**
* The custom uri scheme the editor registers to in the operating system.
*/
export const uriScheme: string;
/**
* Represents the preferred user-language, like `de-CH`, `fr`, or `en-US`.
*/
export const language: string;
/**
* The system clipboard.
*/
export const clipboard: Clipboard;
/**
* A unique identifier for the computer.
*/
export const machineId: string;
/**
* A unique identifier for the current session.
* Changes each time the editor is started.
*/
export const sessionId: string;
/**
* Indicates that this is a fresh install of the application.
* `true` if within the first day of installation otherwise `false`.
*/
export const isNewAppInstall: boolean;
/**
* Indicates whether the users has telemetry enabled.
* Can be observed to determine if the extension should send telemetry.
*/
export const isTelemetryEnabled: boolean;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the user enabled or disables telemetry.
* `true` if the user has enabled telemetry or `false` if the user has disabled telemetry.
*/
export const onDidChangeTelemetryEnabled: Event<boolean>;
/**
* The name of a remote. Defined by extensions, popular samples are `wsl` for the Windows
* Subsystem for Linux or `ssh-remote` for remotes using a secure shell.
*
* *Note* that the value is `undefined` when there is no remote extension host but that the
* value is defined in all extension hosts (local and remote) in case a remote extension host
* exists. Use {@link Extension.extensionKind} to know if
* a specific extension runs remote or not.
*/
export const remoteName: string | undefined;
/**
* The detected default shell for the extension host, this is overridden by the
* `terminal.integrated.defaultProfile` setting for the extension host's platform. Note that in
* environments that do not support a shell the value is the empty string.
*/
export const shell: string;
/**
* The UI kind property indicates from which UI extensions
* are accessed from. For example, extensions could be accessed
* from a desktop application or a web browser.
*/
export const uiKind: UIKind;
/**
* Opens a link externally using the default application. Depending on the
* used scheme this can be:
* * a browser (`http:`, `https:`)
* * a mail client (`mailto:`)
* * VSCode itself (`vscode:` from `vscode.env.uriScheme`)
*
* *Note* that {@linkcode window.showTextDocument showTextDocument} is the right
* way to open a text document inside the editor, not this function.
*
* @param target The uri that should be opened.
* @returns A promise indicating if open was successful.
*/
export function openExternal(target: Uri): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* Resolves a uri to a form that is accessible externally.
*
* #### `http:` or `https:` scheme
*
* Resolves an *external* uri, such as a `http:` or `https:` link, from where the extension is running to a
* uri to the same resource on the client machine.
*
* This is a no-op if the extension is running on the client machine.
*
* If the extension is running remotely, this function automatically establishes a port forwarding tunnel
* from the local machine to `target` on the remote and returns a local uri to the tunnel. The lifetime of
* the port forwarding tunnel is managed by the editor and the tunnel can be closed by the user.
*
* *Note* that uris passed through `openExternal` are automatically resolved and you should not call `asExternalUri` on them.
*
* #### `vscode.env.uriScheme`
*
* Creates a uri that - if opened in a browser (e.g. via `openExternal`) - will result in a registered {@link UriHandler}
* to trigger.
*
* Extensions should not make any assumptions about the resulting uri and should not alter it in any way.
* Rather, extensions can e.g. use this uri in an authentication flow, by adding the uri as callback query
* argument to the server to authenticate to.
*
* *Note* that if the server decides to add additional query parameters to the uri (e.g. a token or secret), it
* will appear in the uri that is passed to the {@link UriHandler}.
*
* **Example** of an authentication flow:
* ```typescript
* vscode.window.registerUriHandler({
* handleUri(uri: vscode.Uri): vscode.ProviderResult<void> {
* if (uri.path === '/did-authenticate') {
* console.log(uri.toString());
* }
* }
* });
*
* const callableUri = await vscode.env.asExternalUri(vscode.Uri.parse(`${vscode.env.uriScheme}://my.extension/did-authenticate`));
* await vscode.env.openExternal(callableUri);
* ```
*
* *Note* that extensions should not cache the result of `asExternalUri` as the resolved uri may become invalid due to
* a system or user action — for example, in remote cases, a user may close a port forwarding tunnel that was opened by
* `asExternalUri`.
*
* #### Any other scheme
*
* Any other scheme will be handled as if the provided URI is a workspace URI. In that case, the method will return
* a URI which, when handled, will make the editor open the workspace.
*
* @return A uri that can be used on the client machine.
*/
export function asExternalUri(target: Uri): Thenable<Uri>;
}
/**
* Namespace for dealing with commands. In short, a command is a function with a
* unique identifier. The function is sometimes also called _command handler_.
*
* Commands can be added to the editor using the {@link commands.registerCommand registerCommand}
* and {@link commands.registerTextEditorCommand registerTextEditorCommand} functions. Commands
* can be executed {@link commands.executeCommand manually} or from a UI gesture. Those are:
*
* * palette - Use the `commands`-section in `package.json` to make a command show in
* the [command palette](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/getstarted/userinterface#_command-palette).
* * keybinding - Use the `keybindings`-section in `package.json` to enable
* [keybindings](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/getstarted/keybindings#_customizing-shortcuts)
* for your extension.
*
* Commands from other extensions and from the editor itself are accessible to an extension. However,
* when invoking an editor command not all argument types are supported.
*
* This is a sample that registers a command handler and adds an entry for that command to the palette. First
* register a command handler with the identifier `extension.sayHello`.
* ```javascript
* commands.registerCommand('extension.sayHello', () => {
* window.showInformationMessage('Hello World!');
* });
* ```
* Second, bind the command identifier to a title under which it will show in the palette (`package.json`).
* ```json
* {
* "contributes": {
* "commands": [{
* "command": "extension.sayHello",
* "title": "Hello World"
* }]
* }
* }
* ```
*/
export namespace commands {
/**
* Registers a command that can be invoked via a keyboard shortcut,
* a menu item, an action, or directly.
*
* Registering a command with an existing command identifier twice
* will cause an error.
*
* @param command A unique identifier for the command.
* @param callback A command handler function.
* @param thisArg The `this` context used when invoking the handler function.
* @return Disposable which unregisters this command on disposal.
*/
export function registerCommand(command: string, callback: (...args: any[]) => any, thisArg?: any): Disposable;
/**
* Registers a text editor command that can be invoked via a keyboard shortcut,
* a menu item, an action, or directly.
*
* Text editor commands are different from ordinary {@link commands.registerCommand commands} as
* they only execute when there is an active editor when the command is called. Also, the
* command handler of an editor command has access to the active editor and to an
* {@link TextEditorEdit edit}-builder. Note that the edit-builder is only valid while the
* callback executes.
*
* @param command A unique identifier for the command.
* @param callback A command handler function with access to an {@link TextEditor editor} and an {@link TextEditorEdit edit}.
* @param thisArg The `this` context used when invoking the handler function.
* @return Disposable which unregisters this command on disposal.
*/
export function registerTextEditorCommand(command: string, callback: (textEditor: TextEditor, edit: TextEditorEdit, ...args: any[]) => void, thisArg?: any): Disposable;
/**
* Executes the command denoted by the given command identifier.
*
* * *Note 1:* When executing an editor command not all types are allowed to
* be passed as arguments. Allowed are the primitive types `string`, `boolean`,
* `number`, `undefined`, and `null`, as well as {@linkcode Position}, {@linkcode Range}, {@linkcode Uri} and {@linkcode Location}.
* * *Note 2:* There are no restrictions when executing commands that have been contributed
* by extensions.
*
* @param command Identifier of the command to execute.
* @param rest Parameters passed to the command function.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the returned value of the given command. `undefined` when
* the command handler function doesn't return anything.
*/
export function executeCommand<T>(command: string, ...rest: any[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Retrieve the list of all available commands. Commands starting with an underscore are
* treated as internal commands.
*
* @param filterInternal Set `true` to not see internal commands (starting with an underscore)
* @return Thenable that resolves to a list of command ids.
*/
export function getCommands(filterInternal?: boolean): Thenable<string[]>;
}
/**
* Represents the state of a window.
*/
export interface WindowState {
/**
* Whether the current window is focused.
*/
readonly focused: boolean;
}
/**
* A uri handler is responsible for handling system-wide {@link Uri uris}.
*
* @see {@link window.registerUriHandler}.
*/
export interface UriHandler {
/**
* Handle the provided system-wide {@link Uri}.
*
* @see {@link window.registerUriHandler}.
*/
handleUri(uri: Uri): ProviderResult<void>;
}
/**
* Namespace for dealing with the current window of the editor. That is visible
* and active editors, as well as, UI elements to show messages, selections, and
* asking for user input.
*/
export namespace window {
/**
* The currently active editor or `undefined`. The active editor is the one
* that currently has focus or, when none has focus, the one that has changed
* input most recently.
*/
export let activeTextEditor: TextEditor | undefined;
/**
* The currently visible editors or an empty array.
*/
export let visibleTextEditors: TextEditor[];
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the {@link window.activeTextEditor active editor}
* has changed. *Note* that the event also fires when the active editor changes
* to `undefined`.
*/
export const onDidChangeActiveTextEditor: Event<TextEditor | undefined>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the array of {@link window.visibleTextEditors visible editors}
* has changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeVisibleTextEditors: Event<TextEditor[]>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the selection in an editor has changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeTextEditorSelection: Event<TextEditorSelectionChangeEvent>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the visible ranges of an editor has changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeTextEditorVisibleRanges: Event<TextEditorVisibleRangesChangeEvent>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the options of an editor have changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeTextEditorOptions: Event<TextEditorOptionsChangeEvent>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the view column of an editor has changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeTextEditorViewColumn: Event<TextEditorViewColumnChangeEvent>;
/**
* The currently opened terminals or an empty array.
*/
export const terminals: readonly Terminal[];
/**
* The currently active terminal or `undefined`. The active terminal is the one that
* currently has focus or most recently had focus.
*/
export const activeTerminal: Terminal | undefined;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the {@link window.activeTerminal active terminal}
* has changed. *Note* that the event also fires when the active terminal changes
* to `undefined`.
*/
export const onDidChangeActiveTerminal: Event<Terminal | undefined>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when a terminal has been created, either through the
* {@link window.createTerminal createTerminal} API or commands.
*/
export const onDidOpenTerminal: Event<Terminal>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when a terminal is disposed.
*/
export const onDidCloseTerminal: Event<Terminal>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when a {@link Terminal.state terminal's state} has changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeTerminalState: Event<Terminal>;
/**
* Represents the current window's state.
*/
export const state: WindowState;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the focus state of the current window
* changes. The value of the event represents whether the window is focused.
*/
export const onDidChangeWindowState: Event<WindowState>;
/**
* Show the given document in a text editor. A {@link ViewColumn column} can be provided
* to control where the editor is being shown. Might change the {@link window.activeTextEditor active editor}.
*
* @param document A text document to be shown.
* @param column A view column in which the {@link TextEditor editor} should be shown. The default is the {@link ViewColumn.Active active}, other values
* are adjusted to be `Min(column, columnCount + 1)`, the {@link ViewColumn.Active active}-column is not adjusted. Use {@linkcode ViewColumn.Beside}
* to open the editor to the side of the currently active one.
* @param preserveFocus When `true` the editor will not take focus.
* @return A promise that resolves to an {@link TextEditor editor}.
*/
export function showTextDocument(document: TextDocument, column?: ViewColumn, preserveFocus?: boolean): Thenable<TextEditor>;
/**
* Show the given document in a text editor. {@link TextDocumentShowOptions Options} can be provided
* to control options of the editor is being shown. Might change the {@link window.activeTextEditor active editor}.
*
* @param document A text document to be shown.
* @param options {@link TextDocumentShowOptions Editor options} to configure the behavior of showing the {@link TextEditor editor}.
* @return A promise that resolves to an {@link TextEditor editor}.
*/
export function showTextDocument(document: TextDocument, options?: TextDocumentShowOptions): Thenable<TextEditor>;
/**
* A short-hand for `openTextDocument(uri).then(document => showTextDocument(document, options))`.
*
* @see {@link openTextDocument}
*
* @param uri A resource identifier.
* @param options {@link TextDocumentShowOptions Editor options} to configure the behavior of showing the {@link TextEditor editor}.
* @return A promise that resolves to an {@link TextEditor editor}.
*/
export function showTextDocument(uri: Uri, options?: TextDocumentShowOptions): Thenable<TextEditor>;
/**
* Create a TextEditorDecorationType that can be used to add decorations to text editors.
*
* @param options Rendering options for the decoration type.
* @return A new decoration type instance.
*/
export function createTextEditorDecorationType(options: DecorationRenderOptions): TextEditorDecorationType;
/**
* Show an information message to users. Optionally provide an array of items which will be presented as
* clickable buttons.
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showInformationMessage(message: string, ...items: string[]): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Show an information message to users. Optionally provide an array of items which will be presented as
* clickable buttons.
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param options Configures the behaviour of the message.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showInformationMessage(message: string, options: MessageOptions, ...items: string[]): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Show an information message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showInformationMessage<T extends MessageItem>(message: string, ...items: T[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Show an information message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param options Configures the behaviour of the message.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showInformationMessage<T extends MessageItem>(message: string, options: MessageOptions, ...items: T[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Show a warning message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showWarningMessage(message: string, ...items: string[]): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Show a warning message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param options Configures the behaviour of the message.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showWarningMessage(message: string, options: MessageOptions, ...items: string[]): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Show a warning message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showWarningMessage<T extends MessageItem>(message: string, ...items: T[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Show a warning message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param options Configures the behaviour of the message.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showWarningMessage<T extends MessageItem>(message: string, options: MessageOptions, ...items: T[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Show an error message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showErrorMessage(message: string, ...items: string[]): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Show an error message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param options Configures the behaviour of the message.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showErrorMessage(message: string, options: MessageOptions, ...items: string[]): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Show an error message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showErrorMessage<T extends MessageItem>(message: string, ...items: T[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Show an error message.
*
* @see {@link window.showInformationMessage showInformationMessage}
*
* @param message The message to show.
* @param options Configures the behaviour of the message.
* @param items A set of items that will be rendered as actions in the message.
* @return A thenable that resolves to the selected item or `undefined` when being dismissed.
*/
export function showErrorMessage<T extends MessageItem>(message: string, options: MessageOptions, ...items: T[]): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a selection list allowing multiple selections.
*
* @param items An array of strings, or a promise that resolves to an array of strings.
* @param options Configures the behavior of the selection list.
* @param token A token that can be used to signal cancellation.
* @return A promise that resolves to the selected items or `undefined`.
*/
export function showQuickPick(items: readonly string[] | Thenable<readonly string[]>, options: QuickPickOptions & { canPickMany: true; }, token?: CancellationToken): Thenable<string[] | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a selection list.
*
* @param items An array of strings, or a promise that resolves to an array of strings.
* @param options Configures the behavior of the selection list.
* @param token A token that can be used to signal cancellation.
* @return A promise that resolves to the selection or `undefined`.
*/
export function showQuickPick(items: readonly string[] | Thenable<readonly string[]>, options?: QuickPickOptions, token?: CancellationToken): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a selection list allowing multiple selections.
*
* @param items An array of items, or a promise that resolves to an array of items.
* @param options Configures the behavior of the selection list.
* @param token A token that can be used to signal cancellation.
* @return A promise that resolves to the selected items or `undefined`.
*/
export function showQuickPick<T extends QuickPickItem>(items: readonly T[] | Thenable<readonly T[]>, options: QuickPickOptions & { canPickMany: true; }, token?: CancellationToken): Thenable<T[] | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a selection list.
*
* @param items An array of items, or a promise that resolves to an array of items.
* @param options Configures the behavior of the selection list.
* @param token A token that can be used to signal cancellation.
* @return A promise that resolves to the selected item or `undefined`.
*/
export function showQuickPick<T extends QuickPickItem>(items: readonly T[] | Thenable<readonly T[]>, options?: QuickPickOptions, token?: CancellationToken): Thenable<T | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a selection list of {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders} to pick from.
* Returns `undefined` if no folder is open.
*
* @param options Configures the behavior of the workspace folder list.
* @return A promise that resolves to the workspace folder or `undefined`.
*/
export function showWorkspaceFolderPick(options?: WorkspaceFolderPickOptions): Thenable<WorkspaceFolder | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a file open dialog to the user which allows to select a file
* for opening-purposes.
*
* @param options Options that control the dialog.
* @returns A promise that resolves to the selected resources or `undefined`.
*/
export function showOpenDialog(options?: OpenDialogOptions): Thenable<Uri[] | undefined>;
/**
* Shows a file save dialog to the user which allows to select a file
* for saving-purposes.
*
* @param options Options that control the dialog.
* @returns A promise that resolves to the selected resource or `undefined`.
*/
export function showSaveDialog(options?: SaveDialogOptions): Thenable<Uri | undefined>;
/**
* Opens an input box to ask the user for input.
*
* The returned value will be `undefined` if the input box was canceled (e.g. pressing ESC). Otherwise the
* returned value will be the string typed by the user or an empty string if the user did not type
* anything but dismissed the input box with OK.
*
* @param options Configures the behavior of the input box.
* @param token A token that can be used to signal cancellation.
* @return A promise that resolves to a string the user provided or to `undefined` in case of dismissal.
*/
export function showInputBox(options?: InputBoxOptions, token?: CancellationToken): Thenable<string | undefined>;
/**
* Creates a {@link QuickPick} to let the user pick an item from a list
* of items of type T.
*
* Note that in many cases the more convenient {@link window.showQuickPick}
* is easier to use. {@link window.createQuickPick} should be used
* when {@link window.showQuickPick} does not offer the required flexibility.
*
* @return A new {@link QuickPick}.
*/
export function createQuickPick<T extends QuickPickItem>(): QuickPick<T>;
/**
* Creates a {@link InputBox} to let the user enter some text input.
*
* Note that in many cases the more convenient {@link window.showInputBox}
* is easier to use. {@link window.createInputBox} should be used
* when {@link window.showInputBox} does not offer the required flexibility.
*
* @return A new {@link InputBox}.
*/
export function createInputBox(): InputBox;
/**
* Creates a new {@link OutputChannel output channel} with the given name.
*
* @param name Human-readable string which will be used to represent the channel in the UI.
*/
export function createOutputChannel(name: string): OutputChannel;
/**
* Create and show a new webview panel.
*
* @param viewType Identifies the type of the webview panel.
* @param title Title of the panel.
* @param showOptions Where to show the webview in the editor. If preserveFocus is set, the new webview will not take focus.
* @param options Settings for the new panel.
*
* @return New webview panel.
*/
export function createWebviewPanel(viewType: string, title: string, showOptions: ViewColumn | { viewColumn: ViewColumn, preserveFocus?: boolean }, options?: WebviewPanelOptions & WebviewOptions): WebviewPanel;
/**
* Set a message to the status bar. This is a short hand for the more powerful
* status bar {@link window.createStatusBarItem items}.
*
* @param text The message to show, supports icon substitution as in status bar {@link StatusBarItem.text items}.
* @param hideAfterTimeout Timeout in milliseconds after which the message will be disposed.
* @return A disposable which hides the status bar message.
*/
export function setStatusBarMessage(text: string, hideAfterTimeout: number): Disposable;
/**
* Set a message to the status bar. This is a short hand for the more powerful
* status bar {@link window.createStatusBarItem items}.
*
* @param text The message to show, supports icon substitution as in status bar {@link StatusBarItem.text items}.
* @param hideWhenDone Thenable on which completion (resolve or reject) the message will be disposed.
* @return A disposable which hides the status bar message.
*/
export function setStatusBarMessage(text: string, hideWhenDone: Thenable<any>): Disposable;
/**
* Set a message to the status bar. This is a short hand for the more powerful
* status bar {@link window.createStatusBarItem items}.
*
* *Note* that status bar messages stack and that they must be disposed when no
* longer used.
*
* @param text The message to show, supports icon substitution as in status bar {@link StatusBarItem.text items}.
* @return A disposable which hides the status bar message.
*/
export function setStatusBarMessage(text: string): Disposable;
/**
* Show progress in the Source Control viewlet while running the given callback and while
* its returned promise isn't resolve or rejected.
*
* @deprecated Use `withProgress` instead.
*
* @param task A callback returning a promise. Progress increments can be reported with
* the provided {@link Progress}-object.
* @return The thenable the task did return.
*/
export function withScmProgress<R>(task: (progress: Progress<number>) => Thenable<R>): Thenable<R>;
/**
* Show progress in the editor. Progress is shown while running the given callback
* and while the promise it returned isn't resolved nor rejected. The location at which
* progress should show (and other details) is defined via the passed {@linkcode ProgressOptions}.
*
* @param task A callback returning a promise. Progress state can be reported with
* the provided {@link Progress}-object.
*
* To report discrete progress, use `increment` to indicate how much work has been completed. Each call with
* a `increment` value will be summed up and reflected as overall progress until 100% is reached (a value of
* e.g. `10` accounts for `10%` of work done).
* Note that currently only `ProgressLocation.Notification` is capable of showing discrete progress.
*
* To monitor if the operation has been cancelled by the user, use the provided {@linkcode CancellationToken}.
* Note that currently only `ProgressLocation.Notification` is supporting to show a cancel button to cancel the
* long running operation.
*
* @return The thenable the task-callback returned.
*/
export function withProgress<R>(options: ProgressOptions, task: (progress: Progress<{ message?: string; increment?: number }>, token: CancellationToken) => Thenable<R>): Thenable<R>;
/**
* Creates a status bar {@link StatusBarItem item}.
*
* @param alignment The alignment of the item.
* @param priority The priority of the item. Higher values mean the item should be shown more to the left.
* @return A new status bar item.
*/
export function createStatusBarItem(alignment?: StatusBarAlignment, priority?: number): StatusBarItem;
/**
* Creates a status bar {@link StatusBarItem item}.
*
* @param id The unique identifier of the item.
* @param alignment The alignment of the item.
* @param priority The priority of the item. Higher values mean the item should be shown more to the left.
* @return A new status bar item.
*/
export function createStatusBarItem(id: string, alignment?: StatusBarAlignment, priority?: number): StatusBarItem;
/**
* Creates a {@link Terminal} with a backing shell process. The cwd of the terminal will be the workspace
* directory if it exists.
*
* @param name Optional human-readable string which will be used to represent the terminal in the UI.
* @param shellPath Optional path to a custom shell executable to be used in the terminal.
* @param shellArgs Optional args for the custom shell executable. A string can be used on Windows only which
* allows specifying shell args in
* [command-line format](https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-au/08dfcab2-eb6e-49a4-80eb-87d4076c98c6).
* @return A new Terminal.
* @throws When running in an environment where a new process cannot be started.
*/
export function createTerminal(name?: string, shellPath?: string, shellArgs?: string[] | string): Terminal;
/**
* Creates a {@link Terminal} with a backing shell process.
*
* @param options A TerminalOptions object describing the characteristics of the new terminal.
* @return A new Terminal.
* @throws When running in an environment where a new process cannot be started.
*/
export function createTerminal(options: TerminalOptions): Terminal;
/**
* Creates a {@link Terminal} where an extension controls its input and output.
*
* @param options An {@link ExtensionTerminalOptions} object describing
* the characteristics of the new terminal.
* @return A new Terminal.
*/
export function createTerminal(options: ExtensionTerminalOptions): Terminal;
/**
* Register a {@link TreeDataProvider} for the view contributed using the extension point `views`.
* This will allow you to contribute data to the {@link TreeView} and update if the data changes.
*
* **Note:** To get access to the {@link TreeView} and perform operations on it, use {@link window.createTreeView createTreeView}.
*
* @param viewId Id of the view contributed using the extension point `views`.
* @param treeDataProvider A {@link TreeDataProvider} that provides tree data for the view
*/
export function registerTreeDataProvider<T>(viewId: string, treeDataProvider: TreeDataProvider<T>): Disposable;
/**
* Create a {@link TreeView} for the view contributed using the extension point `views`.
* @param viewId Id of the view contributed using the extension point `views`.
* @param options Options for creating the {@link TreeView}
* @returns a {@link TreeView}.
*/
export function createTreeView<T>(viewId: string, options: TreeViewOptions<T>): TreeView<T>;
/**
* Registers a {@link UriHandler uri handler} capable of handling system-wide {@link Uri uris}.
* In case there are multiple windows open, the topmost window will handle the uri.
* A uri handler is scoped to the extension it is contributed from; it will only
* be able to handle uris which are directed to the extension itself. A uri must respect
* the following rules:
*
* - The uri-scheme must be `vscode.env.uriScheme`;
* - The uri-authority must be the extension id (e.g. `my.extension`);
* - The uri-path, -query and -fragment parts are arbitrary.
*
* For example, if the `my.extension` extension registers a uri handler, it will only
* be allowed to handle uris with the prefix `product-name://my.extension`.
*
* An extension can only register a single uri handler in its entire activation lifetime.
*
* * *Note:* There is an activation event `onUri` that fires when a uri directed for
* the current extension is about to be handled.
*
* @param handler The uri handler to register for this extension.
*/
export function registerUriHandler(handler: UriHandler): Disposable;
/**
* Registers a webview panel serializer.
*
* Extensions that support reviving should have an `"onWebviewPanel:viewType"` activation event and
* make sure that {@link registerWebviewPanelSerializer} is called during activation.
*
* Only a single serializer may be registered at a time for a given `viewType`.
*
* @param viewType Type of the webview panel that can be serialized.
* @param serializer Webview serializer.
*/
export function registerWebviewPanelSerializer(viewType: string, serializer: WebviewPanelSerializer): Disposable;
/**
* Register a new provider for webview views.
*
* @param viewId Unique id of the view. This should match the `id` from the
* `views` contribution in the package.json.
* @param provider Provider for the webview views.
*
* @return Disposable that unregisters the provider.
*/
export function registerWebviewViewProvider(viewId: string, provider: WebviewViewProvider, options?: {
/**
* Content settings for the webview created for this view.
*/
readonly webviewOptions?: {
/**
* Controls if the webview element itself (iframe) is kept around even when the view
* is no longer visible.
*
* Normally the webview's html context is created when the view becomes visible
* and destroyed when it is hidden. Extensions that have complex state
* or UI can set the `retainContextWhenHidden` to make the editor keep the webview
* context around, even when the webview moves to a background tab. When a webview using
* `retainContextWhenHidden` becomes hidden, its scripts and other dynamic content are suspended.
* When the view becomes visible again, the context is automatically restored
* in the exact same state it was in originally. You cannot send messages to a
* hidden webview, even with `retainContextWhenHidden` enabled.
*
* `retainContextWhenHidden` has a high memory overhead and should only be used if
* your view's context cannot be quickly saved and restored.
*/
readonly retainContextWhenHidden?: boolean;
};
}): Disposable;
/**
* Register a provider for custom editors for the `viewType` contributed by the `customEditors` extension point.
*
* When a custom editor is opened, an `onCustomEditor:viewType` activation event is fired. Your extension
* must register a {@linkcode CustomTextEditorProvider}, {@linkcode CustomReadonlyEditorProvider},
* {@linkcode CustomEditorProvider}for `viewType` as part of activation.
*
* @param viewType Unique identifier for the custom editor provider. This should match the `viewType` from the
* `customEditors` contribution point.
* @param provider Provider that resolves custom editors.
* @param options Options for the provider.
*
* @return Disposable that unregisters the provider.
*/
export function registerCustomEditorProvider(viewType: string, provider: CustomTextEditorProvider | CustomReadonlyEditorProvider | CustomEditorProvider, options?: {
/**
* Content settings for the webview panels created for this custom editor.
*/
readonly webviewOptions?: WebviewPanelOptions;
/**
* Only applies to `CustomReadonlyEditorProvider | CustomEditorProvider`.
*
* Indicates that the provider allows multiple editor instances to be open at the same time for
* the same resource.
*
* By default, the editor only allows one editor instance to be open at a time for each resource. If the
* user tries to open a second editor instance for the resource, the first one is instead moved to where
* the second one was to be opened.
*
* When `supportsMultipleEditorsPerDocument` is enabled, users can split and create copies of the custom
* editor. In this case, the custom editor must make sure it can properly synchronize the states of all
* editor instances for a resource so that they are consistent.
*/
readonly supportsMultipleEditorsPerDocument?: boolean;
}): Disposable;
/**
* Register provider that enables the detection and handling of links within the terminal.
* @param provider The provider that provides the terminal links.
* @return Disposable that unregisters the provider.
*/
export function registerTerminalLinkProvider(provider: TerminalLinkProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Registers a provider for a contributed terminal profile.
* @param id The ID of the contributed terminal profile.
* @param provider The terminal profile provider.
*/
export function registerTerminalProfileProvider(id: string, provider: TerminalProfileProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a file decoration provider.
*
* @param provider A {@link FileDecorationProvider}.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters the provider.
*/
export function registerFileDecorationProvider(provider: FileDecorationProvider): Disposable;
/**
* The currently active color theme as configured in the settings. The active
* theme can be changed via the `workbench.colorTheme` setting.
*/
export let activeColorTheme: ColorTheme;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the active color theme is changed or has changes.
*/
export const onDidChangeActiveColorTheme: Event<ColorTheme>;
}
/**
* Options for creating a {@link TreeView}
*/
export interface TreeViewOptions<T> {
/**
* A data provider that provides tree data.
*/
treeDataProvider: TreeDataProvider<T>;
/**
* Whether to show collapse all action or not.
*/
showCollapseAll?: boolean;
/**
* Whether the tree supports multi-select. When the tree supports multi-select and a command is executed from the tree,
* the first argument to the command is the tree item that the command was executed on and the second argument is an
* array containing all selected tree items.
*/
canSelectMany?: boolean;
}
/**
* The event that is fired when an element in the {@link TreeView} is expanded or collapsed
*/
export interface TreeViewExpansionEvent<T> {
/**
* Element that is expanded or collapsed.
*/
readonly element: T;
}
/**
* The event that is fired when there is a change in {@link TreeView.selection tree view's selection}
*/
export interface TreeViewSelectionChangeEvent<T> {
/**
* Selected elements.
*/
readonly selection: T[];
}
/**
* The event that is fired when there is a change in {@link TreeView.visible tree view's visibility}
*/
export interface TreeViewVisibilityChangeEvent {
/**
* `true` if the {@link TreeView tree view} is visible otherwise `false`.
*/
readonly visible: boolean;
}
/**
* Represents a Tree view
*/
export interface TreeView<T> extends Disposable {
/**
* Event that is fired when an element is expanded
*/
readonly onDidExpandElement: Event<TreeViewExpansionEvent<T>>;
/**
* Event that is fired when an element is collapsed
*/
readonly onDidCollapseElement: Event<TreeViewExpansionEvent<T>>;
/**
* Currently selected elements.
*/
readonly selection: T[];
/**
* Event that is fired when the {@link TreeView.selection selection} has changed
*/
readonly onDidChangeSelection: Event<TreeViewSelectionChangeEvent<T>>;
/**
* `true` if the {@link TreeView tree view} is visible otherwise `false`.
*/
readonly visible: boolean;
/**
* Event that is fired when {@link TreeView.visible visibility} has changed
*/
readonly onDidChangeVisibility: Event<TreeViewVisibilityChangeEvent>;
/**
* An optional human-readable message that will be rendered in the view.
* Setting the message to null, undefined, or empty string will remove the message from the view.
*/
message?: string;
/**
* The tree view title is initially taken from the extension package.json
* Changes to the title property will be properly reflected in the UI in the title of the view.
*/
title?: string;
/**
* An optional human-readable description which is rendered less prominently in the title of the view.
* Setting the title description to null, undefined, or empty string will remove the description from the view.
*/
description?: string;
/**
* Reveals the given element in the tree view.
* If the tree view is not visible then the tree view is shown and element is revealed.
*
* By default revealed element is selected.
* In order to not to select, set the option `select` to `false`.
* In order to focus, set the option `focus` to `true`.
* In order to expand the revealed element, set the option `expand` to `true`. To expand recursively set `expand` to the number of levels to expand.
* **NOTE:** You can expand only to 3 levels maximum.
*
* **NOTE:** The {@link TreeDataProvider} that the `TreeView` {@link window.createTreeView is registered with} with must implement {@link TreeDataProvider.getParent getParent} method to access this API.
*/
reveal(element: T, options?: { select?: boolean, focus?: boolean, expand?: boolean | number }): Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* A data provider that provides tree data
*/
export interface TreeDataProvider<T> {
/**
* An optional event to signal that an element or root has changed.
* This will trigger the view to update the changed element/root and its children recursively (if shown).
* To signal that root has changed, do not pass any argument or pass `undefined` or `null`.
*/
onDidChangeTreeData?: Event<T | undefined | null | void>;
/**
* Get {@link TreeItem} representation of the `element`
*
* @param element The element for which {@link TreeItem} representation is asked for.
* @return TreeItem representation of the element.
*/
getTreeItem(element: T): TreeItem | Thenable<TreeItem>;
/**
* Get the children of `element` or root if no element is passed.
*
* @param element The element from which the provider gets children. Can be `undefined`.
* @return Children of `element` or root if no element is passed.
*/
getChildren(element?: T): ProviderResult<T[]>;
/**
* Optional method to return the parent of `element`.
* Return `null` or `undefined` if `element` is a child of root.
*
* **NOTE:** This method should be implemented in order to access {@link TreeView.reveal reveal} API.
*
* @param element The element for which the parent has to be returned.
* @return Parent of `element`.
*/
getParent?(element: T): ProviderResult<T>;
/**
* Called on hover to resolve the {@link TreeItem.tooltip TreeItem} property if it is undefined.
* Called on tree item click/open to resolve the {@link TreeItem.command TreeItem} property if it is undefined.
* Only properties that were undefined can be resolved in `resolveTreeItem`.
* Functionality may be expanded later to include being called to resolve other missing
* properties on selection and/or on open.
*
* Will only ever be called once per TreeItem.
*
* onDidChangeTreeData should not be triggered from within resolveTreeItem.
*
* *Note* that this function is called when tree items are already showing in the UI.
* Because of that, no property that changes the presentation (label, description, etc.)
* can be changed.
*
* @param item Undefined properties of `item` should be set then `item` should be returned.
* @param element The object associated with the TreeItem.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved tree item or a thenable that resolves to such. It is OK to return the given
* `item`. When no result is returned, the given `item` will be used.
*/
resolveTreeItem?(item: TreeItem, element: T, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<TreeItem>;
}
export class TreeItem {
/**
* A human-readable string describing this item. When `falsy`, it is derived from {@link TreeItem.resourceUri resourceUri}.
*/
label?: string | TreeItemLabel;
/**
* Optional id for the tree item that has to be unique across tree. The id is used to preserve the selection and expansion state of the tree item.
*
* If not provided, an id is generated using the tree item's label. **Note** that when labels change, ids will change and that selection and expansion state cannot be kept stable anymore.
*/
id?: string;
/**
* The icon path or {@link ThemeIcon} for the tree item.
* When `falsy`, {@link ThemeIcon.Folder Folder Theme Icon} is assigned, if item is collapsible otherwise {@link ThemeIcon.File File Theme Icon}.
* When a file or folder {@link ThemeIcon} is specified, icon is derived from the current file icon theme for the specified theme icon using {@link TreeItem.resourceUri resourceUri} (if provided).
*/
iconPath?: string | Uri | { light: string | Uri; dark: string | Uri } | ThemeIcon;
/**
* A human-readable string which is rendered less prominent.
* When `true`, it is derived from {@link TreeItem.resourceUri resourceUri} and when `falsy`, it is not shown.
*/
description?: string | boolean;
/**
* The {@link Uri} of the resource representing this item.
*
* Will be used to derive the {@link TreeItem.label label}, when it is not provided.
* Will be used to derive the icon from current file icon theme, when {@link TreeItem.iconPath iconPath} has {@link ThemeIcon} value.
*/
resourceUri?: Uri;
/**
* The tooltip text when you hover over this item.
*/
tooltip?: string | MarkdownString | undefined;
/**
* The {@link Command} that should be executed when the tree item is selected.
*
* Please use `vscode.open` or `vscode.diff` as command IDs when the tree item is opening
* something in the editor. Using these commands ensures that the resulting editor will
* appear consistent with how other built-in trees open editors.
*/
command?: Command;
/**
* {@link TreeItemCollapsibleState} of the tree item.
*/
collapsibleState?: TreeItemCollapsibleState;
/**
* Context value of the tree item. This can be used to contribute item specific actions in the tree.
* For example, a tree item is given a context value as `folder`. When contributing actions to `view/item/context`
* using `menus` extension point, you can specify context value for key `viewItem` in `when` expression like `viewItem == folder`.
* ```json
* "contributes": {
* "menus": {
* "view/item/context": [
* {
* "command": "extension.deleteFolder",
* "when": "viewItem == folder"
* }
* ]
* }
* }
* ```
* This will show action `extension.deleteFolder` only for items with `contextValue` is `folder`.
*/
contextValue?: string;
/**
* Accessibility information used when screen reader interacts with this tree item.
* Generally, a TreeItem has no need to set the `role` of the accessibilityInformation;
* however, there are cases where a TreeItem is not displayed in a tree-like way where setting the `role` may make sense.
*/
accessibilityInformation?: AccessibilityInformation;
/**
* @param label A human-readable string describing this item
* @param collapsibleState {@link TreeItemCollapsibleState} of the tree item. Default is {@link TreeItemCollapsibleState.None}
*/
constructor(label: string | TreeItemLabel, collapsibleState?: TreeItemCollapsibleState);
/**
* @param resourceUri The {@link Uri} of the resource representing this item.
* @param collapsibleState {@link TreeItemCollapsibleState} of the tree item. Default is {@link TreeItemCollapsibleState.None}
*/
constructor(resourceUri: Uri, collapsibleState?: TreeItemCollapsibleState);
}
/**
* Collapsible state of the tree item
*/
export enum TreeItemCollapsibleState {
/**
* Determines an item can be neither collapsed nor expanded. Implies it has no children.
*/
None = 0,
/**
* Determines an item is collapsed
*/
Collapsed = 1,
/**
* Determines an item is expanded
*/
Expanded = 2
}
/**
* Label describing the {@link TreeItem Tree item}
*/
export interface TreeItemLabel {
/**
* A human-readable string describing the {@link TreeItem Tree item}.
*/
label: string;
/**
* Ranges in the label to highlight. A range is defined as a tuple of two number where the
* first is the inclusive start index and the second the exclusive end index
*/
highlights?: [number, number][];
}
/**
* Value-object describing what options a terminal should use.
*/
export interface TerminalOptions {
/**
* A human-readable string which will be used to represent the terminal in the UI.
*/
name?: string;
/**
* A path to a custom shell executable to be used in the terminal.
*/
shellPath?: string;
/**
* Args for the custom shell executable. A string can be used on Windows only which allows
* specifying shell args in [command-line format](https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-au/08dfcab2-eb6e-49a4-80eb-87d4076c98c6).
*/
shellArgs?: string[] | string;
/**
* A path or Uri for the current working directory to be used for the terminal.
*/
cwd?: string | Uri;
/**
* Object with environment variables that will be added to the editor process.
*/
env?: { [key: string]: string | null | undefined };
/**
* Whether the terminal process environment should be exactly as provided in
* `TerminalOptions.env`. When this is false (default), the environment will be based on the
* window's environment and also apply configured platform settings like
* `terminal.integrated.windows.env` on top. When this is true, the complete environment
* must be provided as nothing will be inherited from the process or any configuration.
*/
strictEnv?: boolean;
/**
* When enabled the terminal will run the process as normal but not be surfaced to the user
* until `Terminal.show` is called. The typical usage for this is when you need to run
* something that may need interactivity but only want to tell the user about it when
* interaction is needed. Note that the terminals will still be exposed to all extensions
* as normal.
*/
hideFromUser?: boolean;
/**
* A message to write to the terminal on first launch, note that this is not sent to the
* process but, rather written directly to the terminal. This supports escape sequences such
* a setting text style.
*/
message?: string;
/**
* The icon path or {@link ThemeIcon} for the terminal.
*/
iconPath?: Uri | { light: Uri; dark: Uri } | ThemeIcon;
/**
* The icon {@link ThemeColor} for the terminal.
* The `terminal.ansi*` theme keys are
* recommended for the best contrast and consistency across themes.
*/
color?: ThemeColor;
}
/**
* Value-object describing what options a virtual process terminal should use.
*/
export interface ExtensionTerminalOptions {
/**
* A human-readable string which will be used to represent the terminal in the UI.
*/
name: string;
/**
* An implementation of {@link Pseudoterminal} that allows an extension to
* control a terminal.
*/
pty: Pseudoterminal;
/**
* The icon path or {@link ThemeIcon} for the terminal.
*/
iconPath?: Uri | { light: Uri; dark: Uri } | ThemeIcon;
/**
* The icon {@link ThemeColor} for the terminal.
* The standard `terminal.ansi*` theme keys are
* recommended for the best contrast and consistency across themes.
*/
color?: ThemeColor;
}
/**
* Defines the interface of a terminal pty, enabling extensions to control a terminal.
*/
interface Pseudoterminal {
/**
* An event that when fired will write data to the terminal. Unlike
* {@link Terminal.sendText} which sends text to the underlying child
* pseudo-device (the child), this will write the text to parent pseudo-device (the
* _terminal_ itself).
*
* Note writing `\n` will just move the cursor down 1 row, you need to write `\r` as well
* to move the cursor to the left-most cell.
*
* Events fired before {@link Pseudoterminal.open} is called will be be ignored.
*
* **Example:** Write red text to the terminal
* ```typescript
* const writeEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<string>();
* const pty: vscode.Pseudoterminal = {
* onDidWrite: writeEmitter.event,
* open: () => writeEmitter.fire('\x1b[31mHello world\x1b[0m'),
* close: () => {}
* };
* vscode.window.createTerminal({ name: 'My terminal', pty });
* ```
*
* **Example:** Move the cursor to the 10th row and 20th column and write an asterisk
* ```typescript
* writeEmitter.fire('\x1b[10;20H*');
* ```
*/
onDidWrite: Event<string>;
/**
* An event that when fired allows overriding the {@link Pseudoterminal.setDimensions dimensions} of the
* terminal. Note that when set, the overridden dimensions will only take effect when they
* are lower than the actual dimensions of the terminal (ie. there will never be a scroll
* bar). Set to `undefined` for the terminal to go back to the regular dimensions (fit to
* the size of the panel).
*
* Events fired before {@link Pseudoterminal.open} is called will be be ignored.
*
* **Example:** Override the dimensions of a terminal to 20 columns and 10 rows
* ```typescript
* const dimensionsEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<vscode.TerminalDimensions>();
* const pty: vscode.Pseudoterminal = {
* onDidWrite: writeEmitter.event,
* onDidOverrideDimensions: dimensionsEmitter.event,
* open: () => {
* dimensionsEmitter.fire({
* columns: 20,
* rows: 10
* });
* },
* close: () => {}
* };
* vscode.window.createTerminal({ name: 'My terminal', pty });
* ```
*/
onDidOverrideDimensions?: Event<TerminalDimensions | undefined>;
/**
* An event that when fired will signal that the pty is closed and dispose of the terminal.
*
* Events fired before {@link Pseudoterminal.open} is called will be be ignored.
*
* A number can be used to provide an exit code for the terminal. Exit codes must be
* positive and a non-zero exit codes signals failure which shows a notification for a
* regular terminal and allows dependent tasks to proceed when used with the
* `CustomExecution` API.
*
* **Example:** Exit the terminal when "y" is pressed, otherwise show a notification.
* ```typescript
* const writeEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<string>();
* const closeEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<vscode.TerminalDimensions>();
* const pty: vscode.Pseudoterminal = {
* onDidWrite: writeEmitter.event,
* onDidClose: closeEmitter.event,
* open: () => writeEmitter.fire('Press y to exit successfully'),
* close: () => {},
* handleInput: data => {
* if (data !== 'y') {
* vscode.window.showInformationMessage('Something went wrong');
* }
* closeEmitter.fire();
* }
* };
* vscode.window.createTerminal({ name: 'Exit example', pty });
* ```
*/
onDidClose?: Event<void | number>;
/**
* An event that when fired allows changing the name of the terminal.
*
* Events fired before {@link Pseudoterminal.open} is called will be be ignored.
*
* **Example:** Change the terminal name to "My new terminal".
* ```typescript
* const writeEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<string>();
* const changeNameEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<string>();
* const pty: vscode.Pseudoterminal = {
* onDidWrite: writeEmitter.event,
* onDidChangeName: changeNameEmitter.event,
* open: () => changeNameEmitter.fire('My new terminal'),
* close: () => {}
* };
* vscode.window.createTerminal({ name: 'My terminal', pty });
* ```
*/
onDidChangeName?: Event<string>;
/**
* Implement to handle when the pty is open and ready to start firing events.
*
* @param initialDimensions The dimensions of the terminal, this will be undefined if the
* terminal panel has not been opened before this is called.
*/
open(initialDimensions: TerminalDimensions | undefined): void;
/**
* Implement to handle when the terminal is closed by an act of the user.
*/
close(): void;
/**
* Implement to handle incoming keystrokes in the terminal or when an extension calls
* {@link Terminal.sendText}. `data` contains the keystrokes/text serialized into
* their corresponding VT sequence representation.
*
* @param data The incoming data.
*
* **Example:** Echo input in the terminal. The sequence for enter (`\r`) is translated to
* CRLF to go to a new line and move the cursor to the start of the line.
* ```typescript
* const writeEmitter = new vscode.EventEmitter<string>();
* const pty: vscode.Pseudoterminal = {
* onDidWrite: writeEmitter.event,
* open: () => {},
* close: () => {},
* handleInput: data => writeEmitter.fire(data === '\r' ? '\r\n' : data)
* };
* vscode.window.createTerminal({ name: 'Local echo', pty });
* ```
*/
handleInput?(data: string): void;
/**
* Implement to handle when the number of rows and columns that fit into the terminal panel
* changes, for example when font size changes or when the panel is resized. The initial
* state of a terminal's dimensions should be treated as `undefined` until this is triggered
* as the size of a terminal isn't known until it shows up in the user interface.
*
* When dimensions are overridden by
* {@link Pseudoterminal.onDidOverrideDimensions onDidOverrideDimensions}, `setDimensions` will
* continue to be called with the regular panel dimensions, allowing the extension continue
* to react dimension changes.
*
* @param dimensions The new dimensions.
*/
setDimensions?(dimensions: TerminalDimensions): void;
}
/**
* Represents the dimensions of a terminal.
*/
export interface TerminalDimensions {
/**
* The number of columns in the terminal.
*/
readonly columns: number;
/**
* The number of rows in the terminal.
*/
readonly rows: number;
}
/**
* Represents how a terminal exited.
*/
export interface TerminalExitStatus {
/**
* The exit code that a terminal exited with, it can have the following values:
* - Zero: the terminal process or custom execution succeeded.
* - Non-zero: the terminal process or custom execution failed.
* - `undefined`: the user forcibly closed the terminal or a custom execution exited
* without providing an exit code.
*/
readonly code: number | undefined;
}
/**
* A type of mutation that can be applied to an environment variable.
*/
export enum EnvironmentVariableMutatorType {
/**
* Replace the variable's existing value.
*/
Replace = 1,
/**
* Append to the end of the variable's existing value.
*/
Append = 2,
/**
* Prepend to the start of the variable's existing value.
*/
Prepend = 3
}
/**
* A type of mutation and its value to be applied to an environment variable.
*/
export interface EnvironmentVariableMutator {
/**
* The type of mutation that will occur to the variable.
*/
readonly type: EnvironmentVariableMutatorType;
/**
* The value to use for the variable.
*/
readonly value: string;
}
/**
* A collection of mutations that an extension can apply to a process environment.
*/
export interface EnvironmentVariableCollection {
/**
* Whether the collection should be cached for the workspace and applied to the terminal
* across window reloads. When true the collection will be active immediately such when the
* window reloads. Additionally, this API will return the cached version if it exists. The
* collection will be invalidated when the extension is uninstalled or when the collection
* is cleared. Defaults to true.
*/
persistent: boolean;
/**
* Replace an environment variable with a value.
*
* Note that an extension can only make a single change to any one variable, so this will
* overwrite any previous calls to replace, append or prepend.
*
* @param variable The variable to replace.
* @param value The value to replace the variable with.
*/
replace(variable: string, value: string): void;
/**
* Append a value to an environment variable.
*
* Note that an extension can only make a single change to any one variable, so this will
* overwrite any previous calls to replace, append or prepend.
*
* @param variable The variable to append to.
* @param value The value to append to the variable.
*/
append(variable: string, value: string): void;
/**
* Prepend a value to an environment variable.
*
* Note that an extension can only make a single change to any one variable, so this will
* overwrite any previous calls to replace, append or prepend.
*
* @param variable The variable to prepend.
* @param value The value to prepend to the variable.
*/
prepend(variable: string, value: string): void;
/**
* Gets the mutator that this collection applies to a variable, if any.
*
* @param variable The variable to get the mutator for.
*/
get(variable: string): EnvironmentVariableMutator | undefined;
/**
* Iterate over each mutator in this collection.
*
* @param callback Function to execute for each entry.
* @param thisArg The `this` context used when invoking the handler function.
*/
forEach(callback: (variable: string, mutator: EnvironmentVariableMutator, collection: EnvironmentVariableCollection) => any, thisArg?: any): void;
/**
* Deletes this collection's mutator for a variable.
*
* @param variable The variable to delete the mutator for.
*/
delete(variable: string): void;
/**
* Clears all mutators from this collection.
*/
clear(): void;
}
/**
* A location in the editor at which progress information can be shown. It depends on the
* location how progress is visually represented.
*/
export enum ProgressLocation {
/**
* Show progress for the source control viewlet, as overlay for the icon and as progress bar
* inside the viewlet (when visible). Neither supports cancellation nor discrete progress.
*/
SourceControl = 1,
/**
* Show progress in the status bar of the editor. Neither supports cancellation nor discrete progress.
*/
Window = 10,
/**
* Show progress as notification with an optional cancel button. Supports to show infinite and discrete progress.
*/
Notification = 15
}
/**
* Value-object describing where and how progress should show.
*/
export interface ProgressOptions {
/**
* The location at which progress should show.
*/
location: ProgressLocation | { viewId: string };
/**
* A human-readable string which will be used to describe the
* operation.
*/
title?: string;
/**
* Controls if a cancel button should show to allow the user to
* cancel the long running operation. Note that currently only
* `ProgressLocation.Notification` is supporting to show a cancel
* button.
*/
cancellable?: boolean;
}
/**
* A light-weight user input UI that is initially not visible. After
* configuring it through its properties the extension can make it
* visible by calling {@link QuickInput.show}.
*
* There are several reasons why this UI might have to be hidden and
* the extension will be notified through {@link QuickInput.onDidHide}.
* (Examples include: an explicit call to {@link QuickInput.hide},
* the user pressing Esc, some other input UI opening, etc.)
*
* A user pressing Enter or some other gesture implying acceptance
* of the current state does not automatically hide this UI component.
* It is up to the extension to decide whether to accept the user's input
* and if the UI should indeed be hidden through a call to {@link QuickInput.hide}.
*
* When the extension no longer needs this input UI, it should
* {@link QuickInput.dispose} it to allow for freeing up
* any resources associated with it.
*
* See {@link QuickPick} and {@link InputBox} for concrete UIs.
*/
export interface QuickInput {
/**
* An optional title.
*/
title: string | undefined;
/**
* An optional current step count.
*/
step: number | undefined;
/**
* An optional total step count.
*/
totalSteps: number | undefined;
/**
* If the UI should allow for user input. Defaults to true.
*
* Change this to false, e.g., while validating user input or
* loading data for the next step in user input.
*/
enabled: boolean;
/**
* If the UI should show a progress indicator. Defaults to false.
*
* Change this to true, e.g., while loading more data or validating
* user input.
*/
busy: boolean;
/**
* If the UI should stay open even when loosing UI focus. Defaults to false.
* This setting is ignored on iPad and is always false.
*/
ignoreFocusOut: boolean;
/**
* Makes the input UI visible in its current configuration. Any other input
* UI will first fire an {@link QuickInput.onDidHide} event.
*/
show(): void;
/**
* Hides this input UI. This will also fire an {@link QuickInput.onDidHide}
* event.
*/
hide(): void;
/**
* An event signaling when this input UI is hidden.
*
* There are several reasons why this UI might have to be hidden and
* the extension will be notified through {@link QuickInput.onDidHide}.
* (Examples include: an explicit call to {@link QuickInput.hide},
* the user pressing Esc, some other input UI opening, etc.)
*/
onDidHide: Event<void>;
/**
* Dispose of this input UI and any associated resources. If it is still
* visible, it is first hidden. After this call the input UI is no longer
* functional and no additional methods or properties on it should be
* accessed. Instead a new input UI should be created.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* A concrete {@link QuickInput} to let the user pick an item from a
* list of items of type T. The items can be filtered through a filter text field and
* there is an option {@link QuickPick.canSelectMany canSelectMany} to allow for
* selecting multiple items.
*
* Note that in many cases the more convenient {@link window.showQuickPick}
* is easier to use. {@link window.createQuickPick} should be used
* when {@link window.showQuickPick} does not offer the required flexibility.
*/
export interface QuickPick<T extends QuickPickItem> extends QuickInput {
/**
* Current value of the filter text.
*/
value: string;
/**
* Optional placeholder in the filter text.
*/
placeholder: string | undefined;
/**
* An event signaling when the value of the filter text has changed.
*/
readonly onDidChangeValue: Event<string>;
/**
* An event signaling when the user indicated acceptance of the selected item(s).
*/
readonly onDidAccept: Event<void>;
/**
* Buttons for actions in the UI.
*/
buttons: readonly QuickInputButton[];
/**
* An event signaling when a button in the title bar was triggered.
* This event does not fire for buttons on a {@link QuickPickItem}.
*/
readonly onDidTriggerButton: Event<QuickInputButton>;
/**
* Items to pick from. This can be read and updated by the extension.
*/
items: readonly T[];
/**
* If multiple items can be selected at the same time. Defaults to false.
*/
canSelectMany: boolean;
/**
* If the filter text should also be matched against the description of the items. Defaults to false.
*/
matchOnDescription: boolean;
/**
* If the filter text should also be matched against the detail of the items. Defaults to false.
*/
matchOnDetail: boolean;
/**
* Active items. This can be read and updated by the extension.
*/
activeItems: readonly T[];
/**
* An event signaling when the active items have changed.
*/
readonly onDidChangeActive: Event<readonly T[]>;
/**
* Selected items. This can be read and updated by the extension.
*/
selectedItems: readonly T[];
/**
* An event signaling when the selected items have changed.
*/
readonly onDidChangeSelection: Event<readonly T[]>;
}
/**
* A concrete {@link QuickInput} to let the user input a text value.
*
* Note that in many cases the more convenient {@link window.showInputBox}
* is easier to use. {@link window.createInputBox} should be used
* when {@link window.showInputBox} does not offer the required flexibility.
*/
export interface InputBox extends QuickInput {
/**
* Current input value.
*/
value: string;
/**
* Optional placeholder in the filter text.
*/
placeholder: string | undefined;
/**
* If the input value should be hidden. Defaults to false.
*/
password: boolean;
/**
* An event signaling when the value has changed.
*/
readonly onDidChangeValue: Event<string>;
/**
* An event signaling when the user indicated acceptance of the input value.
*/
readonly onDidAccept: Event<void>;
/**
* Buttons for actions in the UI.
*/
buttons: readonly QuickInputButton[];
/**
* An event signaling when a button was triggered.
*/
readonly onDidTriggerButton: Event<QuickInputButton>;
/**
* An optional prompt text providing some ask or explanation to the user.
*/
prompt: string | undefined;
/**
* An optional validation message indicating a problem with the current input value.
*/
validationMessage: string | undefined;
}
/**
* Button for an action in a {@link QuickPick} or {@link InputBox}.
*/
export interface QuickInputButton {
/**
* Icon for the button.
*/
readonly iconPath: Uri | { light: Uri; dark: Uri } | ThemeIcon;
/**
* An optional tooltip.
*/
readonly tooltip?: string | undefined;
}
/**
* Predefined buttons for {@link QuickPick} and {@link InputBox}.
*/
export class QuickInputButtons {
/**
* A back button for {@link QuickPick} and {@link InputBox}.
*
* When a navigation 'back' button is needed this one should be used for consistency.
* It comes with a predefined icon, tooltip and location.
*/
static readonly Back: QuickInputButton;
/**
* @hidden
*/
private constructor();
}
/**
* An event describing an individual change in the text of a {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
export interface TextDocumentContentChangeEvent {
/**
* The range that got replaced.
*/
readonly range: Range;
/**
* The offset of the range that got replaced.
*/
readonly rangeOffset: number;
/**
* The length of the range that got replaced.
*/
readonly rangeLength: number;
/**
* The new text for the range.
*/
readonly text: string;
}
export enum TextDocumentChangeReason {
/** The text change is caused by an undo operation. */
Undo = 1,
/** The text change is caused by an redo operation. */
Redo = 2,
}
/**
* An event describing a transactional {@link TextDocument document} change.
*/
export interface TextDocumentChangeEvent {
/**
* The affected document.
*/
readonly document: TextDocument;
/**
* An array of content changes.
*/
readonly contentChanges: readonly TextDocumentContentChangeEvent[];
/**
* The reason why the document was changed.
* Is `undefined` if the reason is not known.
*/
readonly reason: TextDocumentChangeReason | undefined;
}
/**
* Represents reasons why a text document is saved.
*/
export enum TextDocumentSaveReason {
/**
* Manually triggered, e.g. by the user pressing save, by starting debugging,
* or by an API call.
*/
Manual = 1,
/**
* Automatic after a delay.
*/
AfterDelay = 2,
/**
* When the editor lost focus.
*/
FocusOut = 3
}
/**
* An event that is fired when a {@link TextDocument document} will be saved.
*
* To make modifications to the document before it is being saved, call the
* {@linkcode TextDocumentWillSaveEvent.waitUntil waitUntil}-function with a thenable
* that resolves to an array of {@link TextEdit text edits}.
*/
export interface TextDocumentWillSaveEvent {
/**
* The document that will be saved.
*/
readonly document: TextDocument;
/**
* The reason why save was triggered.
*/
readonly reason: TextDocumentSaveReason;
/**
* Allows to pause the event loop and to apply {@link TextEdit pre-save-edits}.
* Edits of subsequent calls to this function will be applied in order. The
* edits will be *ignored* if concurrent modifications of the document happened.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch and not
* in an asynchronous manner:
*
* ```ts
* workspace.onWillSaveTextDocument(event => {
* // async, will *throw* an error
* setTimeout(() => event.waitUntil(promise));
*
* // sync, OK
* event.waitUntil(promise);
* })
* ```
*
* @param thenable A thenable that resolves to {@link TextEdit pre-save-edits}.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<TextEdit[]>): void;
/**
* Allows to pause the event loop until the provided thenable resolved.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch.
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<any>): void;
}
/**
* An event that is fired when files are going to be created.
*
* To make modifications to the workspace before the files are created,
* call the {@linkcode FileWillCreateEvent.waitUntil waitUntil}-function with a
* thenable that resolves to a {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*/
export interface FileWillCreateEvent {
/**
* The files that are going to be created.
*/
readonly files: readonly Uri[];
/**
* Allows to pause the event and to apply a {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch and not
* in an asynchronous manner:
*
* ```ts
* workspace.onWillCreateFiles(event => {
* // async, will *throw* an error
* setTimeout(() => event.waitUntil(promise));
*
* // sync, OK
* event.waitUntil(promise);
* })
* ```
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<WorkspaceEdit>): void;
/**
* Allows to pause the event until the provided thenable resolves.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch.
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<any>): void;
}
/**
* An event that is fired after files are created.
*/
export interface FileCreateEvent {
/**
* The files that got created.
*/
readonly files: readonly Uri[];
}
/**
* An event that is fired when files are going to be deleted.
*
* To make modifications to the workspace before the files are deleted,
* call the {@link FileWillCreateEvent.waitUntil `waitUntil}-function with a
* thenable that resolves to a {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*/
export interface FileWillDeleteEvent {
/**
* The files that are going to be deleted.
*/
readonly files: readonly Uri[];
/**
* Allows to pause the event and to apply a {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch and not
* in an asynchronous manner:
*
* ```ts
* workspace.onWillCreateFiles(event => {
* // async, will *throw* an error
* setTimeout(() => event.waitUntil(promise));
*
* // sync, OK
* event.waitUntil(promise);
* })
* ```
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<WorkspaceEdit>): void;
/**
* Allows to pause the event until the provided thenable resolves.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch.
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<any>): void;
}
/**
* An event that is fired after files are deleted.
*/
export interface FileDeleteEvent {
/**
* The files that got deleted.
*/
readonly files: readonly Uri[];
}
/**
* An event that is fired when files are going to be renamed.
*
* To make modifications to the workspace before the files are renamed,
* call the {@link FileWillCreateEvent.waitUntil `waitUntil}-function with a
* thenable that resolves to a {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*/
export interface FileWillRenameEvent {
/**
* The files that are going to be renamed.
*/
readonly files: ReadonlyArray<{ readonly oldUri: Uri, readonly newUri: Uri }>;
/**
* Allows to pause the event and to apply a {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch and not
* in an asynchronous manner:
*
* ```ts
* workspace.onWillCreateFiles(event => {
* // async, will *throw* an error
* setTimeout(() => event.waitUntil(promise));
*
* // sync, OK
* event.waitUntil(promise);
* })
* ```
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<WorkspaceEdit>): void;
/**
* Allows to pause the event until the provided thenable resolves.
*
* *Note:* This function can only be called during event dispatch.
*
* @param thenable A thenable that delays saving.
*/
waitUntil(thenable: Thenable<any>): void;
}
/**
* An event that is fired after files are renamed.
*/
export interface FileRenameEvent {
/**
* The files that got renamed.
*/
readonly files: ReadonlyArray<{ readonly oldUri: Uri, readonly newUri: Uri }>;
}
/**
* An event describing a change to the set of {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders}.
*/
export interface WorkspaceFoldersChangeEvent {
/**
* Added workspace folders.
*/
readonly added: readonly WorkspaceFolder[];
/**
* Removed workspace folders.
*/
readonly removed: readonly WorkspaceFolder[];
}
/**
* A workspace folder is one of potentially many roots opened by the editor. All workspace folders
* are equal which means there is no notion of an active or primary workspace folder.
*/
export interface WorkspaceFolder {
/**
* The associated uri for this workspace folder.
*
* *Note:* The {@link Uri}-type was intentionally chosen such that future releases of the editor can support
* workspace folders that are not stored on the local disk, e.g. `ftp://server/workspaces/foo`.
*/
readonly uri: Uri;
/**
* The name of this workspace folder. Defaults to
* the basename of its {@link Uri.path uri-path}
*/
readonly name: string;
/**
* The ordinal number of this workspace folder.
*/
readonly index: number;
}
/**
* Namespace for dealing with the current workspace. A workspace is the collection of one
* or more folders that are opened in an editor window (instance).
*
* It is also possible to open an editor without a workspace. For example, when you open a
* new editor window by selecting a file from your platform's File menu, you will not be
* inside a workspace. In this mode, some of the editor's capabilities are reduced but you can
* still open text files and edit them.
*
* Refer to https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/workspaces for more information on
* the concept of workspaces.
*
* The workspace offers support for {@link workspace.createFileSystemWatcher listening} to fs
* events and for {@link workspace.findFiles finding} files. Both perform well and run _outside_
* the editor-process so that they should be always used instead of nodejs-equivalents.
*/
export namespace workspace {
/**
* A {@link FileSystem file system} instance that allows to interact with local and remote
* files, e.g. `vscode.workspace.fs.readDirectory(someUri)` allows to retrieve all entries
* of a directory or `vscode.workspace.fs.stat(anotherUri)` returns the meta data for a
* file.
*/
export const fs: FileSystem;
/**
* The uri of the first entry of {@linkcode workspace.workspaceFolders workspaceFolders}
* as `string`. `undefined` if there is no first entry.
*
* Refer to https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/workspaces for more information
* on workspaces.
*
* @deprecated Use {@linkcode workspace.workspaceFolders workspaceFolders} instead.
*/
export const rootPath: string | undefined;
/**
* List of workspace folders (0-N) that are open in the editor. `undefined` when no workspace
* has been opened.
*
* Refer to https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/workspaces for more information
* on workspaces.
*/
export const workspaceFolders: readonly WorkspaceFolder[] | undefined;
/**
* The name of the workspace. `undefined` when no workspace
* has been opened.
*
* Refer to https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/workspaces for more information on
* the concept of workspaces.
*/
export const name: string | undefined;
/**
* The location of the workspace file, for example:
*
* `file:///Users/name/Development/myProject.code-workspace`
*
* or
*
* `untitled:1555503116870`
*
* for a workspace that is untitled and not yet saved.
*
* Depending on the workspace that is opened, the value will be:
* * `undefined` when no workspace is opened
* * the path of the workspace file as `Uri` otherwise. if the workspace
* is untitled, the returned URI will use the `untitled:` scheme
*
* The location can e.g. be used with the `vscode.openFolder` command to
* open the workspace again after it has been closed.
*
* **Example:**
* ```typescript
* vscode.commands.executeCommand('vscode.openFolder', uriOfWorkspace);
* ```
*
* Refer to https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/workspaces for more information on
* the concept of workspaces.
*
* **Note:** it is not advised to use `workspace.workspaceFile` to write
* configuration data into the file. You can use `workspace.getConfiguration().update()`
* for that purpose which will work both when a single folder is opened as
* well as an untitled or saved workspace.
*/
export const workspaceFile: Uri | undefined;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a workspace folder is added or removed.
*/
export const onDidChangeWorkspaceFolders: Event<WorkspaceFoldersChangeEvent>;
/**
* Returns the {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder} that contains a given uri.
* * returns `undefined` when the given uri doesn't match any workspace folder
* * returns the *input* when the given uri is a workspace folder itself
*
* @param uri An uri.
* @return A workspace folder or `undefined`
*/
export function getWorkspaceFolder(uri: Uri): WorkspaceFolder | undefined;
/**
* Returns a path that is relative to the workspace folder or folders.
*
* When there are no {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders} or when the path
* is not contained in them, the input is returned.
*
* @param pathOrUri A path or uri. When a uri is given its {@link Uri.fsPath fsPath} is used.
* @param includeWorkspaceFolder When `true` and when the given path is contained inside a
* workspace folder the name of the workspace is prepended. Defaults to `true` when there are
* multiple workspace folders and `false` otherwise.
* @return A path relative to the root or the input.
*/
export function asRelativePath(pathOrUri: string | Uri, includeWorkspaceFolder?: boolean): string;
/**
* This method replaces `deleteCount` {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders} starting at index `start`
* by an optional set of `workspaceFoldersToAdd` on the `vscode.workspace.workspaceFolders` array. This "splice"
* behavior can be used to add, remove and change workspace folders in a single operation.
*
* If the first workspace folder is added, removed or changed, the currently executing extensions (including the
* one that called this method) will be terminated and restarted so that the (deprecated) `rootPath` property is
* updated to point to the first workspace folder.
*
* Use the {@linkcode onDidChangeWorkspaceFolders onDidChangeWorkspaceFolders()} event to get notified when the
* workspace folders have been updated.
*
* **Example:** adding a new workspace folder at the end of workspace folders
* ```typescript
* workspace.updateWorkspaceFolders(workspace.workspaceFolders ? workspace.workspaceFolders.length : 0, null, { uri: ...});
* ```
*
* **Example:** removing the first workspace folder
* ```typescript
* workspace.updateWorkspaceFolders(0, 1);
* ```
*
* **Example:** replacing an existing workspace folder with a new one
* ```typescript
* workspace.updateWorkspaceFolders(0, 1, { uri: ...});
* ```
*
* It is valid to remove an existing workspace folder and add it again with a different name
* to rename that folder.
*
* **Note:** it is not valid to call {@link updateWorkspaceFolders updateWorkspaceFolders()} multiple times
* without waiting for the {@linkcode onDidChangeWorkspaceFolders onDidChangeWorkspaceFolders()} to fire.
*
* @param start the zero-based location in the list of currently opened {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folders}
* from which to start deleting workspace folders.
* @param deleteCount the optional number of workspace folders to remove.
* @param workspaceFoldersToAdd the optional variable set of workspace folders to add in place of the deleted ones.
* Each workspace is identified with a mandatory URI and an optional name.
* @return true if the operation was successfully started and false otherwise if arguments were used that would result
* in invalid workspace folder state (e.g. 2 folders with the same URI).
*/
export function updateWorkspaceFolders(start: number, deleteCount: number | undefined | null, ...workspaceFoldersToAdd: { uri: Uri, name?: string }[]): boolean;
/**
* Creates a file system watcher.
*
* A glob pattern that filters the file events on their absolute path must be provided. Optionally,
* flags to ignore certain kinds of events can be provided. To stop listening to events the watcher must be disposed.
*
* *Note* that only files within the current {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders} can be watched.
* *Note* that when watching for file changes such as '**/*.js', notifications will not be sent when a parent folder is
* moved or deleted (this is a known limitation of the current implementation and may change in the future).
*
* @param globPattern A {@link GlobPattern glob pattern} that is applied to the absolute paths of created, changed,
* and deleted files. Use a {@link RelativePattern relative pattern} to limit events to a certain {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder}.
* @param ignoreCreateEvents Ignore when files have been created.
* @param ignoreChangeEvents Ignore when files have been changed.
* @param ignoreDeleteEvents Ignore when files have been deleted.
* @return A new file system watcher instance.
*/
export function createFileSystemWatcher(globPattern: GlobPattern, ignoreCreateEvents?: boolean, ignoreChangeEvents?: boolean, ignoreDeleteEvents?: boolean): FileSystemWatcher;
/**
* Find files across all {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders} in the workspace.
*
* @example
* findFiles('**/*.js', '**/node_modules/**', 10)
*
* @param include A {@link GlobPattern glob pattern} that defines the files to search for. The glob pattern
* will be matched against the file paths of resulting matches relative to their workspace. Use a {@link RelativePattern relative pattern}
* to restrict the search results to a {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder}.
* @param exclude A {@link GlobPattern glob pattern} that defines files and folders to exclude. The glob pattern
* will be matched against the file paths of resulting matches relative to their workspace. When `undefined`, default file-excludes (e.g. the `files.exclude`-setting
* but not `search.exclude`) will apply. When `null`, no excludes will apply.
* @param maxResults An upper-bound for the result.
* @param token A token that can be used to signal cancellation to the underlying search engine.
* @return A thenable that resolves to an array of resource identifiers. Will return no results if no
* {@link workspace.workspaceFolders workspace folders} are opened.
*/
export function findFiles(include: GlobPattern, exclude?: GlobPattern | null, maxResults?: number, token?: CancellationToken): Thenable<Uri[]>;
/**
* Save all dirty files.
*
* @param includeUntitled Also save files that have been created during this session.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the files have been saved.
*/
export function saveAll(includeUntitled?: boolean): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* Make changes to one or many resources or create, delete, and rename resources as defined by the given
* {@link WorkspaceEdit workspace edit}.
*
* All changes of a workspace edit are applied in the same order in which they have been added. If
* multiple textual inserts are made at the same position, these strings appear in the resulting text
* in the order the 'inserts' were made, unless that are interleaved with resource edits. Invalid sequences
* like 'delete file a' -> 'insert text in file a' cause failure of the operation.
*
* When applying a workspace edit that consists only of text edits an 'all-or-nothing'-strategy is used.
* A workspace edit with resource creations or deletions aborts the operation, e.g. consecutive edits will
* not be attempted, when a single edit fails.
*
* @param edit A workspace edit.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the edit could be applied.
*/
export function applyEdit(edit: WorkspaceEdit): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* All text documents currently known to the editor.
*/
export const textDocuments: readonly TextDocument[];
/**
* Opens a document. Will return early if this document is already open. Otherwise
* the document is loaded and the {@link workspace.onDidOpenTextDocument didOpen}-event fires.
*
* The document is denoted by an {@link Uri}. Depending on the {@link Uri.scheme scheme} the
* following rules apply:
* * `file`-scheme: Open a file on disk (`openTextDocument(Uri.file(path))`). Will be rejected if the file
* does not exist or cannot be loaded.
* * `untitled`-scheme: Open a blank untitled file with associated path (`openTextDocument(Uri.file(path).with({ scheme: 'untitled' }))`).
* The language will be derived from the file name.
* * For all other schemes contributed {@link TextDocumentContentProvider text document content providers} and
* {@link FileSystemProvider file system providers} are consulted.
*
* *Note* that the lifecycle of the returned document is owned by the editor and not by the extension. That means an
* {@linkcode workspace.onDidCloseTextDocument onDidClose}-event can occur at any time after opening it.
*
* @param uri Identifies the resource to open.
* @return A promise that resolves to a {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
export function openTextDocument(uri: Uri): Thenable<TextDocument>;
/**
* A short-hand for `openTextDocument(Uri.file(fileName))`.
*
* @see {@link openTextDocument}
* @param fileName A name of a file on disk.
* @return A promise that resolves to a {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
export function openTextDocument(fileName: string): Thenable<TextDocument>;
/**
* Opens an untitled text document. The editor will prompt the user for a file
* path when the document is to be saved. The `options` parameter allows to
* specify the *language* and/or the *content* of the document.
*
* @param options Options to control how the document will be created.
* @return A promise that resolves to a {@link TextDocument document}.
*/
export function openTextDocument(options?: { language?: string; content?: string; }): Thenable<TextDocument>;
/**
* Register a text document content provider.
*
* Only one provider can be registered per scheme.
*
* @param scheme The uri-scheme to register for.
* @param provider A content provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerTextDocumentContentProvider(scheme: string, provider: TextDocumentContentProvider): Disposable;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link TextDocument text document} is opened or when the language id
* of a text document {@link languages.setTextDocumentLanguage has been changed}.
*
* To add an event listener when a visible text document is opened, use the {@link TextEditor} events in the
* {@link window} namespace. Note that:
*
* - The event is emitted before the {@link TextDocument document} is updated in the
* {@link window.activeTextEditor active text editor}
* - When a {@link TextDocument text document} is already open (e.g.: open in another {@link window.visibleTextEditors visible text editor}) this event is not emitted
*
*/
export const onDidOpenTextDocument: Event<TextDocument>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link TextDocument text document} is disposed or when the language id
* of a text document {@link languages.setTextDocumentLanguage has been changed}.
*
* *Note 1:* There is no guarantee that this event fires when an editor tab is closed, use the
* {@linkcode window.onDidChangeVisibleTextEditors onDidChangeVisibleTextEditors}-event to know when editors change.
*
* *Note 2:* A document can be open but not shown in an editor which means this event can fire
* for a document that has not been shown in an editor.
*/
export const onDidCloseTextDocument: Event<TextDocument>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link TextDocument text document} is changed. This usually happens
* when the {@link TextDocument.getText contents} changes but also when other things like the
* {@link TextDocument.isDirty dirty}-state changes.
*/
export const onDidChangeTextDocument: Event<TextDocumentChangeEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link TextDocument text document} will be saved to disk.
*
* *Note 1:* Subscribers can delay saving by registering asynchronous work. For the sake of data integrity the editor
* might save without firing this event. For instance when shutting down with dirty files.
*
* *Note 2:* Subscribers are called sequentially and they can {@link TextDocumentWillSaveEvent.waitUntil delay} saving
* by registering asynchronous work. Protection against misbehaving listeners is implemented as such:
* * there is an overall time budget that all listeners share and if that is exhausted no further listener is called
* * listeners that take a long time or produce errors frequently will not be called anymore
*
* The current thresholds are 1.5 seconds as overall time budget and a listener can misbehave 3 times before being ignored.
*/
export const onWillSaveTextDocument: Event<TextDocumentWillSaveEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link TextDocument text document} is saved to disk.
*/
export const onDidSaveTextDocument: Event<TextDocument>;
/**
* All notebook documents currently known to the editor.
*/
export const notebookDocuments: readonly NotebookDocument[];
/**
* Open a notebook. Will return early if this notebook is already {@link notebook.notebookDocuments loaded}. Otherwise
* the notebook is loaded and the {@linkcode notebook.onDidOpenNotebookDocument onDidOpenNotebookDocument}-event fires.
*
* *Note* that the lifecycle of the returned notebook is owned by the editor and not by the extension. That means an
* {@linkcode notebook.onDidCloseNotebookDocument onDidCloseNotebookDocument}-event can occur at any time after.
*
* *Note* that opening a notebook does not show a notebook editor. This function only returns a notebook document which
* can be showns in a notebook editor but it can also be used for other things.
*
* @param uri The resource to open.
* @returns A promise that resolves to a {@link NotebookDocument notebook}
*/
export function openNotebookDocument(uri: Uri): Thenable<NotebookDocument>;
/**
* Open an untitled notebook. The editor will prompt the user for a file
* path when the document is to be saved.
*
* @see {@link openNotebookDocument}
* @param notebookType The notebook type that should be used.
* @param content The initial contents of the notebook.
* @returns A promise that resolves to a {@link NotebookDocument notebook}.
*/
export function openNotebookDocument(notebookType: string, content?: NotebookData): Thenable<NotebookDocument>;
/**
* Register a {@link NotebookSerializer notebook serializer}.
*
* A notebook serializer must be contributed through the `notebooks` extension point. When opening a notebook file, the editor will send
* the `onNotebook:<notebookType>` activation event, and extensions must register their serializer in return.
*
* @param notebookType A notebook.
* @param serializer A notebook serialzier.
* @param options Optional context options that define what parts of a notebook should be persisted
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this serializer when being disposed.
*/
export function registerNotebookSerializer(notebookType: string, serializer: NotebookSerializer, options?: NotebookDocumentContentOptions): Disposable;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link NotebookDocument notebook} is opened.
*/
export const onDidOpenNotebookDocument: Event<NotebookDocument>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when a {@link NotebookDocument notebook} is disposed.
*
* *Note 1:* There is no guarantee that this event fires when an editor tab is closed.
*
* *Note 2:* A notebook can be open but not shown in an editor which means this event can fire
* for a notebook that has not been shown in an editor.
*/
export const onDidCloseNotebookDocument: Event<NotebookDocument>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when files are being created.
*
* *Note 1:* This event is triggered by user gestures, like creating a file from the
* explorer, or from the {@linkcode workspace.applyEdit}-api. This event is *not* fired when
* files change on disk, e.g triggered by another application, or when using the
* {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs}-api.
*
* *Note 2:* When this event is fired, edits to files that are are being created cannot be applied.
*/
export const onWillCreateFiles: Event<FileWillCreateEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when files have been created.
*
* *Note:* This event is triggered by user gestures, like creating a file from the
* explorer, or from the {@linkcode workspace.applyEdit}-api, but this event is *not* fired when
* files change on disk, e.g triggered by another application, or when using the
* {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs}-api.
*/
export const onDidCreateFiles: Event<FileCreateEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when files are being deleted.
*
* *Note 1:* This event is triggered by user gestures, like deleting a file from the
* explorer, or from the {@linkcode workspace.applyEdit}-api, but this event is *not* fired when
* files change on disk, e.g triggered by another application, or when using the
* {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs}-api.
*
* *Note 2:* When deleting a folder with children only one event is fired.
*/
export const onWillDeleteFiles: Event<FileWillDeleteEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when files have been deleted.
*
* *Note 1:* This event is triggered by user gestures, like deleting a file from the
* explorer, or from the {@linkcode workspace.applyEdit}-api, but this event is *not* fired when
* files change on disk, e.g triggered by another application, or when using the
* {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs}-api.
*
* *Note 2:* When deleting a folder with children only one event is fired.
*/
export const onDidDeleteFiles: Event<FileDeleteEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when files are being renamed.
*
* *Note 1:* This event is triggered by user gestures, like renaming a file from the
* explorer, and from the {@linkcode workspace.applyEdit}-api, but this event is *not* fired when
* files change on disk, e.g triggered by another application, or when using the
* {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs}-api.
*
* *Note 2:* When renaming a folder with children only one event is fired.
*/
export const onWillRenameFiles: Event<FileWillRenameEvent>;
/**
* An event that is emitted when files have been renamed.
*
* *Note 1:* This event is triggered by user gestures, like renaming a file from the
* explorer, and from the {@linkcode workspace.applyEdit}-api, but this event is *not* fired when
* files change on disk, e.g triggered by another application, or when using the
* {@linkcode FileSystem workspace.fs}-api.
*
* *Note 2:* When renaming a folder with children only one event is fired.
*/
export const onDidRenameFiles: Event<FileRenameEvent>;
/**
* Get a workspace configuration object.
*
* When a section-identifier is provided only that part of the configuration
* is returned. Dots in the section-identifier are interpreted as child-access,
* like `{ myExt: { setting: { doIt: true }}}` and `getConfiguration('myExt.setting').get('doIt') === true`.
*
* When a scope is provided configuration confined to that scope is returned. Scope can be a resource or a language identifier or both.
*
* @param section A dot-separated identifier.
* @param scope A scope for which the configuration is asked for.
* @return The full configuration or a subset.
*/
export function getConfiguration(section?: string, scope?: ConfigurationScope | null): WorkspaceConfiguration;
/**
* An event that is emitted when the {@link WorkspaceConfiguration configuration} changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeConfiguration: Event<ConfigurationChangeEvent>;
/**
* Register a task provider.
*
* @deprecated Use the corresponding function on the `tasks` namespace instead
*
* @param type The task kind type this provider is registered for.
* @param provider A task provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerTaskProvider(type: string, provider: TaskProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a filesystem provider for a given scheme, e.g. `ftp`.
*
* There can only be one provider per scheme and an error is being thrown when a scheme
* has been claimed by another provider or when it is reserved.
*
* @param scheme The uri-{@link Uri.scheme scheme} the provider registers for.
* @param provider The filesystem provider.
* @param options Immutable metadata about the provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerFileSystemProvider(scheme: string, provider: FileSystemProvider, options?: { readonly isCaseSensitive?: boolean, readonly isReadonly?: boolean }): Disposable;
/**
* When true, the user has explicitly trusted the contents of the workspace.
*/
export const isTrusted: boolean;
/**
* Event that fires when the current workspace has been trusted.
*/
export const onDidGrantWorkspaceTrust: Event<void>;
}
/**
* The configuration scope which can be a
* a 'resource' or a languageId or both or
* a '{@link TextDocument}' or
* a '{@link WorkspaceFolder}'
*/
export type ConfigurationScope = Uri | TextDocument | WorkspaceFolder | { uri?: Uri, languageId: string };
/**
* An event describing the change in Configuration
*/
export interface ConfigurationChangeEvent {
/**
* Checks if the given section has changed.
* If scope is provided, checks if the section has changed for resources under the given scope.
*
* @param section Configuration name, supports _dotted_ names.
* @param scope A scope in which to check.
* @return `true` if the given section has changed.
*/
affectsConfiguration(section: string, scope?: ConfigurationScope): boolean;
}
/**
* Namespace for participating in language-specific editor [features](https://code.visualstudio.com/docs/editor/editingevolved),
* like IntelliSense, code actions, diagnostics etc.
*
* Many programming languages exist and there is huge variety in syntaxes, semantics, and paradigms. Despite that, features
* like automatic word-completion, code navigation, or code checking have become popular across different tools for different
* programming languages.
*
* The editor provides an API that makes it simple to provide such common features by having all UI and actions already in place and
* by allowing you to participate by providing data only. For instance, to contribute a hover all you have to do is provide a function
* that can be called with a {@link TextDocument} and a {@link Position} returning hover info. The rest, like tracking the
* mouse, positioning the hover, keeping the hover stable etc. is taken care of by the editor.
*
* ```javascript
* languages.registerHoverProvider('javascript', {
* provideHover(document, position, token) {
* return new Hover('I am a hover!');
* }
* });
* ```
*
* Registration is done using a {@link DocumentSelector document selector} which is either a language id, like `javascript` or
* a more complex {@link DocumentFilter filter} like `{ language: 'typescript', scheme: 'file' }`. Matching a document against such
* a selector will result in a {@link languages.match score} that is used to determine if and how a provider shall be used. When
* scores are equal the provider that came last wins. For features that allow full arity, like {@link languages.registerHoverProvider hover},
* the score is only checked to be `>0`, for other features, like {@link languages.registerCompletionItemProvider IntelliSense} the
* score is used for determining the order in which providers are asked to participate.
*/
export namespace languages {
/**
* Return the identifiers of all known languages.
* @return Promise resolving to an array of identifier strings.
*/
export function getLanguages(): Thenable<string[]>;
/**
* Set (and change) the {@link TextDocument.languageId language} that is associated
* with the given document.
*
* *Note* that calling this function will trigger the {@linkcode workspace.onDidCloseTextDocument onDidCloseTextDocument} event
* followed by the {@linkcode workspace.onDidOpenTextDocument onDidOpenTextDocument} event.
*
* @param document The document which language is to be changed
* @param languageId The new language identifier.
* @returns A thenable that resolves with the updated document.
*/
export function setTextDocumentLanguage(document: TextDocument, languageId: string): Thenable<TextDocument>;
/**
* Compute the match between a document {@link DocumentSelector selector} and a document. Values
* greater than zero mean the selector matches the document.
*
* A match is computed according to these rules:
* 1. When {@linkcode DocumentSelector} is an array, compute the match for each contained `DocumentFilter` or language identifier and take the maximum value.
* 2. A string will be desugared to become the `language`-part of a {@linkcode DocumentFilter}, so `"fooLang"` is like `{ language: "fooLang" }`.
* 3. A {@linkcode DocumentFilter} will be matched against the document by comparing its parts with the document. The following rules apply:
* 1. When the `DocumentFilter` is empty (`{}`) the result is `0`
* 2. When `scheme`, `language`, or `pattern` are defined but one doesn't match, the result is `0`
* 3. Matching against `*` gives a score of `5`, matching via equality or via a glob-pattern gives a score of `10`
* 4. The result is the maximum value of each match
*
* Samples:
* ```js
* // default document from disk (file-scheme)
* doc.uri; //'file:///my/file.js'
* doc.languageId; // 'javascript'
* match('javascript', doc); // 10;
* match({language: 'javascript'}, doc); // 10;
* match({language: 'javascript', scheme: 'file'}, doc); // 10;
* match('*', doc); // 5
* match('fooLang', doc); // 0
* match(['fooLang', '*'], doc); // 5
*
* // virtual document, e.g. from git-index
* doc.uri; // 'git:/my/file.js'
* doc.languageId; // 'javascript'
* match('javascript', doc); // 10;
* match({language: 'javascript', scheme: 'git'}, doc); // 10;
* match('*', doc); // 5
* ```
*
* @param selector A document selector.
* @param document A text document.
* @return A number `>0` when the selector matches and `0` when the selector does not match.
*/
export function match(selector: DocumentSelector, document: TextDocument): number;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the global set of diagnostics changes. This is
* newly added and removed diagnostics.
*/
export const onDidChangeDiagnostics: Event<DiagnosticChangeEvent>;
/**
* Get all diagnostics for a given resource.
*
* @param resource A resource
* @returns An array of {@link Diagnostic diagnostics} objects or an empty array.
*/
export function getDiagnostics(resource: Uri): Diagnostic[];
/**
* Get all diagnostics.
*
* @returns An array of uri-diagnostics tuples or an empty array.
*/
export function getDiagnostics(): [Uri, Diagnostic[]][];
/**
* Create a diagnostics collection.
*
* @param name The {@link DiagnosticCollection.name name} of the collection.
* @return A new diagnostic collection.
*/
export function createDiagnosticCollection(name?: string): DiagnosticCollection;
/**
* Register a completion provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and groups of equal score are sequentially asked for
* completion items. The process stops when one or many providers of a group return a
* result. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will not fail the whole
* operation.
*
* A completion item provider can be associated with a set of `triggerCharacters`. When trigger
* characters are being typed, completions are requested but only from providers that registered
* the typed character. Because of that trigger characters should be different than {@link LanguageConfiguration.wordPattern word characters},
* a common trigger character is `.` to trigger member completions.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A completion provider.
* @param triggerCharacters Trigger completion when the user types one of the characters.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerCompletionItemProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: CompletionItemProvider, ...triggerCharacters: string[]): Disposable;
/**
* Register a code action provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A code action provider.
* @param metadata Metadata about the kind of code actions the provider provides.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerCodeActionsProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: CodeActionProvider, metadata?: CodeActionProviderMetadata): Disposable;
/**
* Register a code lens provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A code lens provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerCodeLensProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: CodeLensProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a definition provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A definition provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDefinitionProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DefinitionProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register an implementation provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider An implementation provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerImplementationProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: ImplementationProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a type definition provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A type definition provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerTypeDefinitionProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: TypeDefinitionProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a declaration provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A declaration provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDeclarationProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DeclarationProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a hover provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A hover provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerHoverProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: HoverProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a provider that locates evaluatable expressions in text documents.
* The editor will evaluate the expression in the active debug session and will show the result in the debug hover.
*
* If multiple providers are registered for a language an arbitrary provider will be used.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider An evaluatable expression provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerEvaluatableExpressionProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: EvaluatableExpressionProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a provider that returns data for the debugger's 'inline value' feature.
* Whenever the generic debugger has stopped in a source file, providers registered for the language of the file
* are called to return textual data that will be shown in the editor at the end of lines.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider An inline values provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerInlineValuesProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: InlineValuesProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a document highlight provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and groups sequentially asked for document highlights.
* The process stops when a provider returns a `non-falsy` or `non-failure` result.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document highlight provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentHighlightProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentHighlightProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a document symbol provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document symbol provider.
* @param metaData metadata about the provider
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentSymbolProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentSymbolProvider, metaData?: DocumentSymbolProviderMetadata): Disposable;
/**
* Register a workspace symbol provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered. In that case providers are asked in parallel and
* the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will not cause
* a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param provider A workspace symbol provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerWorkspaceSymbolProvider(provider: WorkspaceSymbolProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a reference provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A reference provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerReferenceProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: ReferenceProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a rename provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and asked in sequence. The first provider producing a result
* defines the result of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A rename provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerRenameProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: RenameProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a semantic tokens provider for a whole document.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and the best-matching provider is used. Failure
* of the selected provider will cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document semantic tokens provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentSemanticTokensProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentSemanticTokensProvider, legend: SemanticTokensLegend): Disposable;
/**
* Register a semantic tokens provider for a document range.
*
* *Note:* If a document has both a `DocumentSemanticTokensProvider` and a `DocumentRangeSemanticTokensProvider`,
* the range provider will be invoked only initially, for the time in which the full document provider takes
* to resolve the first request. Once the full document provider resolves the first request, the semantic tokens
* provided via the range provider will be discarded and from that point forward, only the document provider
* will be used.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and the best-matching provider is used. Failure
* of the selected provider will cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document range semantic tokens provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentRangeSemanticTokensProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentRangeSemanticTokensProvider, legend: SemanticTokensLegend): Disposable;
/**
* Register a formatting provider for a document.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and the best-matching provider is used. Failure
* of the selected provider will cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document formatting edit provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentFormattingEditProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentFormattingEditProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a formatting provider for a document range.
*
* *Note:* A document range provider is also a {@link DocumentFormattingEditProvider document formatter}
* which means there is no need to {@link languages.registerDocumentFormattingEditProvider register} a document
* formatter when also registering a range provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and the best-matching provider is used. Failure
* of the selected provider will cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document range formatting edit provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentRangeFormattingEditProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentRangeFormattingEditProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a formatting provider that works on type. The provider is active when the user enables the setting `editor.formatOnType`.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and the best-matching provider is used. Failure
* of the selected provider will cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider An on type formatting edit provider.
* @param firstTriggerCharacter A character on which formatting should be triggered, like `}`.
* @param moreTriggerCharacter More trigger characters.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerOnTypeFormattingEditProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: OnTypeFormattingEditProvider, firstTriggerCharacter: string, ...moreTriggerCharacter: string[]): Disposable;
/**
* Register a signature help provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and called sequentially until a provider returns a
* valid result.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A signature help provider.
* @param triggerCharacters Trigger signature help when the user types one of the characters, like `,` or `(`.
* @param metadata Information about the provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerSignatureHelpProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: SignatureHelpProvider, ...triggerCharacters: string[]): Disposable;
export function registerSignatureHelpProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: SignatureHelpProvider, metadata: SignatureHelpProviderMetadata): Disposable;
/**
* Register a document link provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A document link provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDocumentLinkProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentLinkProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a color provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A color provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerColorProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: DocumentColorProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a folding range provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged.
* If multiple folding ranges start at the same position, only the range of the first registered provider is used.
* If a folding range overlaps with an other range that has a smaller position, it is also ignored.
*
* A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A folding range provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerFoldingRangeProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: FoldingRangeProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a selection range provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are asked in
* parallel and the results are merged. A failing provider (rejected promise or exception) will
* not cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A selection range provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerSelectionRangeProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: SelectionRangeProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a call hierarchy provider.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A call hierarchy provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerCallHierarchyProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: CallHierarchyProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a type hierarchy provider.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A type hierarchy provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerTypeHierarchyProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: TypeHierarchyProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Register a linked editing range provider.
*
* Multiple providers can be registered for a language. In that case providers are sorted
* by their {@link languages.match score} and the best-matching provider that has a result is used. Failure
* of the selected provider will cause a failure of the whole operation.
*
* @param selector A selector that defines the documents this provider is applicable to.
* @param provider A linked editing range provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerLinkedEditingRangeProvider(selector: DocumentSelector, provider: LinkedEditingRangeProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Set a {@link LanguageConfiguration language configuration} for a language.
*
* @param language A language identifier like `typescript`.
* @param configuration Language configuration.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unsets this configuration.
*/
export function setLanguageConfiguration(language: string, configuration: LanguageConfiguration): Disposable;
}
/**
* A notebook cell kind.
*/
export enum NotebookCellKind {
/**
* A markup-cell is formatted source that is used for display.
*/
Markup = 1,
/**
* A code-cell is source that can be {@link NotebookController executed} and that
* produces {@link NotebookCellOutput output}.
*/
Code = 2
}
/**
* Represents a cell of a {@link NotebookDocument notebook}, either a {@link NotebookCellKind.Code code}-cell
* or {@link NotebookCellKind.Markup markup}-cell.
*
* NotebookCell instances are immutable and are kept in sync for as long as they are part of their notebook.
*/
export interface NotebookCell {
/**
* The index of this cell in its {@link NotebookDocument.cellAt containing notebook}. The
* index is updated when a cell is moved within its notebook. The index is `-1`
* when the cell has been removed from its notebook.
*/
readonly index: number;
/**
* The {@link NotebookDocument notebook} that contains this cell.
*/
readonly notebook: NotebookDocument;
/**
* The kind of this cell.
*/
readonly kind: NotebookCellKind;
/**
* The {@link TextDocument text} of this cell, represented as text document.
*/
readonly document: TextDocument;
/**
* The metadata of this cell. Can be anything but must be JSON-stringifyable.
*/
readonly metadata: { [key: string]: any };
/**
* The outputs of this cell.
*/
readonly outputs: readonly NotebookCellOutput[];
/**
* The most recent {@link NotebookCellExecutionSummary execution summary} for this cell.
*/
readonly executionSummary: NotebookCellExecutionSummary | undefined;
}
/**
* Represents a notebook editor that is attached to a {@link NotebookDocument notebook}.
* Additional properties of the NotebookEditor are available in the proposed
* API, which will be finalized later.
*/
export interface NotebookEditor {
}
/**
* Renderer messaging is used to communicate with a single renderer. It's returned from {@link notebooks.createRendererMessaging}.
*/
export interface NotebookRendererMessaging {
/**
* An event that fires when a message is received from a renderer.
*/
readonly onDidReceiveMessage: Event<{
readonly editor: NotebookEditor;
readonly message: any;
}>;
/**
* Send a message to one or all renderer.
*
* @param message Message to send
* @param editor Editor to target with the message. If not provided, the
* message is sent to all renderers.
* @returns a boolean indicating whether the message was successfully
* delivered to any renderer.
*/
postMessage(message: any, editor?: NotebookEditor): Thenable<boolean>;
}
/**
* Represents a notebook which itself is a sequence of {@link NotebookCell code or markup cells}. Notebook documents are
* created from {@link NotebookData notebook data}.
*/
export interface NotebookDocument {
/**
* The associated uri for this notebook.
*
* *Note* that most notebooks use the `file`-scheme, which means they are files on disk. However, **not** all notebooks are
* saved on disk and therefore the `scheme` must be checked before trying to access the underlying file or siblings on disk.
*
* @see {@link FileSystemProvider}
*/
readonly uri: Uri;
/**
* The type of notebook.
*/
readonly notebookType: string;
/**
* The version number of this notebook (it will strictly increase after each
* change, including undo/redo).
*/
readonly version: number;
/**
* `true` if there are unpersisted changes.
*/
readonly isDirty: boolean;
/**
* Is this notebook representing an untitled file which has not been saved yet.
*/
readonly isUntitled: boolean;
/**
* `true` if the notebook has been closed. A closed notebook isn't synchronized anymore
* and won't be re-used when the same resource is opened again.
*/
readonly isClosed: boolean;
/**
* Arbitrary metadata for this notebook. Can be anything but must be JSON-stringifyable.
*/
readonly metadata: { [key: string]: any };
/**
* The number of cells in the notebook.
*/
readonly cellCount: number;
/**
* Return the cell at the specified index. The index will be adjusted to the notebook.
*
* @param index - The index of the cell to retrieve.
* @return A {@link NotebookCell cell}.
*/
cellAt(index: number): NotebookCell;
/**
* Get the cells of this notebook. A subset can be retrieved by providing
* a range. The range will be adjusted to the notebook.
*
* @param range A notebook range.
* @returns The cells contained by the range or all cells.
*/
getCells(range?: NotebookRange): NotebookCell[];
/**
* Save the document. The saving will be handled by the corresponding {@link NotebookSerializer serializer}.
*
* @return A promise that will resolve to true when the document
* has been saved. Will return false if the file was not dirty or when save failed.
*/
save(): Thenable<boolean>;
}
/**
* The summary of a notebook cell execution.
*/
export interface NotebookCellExecutionSummary {
/**
* The order in which the execution happened.
*/
readonly executionOrder?: number;
/**
* If the execution finished successfully.
*/
readonly success?: boolean;
/**
* The times at which execution started and ended, as unix timestamps
*/
readonly timing?: { startTime: number, endTime: number };
}
/**
* A notebook range represents an ordered pair of two cell indices.
* It is guaranteed that start is less than or equal to end.
*/
export class NotebookRange {
/**
* The zero-based start index of this range.
*/
readonly start: number;
/**
* The exclusive end index of this range (zero-based).
*/
readonly end: number;
/**
* `true` if `start` and `end` are equal.
*/
readonly isEmpty: boolean;
/**
* Create a new notebook range. If `start` is not
* before or equal to `end`, the values will be swapped.
*
* @param start start index
* @param end end index.
*/
constructor(start: number, end: number);
/**
* Derive a new range for this range.
*
* @param change An object that describes a change to this range.
* @return A range that reflects the given change. Will return `this` range if the change
* is not changing anything.
*/
with(change: { start?: number, end?: number }): NotebookRange;
}
/**
* One representation of a {@link NotebookCellOutput notebook output}, defined by MIME type and data.
*/
export class NotebookCellOutputItem {
/**
* Factory function to create a `NotebookCellOutputItem` from a string.
*
* *Note* that an UTF-8 encoder is used to create bytes for the string.
*
* @param value A string.
* @param mime Optional MIME type, defaults to `text/plain`.
* @returns A new output item object.
*/
static text(value: string, mime?: string): NotebookCellOutputItem;
/**
* Factory function to create a `NotebookCellOutputItem` from
* a JSON object.
*
* *Note* that this function is not expecting "stringified JSON" but
* an object that can be stringified. This function will throw an error
* when the passed value cannot be JSON-stringified.
*
* @param value A JSON-stringifyable value.
* @param mime Optional MIME type, defaults to `application/json`
* @returns A new output item object.
*/
static json(value: any, mime?: string): NotebookCellOutputItem;
/**
* Factory function to create a `NotebookCellOutputItem` that uses
* uses the `application/vnd.code.notebook.stdout` mime type.
*
* @param value A string.
* @returns A new output item object.
*/
static stdout(value: string): NotebookCellOutputItem;
/**
* Factory function to create a `NotebookCellOutputItem` that uses
* uses the `application/vnd.code.notebook.stderr` mime type.
*
* @param value A string.
* @returns A new output item object.
*/
static stderr(value: string): NotebookCellOutputItem;
/**
* Factory function to create a `NotebookCellOutputItem` that uses
* uses the `application/vnd.code.notebook.error` mime type.
*
* @param value An error object.
* @returns A new output item object.
*/
static error(value: Error): NotebookCellOutputItem;
/**
* The mime type which determines how the {@linkcode NotebookCellOutputItem.data data}-property
* is interpreted.
*
* Notebooks have built-in support for certain mime-types, extensions can add support for new
* types and override existing types.
*/
mime: string;
/**
* The data of this output item. Must always be an array of unsigned 8-bit integers.
*/
data: Uint8Array;
/**
* Create a new notebook cell output item.
*
* @param data The value of the output item.
* @param mime The mime type of the output item.
*/
constructor(data: Uint8Array, mime: string);
}
/**
* Notebook cell output represents a result of executing a cell. It is a container type for multiple
* {@link NotebookCellOutputItem output items} where contained items represent the same result but
* use different MIME types.
*/
export class NotebookCellOutput {
/**
* The output items of this output. Each item must represent the same result. _Note_ that repeated
* MIME types per output is invalid and that the editor will just pick one of them.
*
* ```ts
* new vscode.NotebookCellOutput([
* vscode.NotebookCellOutputItem.text('Hello', 'text/plain'),
* vscode.NotebookCellOutputItem.text('<i>Hello</i>', 'text/html'),
* vscode.NotebookCellOutputItem.text('_Hello_', 'text/markdown'),
* vscode.NotebookCellOutputItem.text('Hey', 'text/plain'), // INVALID: repeated type, editor will pick just one
* ])
* ```
*/
items: NotebookCellOutputItem[];
/**
* Arbitrary metadata for this cell output. Can be anything but must be JSON-stringifyable.
*/
metadata?: { [key: string]: any };
/**
* Create new notebook output.
*
* @param items Notebook output items.
* @param metadata Optional metadata.
*/
constructor(items: NotebookCellOutputItem[], metadata?: { [key: string]: any });
}
/**
* NotebookCellData is the raw representation of notebook cells. Its is part of {@linkcode NotebookData}.
*/
export class NotebookCellData {
/**
* The {@link NotebookCellKind kind} of this cell data.
*/
kind: NotebookCellKind;
/**
* The source value of this cell data - either source code or formatted text.
*/
value: string;
/**
* The language identifier of the source value of this cell data. Any value from
* {@linkcode languages.getLanguages getLanguages} is possible.
*/
languageId: string;
/**
* The outputs of this cell data.
*/
outputs?: NotebookCellOutput[];
/**
* Arbitrary metadata of this cell data. Can be anything but must be JSON-stringifyable.
*/
metadata?: { [key: string]: any };
/**
* The execution summary of this cell data.
*/
executionSummary?: NotebookCellExecutionSummary;
/**
* Create new cell data. Minimal cell data specifies its kind, its source value, and the
* language identifier of its source.
*
* @param kind The kind.
* @param value The source value.
* @param languageId The language identifier of the source value.
*/
constructor(kind: NotebookCellKind, value: string, languageId: string);
}
/**
* Raw representation of a notebook.
*
* Extensions are responsible for creating {@linkcode NotebookData} so that the editor
* can create a {@linkcode NotebookDocument}.
*
* @see {@link NotebookSerializer}
*/
export class NotebookData {
/**
* The cell data of this notebook data.
*/
cells: NotebookCellData[];
/**
* Arbitrary metadata of notebook data.
*/
metadata?: { [key: string]: any };
/**
* Create new notebook data.
*
* @param cells An array of cell data.
*/
constructor(cells: NotebookCellData[]);
}
/**
* The notebook serializer enables the editor to open notebook files.
*
* At its core the editor only knows a {@link NotebookData notebook data structure} but not
* how that data structure is written to a file, nor how it is read from a file. The
* notebook serializer bridges this gap by deserializing bytes into notebook data and
* vice versa.
*/
export interface NotebookSerializer {
/**
* Deserialize contents of a notebook file into the notebook data structure.
*
* @param content Contents of a notebook file.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return Notebook data or a thenable that resolves to such.
*/
deserializeNotebook(content: Uint8Array, token: CancellationToken): NotebookData | Thenable<NotebookData>;
/**
* Serialize notebook data into file contents.
*
* @param data A notebook data structure.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @returns An array of bytes or a thenable that resolves to such.
*/
serializeNotebook(data: NotebookData, token: CancellationToken): Uint8Array | Thenable<Uint8Array>;
}
/**
* Notebook content options define what parts of a notebook are persisted. Note
*
* For instance, a notebook serializer can opt-out of saving outputs and in that case the editor doesn't mark a
* notebooks as {@link NotebookDocument.isDirty dirty} when its output has changed.
*/
export interface NotebookDocumentContentOptions {
/**
* Controls if outputs change will trigger notebook document content change and if it will be used in the diff editor
* Default to false. If the content provider doesn't persisit the outputs in the file document, this should be set to true.
*/
transientOutputs?: boolean;
/**
* Controls if a cell metadata property change will trigger notebook document content change and if it will be used in the diff editor
* Default to false. If the content provider doesn't persisit a metadata property in the file document, it should be set to true.
*/
transientCellMetadata?: { [key: string]: boolean | undefined };
/**
* Controls if a document metadata property change will trigger notebook document content change and if it will be used in the diff editor
* Default to false. If the content provider doesn't persisit a metadata property in the file document, it should be set to true.
*/
transientDocumentMetadata?: { [key: string]: boolean | undefined };
}
/**
* Notebook controller affinity for notebook documents.
*
* @see {@link NotebookController.updateNotebookAffinity}
*/
export enum NotebookControllerAffinity {
/**
* Default affinity.
*/
Default = 1,
/**
* A controller is preferred for a notebook.
*/
Preferred = 2
}
/**
* A notebook controller represents an entity that can execute notebook cells. This is often referred to as a kernel.
*
* There can be multiple controllers and the editor will let users choose which controller to use for a certain notebook. The
* {@linkcode NotebookController.notebookType notebookType}-property defines for what kind of notebooks a controller is for and
* the {@linkcode NotebookController.updateNotebookAffinity updateNotebookAffinity}-function allows controllers to set a preference
* for specific notebook documents. When a controller has been selected its
* {@link NotebookController.onDidChangeSelectedNotebooks onDidChangeSelectedNotebooks}-event fires.
*
* When a cell is being run the editor will invoke the {@linkcode NotebookController.executeHandler executeHandler} and a controller
* is expected to create and finalize a {@link NotebookCellExecution notebook cell execution}. However, controllers are also free
* to create executions by themselves.
*/
export interface NotebookController {
/**
* The identifier of this notebook controller.
*
* _Note_ that controllers are remembered by their identifier and that extensions should use
* stable identifiers across sessions.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The notebook type this controller is for.
*/
readonly notebookType: string;
/**
* An array of language identifiers that are supported by this
* controller. Any language identifier from {@linkcode languages.getLanguages getLanguages}
* is possible. When falsy all languages are supported.
*
* Samples:
* ```js
* // support JavaScript and TypeScript
* myController.supportedLanguages = ['javascript', 'typescript']
*
* // support all languages
* myController.supportedLanguages = undefined; // falsy
* myController.supportedLanguages = []; // falsy
* ```
*/
supportedLanguages?: string[];
/**
* The human-readable label of this notebook controller.
*/
label: string;
/**
* The human-readable description which is rendered less prominent.
*/
description?: string;
/**
* The human-readable detail which is rendered less prominent.
*/
detail?: string;
/**
* Whether this controller supports execution order so that the
* editor can render placeholders for them.
*/
supportsExecutionOrder?: boolean;
/**
* Create a cell execution task.
*
* _Note_ that there can only be one execution per cell at a time and that an error is thrown if
* a cell execution is created while another is still active.
*
* This should be used in response to the {@link NotebookController.executeHandler execution handler}
* being called or when cell execution has been started else, e.g when a cell was already
* executing or when cell execution was triggered from another source.
*
* @param cell The notebook cell for which to create the execution.
* @returns A notebook cell execution.
*/
createNotebookCellExecution(cell: NotebookCell): NotebookCellExecution;
/**
* The execute handler is invoked when the run gestures in the UI are selected, e.g Run Cell, Run All,
* Run Selection etc. The execute handler is responsible for creating and managing {@link NotebookCellExecution execution}-objects.
*/
executeHandler: (cells: NotebookCell[], notebook: NotebookDocument, controller: NotebookController) => void | Thenable<void>;
/**
* Optional interrupt handler.
*
* By default cell execution is canceled via {@link NotebookCellExecution.token tokens}. Cancellation
* tokens require that a controller can keep track of its execution so that it can cancel a specific execution at a later
* point. Not all scenarios allow for that, eg. REPL-style controllers often work by interrupting whatever is currently
* running. For those cases the interrupt handler exists - it can be thought of as the equivalent of `SIGINT`
* or `Control+C` in terminals.
*
* _Note_ that supporting {@link NotebookCellExecution.token cancellation tokens} is preferred and that interrupt handlers should
* only be used when tokens cannot be supported.
*/
interruptHandler?: (notebook: NotebookDocument) => void | Thenable<void>;
/**
* An event that fires whenever a controller has been selected or un-selected for a notebook document.
*
* There can be multiple controllers for a notebook and in that case a controllers needs to be _selected_. This is a user gesture
* and happens either explicitly or implicitly when interacting with a notebook for which a controller was _suggested_. When possible,
* the editor _suggests_ a controller that is most likely to be _selected_.
*
* _Note_ that controller selection is persisted (by the controllers {@link NotebookController.id id}) and restored as soon as a
* controller is re-created or as a notebook is {@link workspace.onDidOpenNotebookDocument opened}.
*/
readonly onDidChangeSelectedNotebooks: Event<{ notebook: NotebookDocument, selected: boolean }>;
/**
* A controller can set affinities for specific notebook documents. This allows a controller
* to be presented more prominent for some notebooks.
*
* @param notebook The notebook for which a priority is set.
* @param affinity A controller affinity
*/
updateNotebookAffinity(notebook: NotebookDocument, affinity: NotebookControllerAffinity): void;
/**
* Dispose and free associated resources.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* A NotebookCellExecution is how {@link NotebookController notebook controller} modify a notebook cell as
* it is executing.
*
* When a cell execution object is created, the cell enters the {@linkcode NotebookCellExecutionState.Pending Pending} state.
* When {@linkcode NotebookCellExecution.start start(...)} is called on the execution task, it enters the {@linkcode NotebookCellExecutionState.Executing Executing} state. When
* {@linkcode NotebookCellExecution.end end(...)} is called, it enters the {@linkcode NotebookCellExecutionState.Idle Idle} state.
*/
export interface NotebookCellExecution {
/**
* The {@link NotebookCell cell} for which this execution has been created.
*/
readonly cell: NotebookCell;
/**
* A cancellation token which will be triggered when the cell execution is canceled
* from the UI.
*
* _Note_ that the cancellation token will not be triggered when the {@link NotebookController controller}
* that created this execution uses an {@link NotebookController.interruptHandler interrupt-handler}.
*/
readonly token: CancellationToken;
/**
* Set and unset the order of this cell execution.
*/
executionOrder: number | undefined;
/**
* Signal that the execution has begun.
*
* @param startTime The time that execution began, in milliseconds in the Unix epoch. Used to drive the clock
* that shows for how long a cell has been running. If not given, the clock won't be shown.
*/
start(startTime?: number): void;
/**
* Signal that execution has ended.
*
* @param success If true, a green check is shown on the cell status bar.
* If false, a red X is shown.
* If undefined, no check or X icon is shown.
* @param endTime The time that execution finished, in milliseconds in the Unix epoch.
*/
end(success: boolean | undefined, endTime?: number): void;
/**
* Clears the output of the cell that is executing or of another cell that is affected by this execution.
*
* @param cell Cell for which output is cleared. Defaults to the {@link NotebookCellExecution.cell cell} of
* this execution.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the operation finished.
*/
clearOutput(cell?: NotebookCell): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Replace the output of the cell that is executing or of another cell that is affected by this execution.
*
* @param out Output that replaces the current output.
* @param cell Cell for which output is cleared. Defaults to the {@link NotebookCellExecution.cell cell} of
* this execution.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the operation finished.
*/
replaceOutput(out: NotebookCellOutput | NotebookCellOutput[], cell?: NotebookCell): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Append to the output of the cell that is executing or to another cell that is affected by this execution.
*
* @param out Output that is appended to the current output.
* @param cell Cell for which output is cleared. Defaults to the {@link NotebookCellExecution.cell cell} of
* this execution.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the operation finished.
*/
appendOutput(out: NotebookCellOutput | NotebookCellOutput[], cell?: NotebookCell): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Replace all output items of existing cell output.
*
* @param items Output items that replace the items of existing output.
* @param output Output object that already exists.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the operation finished.
*/
replaceOutputItems(items: NotebookCellOutputItem | NotebookCellOutputItem[], output: NotebookCellOutput): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Append output items to existing cell output.
*
* @param items Output items that are append to existing output.
* @param output Output object that already exists.
* @return A thenable that resolves when the operation finished.
*/
appendOutputItems(items: NotebookCellOutputItem | NotebookCellOutputItem[], output: NotebookCellOutput): Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* Represents the alignment of status bar items.
*/
export enum NotebookCellStatusBarAlignment {
/**
* Aligned to the left side.
*/
Left = 1,
/**
* Aligned to the right side.
*/
Right = 2
}
/**
* A contribution to a cell's status bar
*/
export class NotebookCellStatusBarItem {
/**
* The text to show for the item.
*/
text: string;
/**
* Whether the item is aligned to the left or right.
*/
alignment: NotebookCellStatusBarAlignment;
/**
* An optional {@linkcode Command} or identifier of a command to run on click.
*
* The command must be {@link commands.getCommands known}.
*
* Note that if this is a {@linkcode Command} object, only the {@linkcode Command.command command} and {@linkcode Command.arguments arguments}
* are used by the editor.
*/
command?: string | Command;
/**
* A tooltip to show when the item is hovered.
*/
tooltip?: string;
/**
* The priority of the item. A higher value item will be shown more to the left.
*/
priority?: number;
/**
* Accessibility information used when a screen reader interacts with this item.
*/
accessibilityInformation?: AccessibilityInformation;
/**
* Creates a new NotebookCellStatusBarItem.
* @param text The text to show for the item.
* @param alignment Whether the item is aligned to the left or right.
*/
constructor(text: string, alignment: NotebookCellStatusBarAlignment);
}
/**
* A provider that can contribute items to the status bar that appears below a cell's editor.
*/
export interface NotebookCellStatusBarItemProvider {
/**
* An optional event to signal that statusbar items have changed. The provide method will be called again.
*/
onDidChangeCellStatusBarItems?: Event<void>;
/**
* The provider will be called when the cell scrolls into view, when its content, outputs, language, or metadata change, and when it changes execution state.
* @param cell The cell for which to return items.
* @param token A token triggered if this request should be cancelled.
* @return One or more {@link NotebookCellStatusBarItem cell statusbar items}
*/
provideCellStatusBarItems(cell: NotebookCell, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<NotebookCellStatusBarItem | NotebookCellStatusBarItem[]>;
}
/**
* Namespace for notebooks.
*
* The notebooks functionality is composed of three loosely coupled components:
*
* 1. {@link NotebookSerializer} enable the editor to open, show, and save notebooks
* 2. {@link NotebookController} own the execution of notebooks, e.g they create output from code cells.
* 3. NotebookRenderer present notebook output in the editor. They run in a separate context.
*/
export namespace notebooks {
/**
* Creates a new notebook controller.
*
* @param id Identifier of the controller. Must be unique per extension.
* @param notebookType A notebook type for which this controller is for.
* @param label The label of the controller.
* @param handler The execute-handler of the controller.
*/
export function createNotebookController(id: string, notebookType: string, label: string, handler?: (cells: NotebookCell[], notebook: NotebookDocument, controller: NotebookController) => void | Thenable<void>): NotebookController;
/**
* Register a {@link NotebookCellStatusBarItemProvider cell statusbar item provider} for the given notebook type.
*
* @param notebookType The notebook type to register for.
* @param provider A cell status bar provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerNotebookCellStatusBarItemProvider(notebookType: string, provider: NotebookCellStatusBarItemProvider): Disposable;
/**
* Creates a new messaging instance used to communicate with a specific renderer.
*
* * *Note 1:* Extensions can only create renderer that they have defined in their `package.json`-file
* * *Note 2:* A renderer only has access to messaging if `requiresMessaging` is set to `always` or `optional` in
* its `notebookRenderer` contribution.
*
* @param rendererId The renderer ID to communicate with
* @returns A new notebook renderer messaging object.
*/
export function createRendererMessaging(rendererId: string): NotebookRendererMessaging;
}
/**
* Represents the input box in the Source Control viewlet.
*/
export interface SourceControlInputBox {
/**
* Setter and getter for the contents of the input box.
*/
value: string;
/**
* A string to show as placeholder in the input box to guide the user.
*/
placeholder: string;
/**
* Controls whether the input box is visible (default is `true`).
*/
visible: boolean;
}
interface QuickDiffProvider {
/**
* Provide a {@link Uri} to the original resource of any given resource uri.
*
* @param uri The uri of the resource open in a text editor.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return A thenable that resolves to uri of the matching original resource.
*/
provideOriginalResource?(uri: Uri, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Uri>;
}
/**
* The theme-aware decorations for a
* {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource state}.
*/
export interface SourceControlResourceThemableDecorations {
/**
* The icon path for a specific
* {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource state}.
*/
readonly iconPath?: string | Uri | ThemeIcon;
}
/**
* The decorations for a {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource state}.
* Can be independently specified for light and dark themes.
*/
export interface SourceControlResourceDecorations extends SourceControlResourceThemableDecorations {
/**
* Whether the {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource state} should
* be striked-through in the UI.
*/
readonly strikeThrough?: boolean;
/**
* Whether the {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource state} should
* be faded in the UI.
*/
readonly faded?: boolean;
/**
* The title for a specific
* {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource state}.
*/
readonly tooltip?: string;
/**
* The light theme decorations.
*/
readonly light?: SourceControlResourceThemableDecorations;
/**
* The dark theme decorations.
*/
readonly dark?: SourceControlResourceThemableDecorations;
}
/**
* An source control resource state represents the state of an underlying workspace
* resource within a certain {@link SourceControlResourceGroup source control group}.
*/
export interface SourceControlResourceState {
/**
* The {@link Uri} of the underlying resource inside the workspace.
*/
readonly resourceUri: Uri;
/**
* The {@link Command} which should be run when the resource
* state is open in the Source Control viewlet.
*/
readonly command?: Command;
/**
* The {@link SourceControlResourceDecorations decorations} for this source control
* resource state.
*/
readonly decorations?: SourceControlResourceDecorations;
/**
* Context value of the resource state. This can be used to contribute resource specific actions.
* For example, if a resource is given a context value as `diffable`. When contributing actions to `scm/resourceState/context`
* using `menus` extension point, you can specify context value for key `scmResourceState` in `when` expressions, like `scmResourceState == diffable`.
* ```json
* "contributes": {
* "menus": {
* "scm/resourceState/context": [
* {
* "command": "extension.diff",
* "when": "scmResourceState == diffable"
* }
* ]
* }
* }
* ```
* This will show action `extension.diff` only for resources with `contextValue` is `diffable`.
*/
readonly contextValue?: string;
}
/**
* A source control resource group is a collection of
* {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource states}.
*/
export interface SourceControlResourceGroup {
/**
* The id of this source control resource group.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The label of this source control resource group.
*/
label: string;
/**
* Whether this source control resource group is hidden when it contains
* no {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource states}.
*/
hideWhenEmpty?: boolean;
/**
* This group's collection of
* {@link SourceControlResourceState source control resource states}.
*/
resourceStates: SourceControlResourceState[];
/**
* Dispose this source control resource group.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* An source control is able to provide {@link SourceControlResourceState resource states}
* to the editor and interact with the editor in several source control related ways.
*/
export interface SourceControl {
/**
* The id of this source control.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The human-readable label of this source control.
*/
readonly label: string;
/**
* The (optional) Uri of the root of this source control.
*/
readonly rootUri: Uri | undefined;
/**
* The {@link SourceControlInputBox input box} for this source control.
*/
readonly inputBox: SourceControlInputBox;
/**
* The UI-visible count of {@link SourceControlResourceState resource states} of
* this source control.
*
* If undefined, this source control will
* - display its UI-visible count as zero, and
* - contribute the count of its {@link SourceControlResourceState resource states} to the UI-visible aggregated count for all source controls
*/
count?: number;
/**
* An optional {@link QuickDiffProvider quick diff provider}.
*/
quickDiffProvider?: QuickDiffProvider;
/**
* Optional commit template string.
*
* The Source Control viewlet will populate the Source Control
* input with this value when appropriate.
*/
commitTemplate?: string;
/**
* Optional accept input command.
*
* This command will be invoked when the user accepts the value
* in the Source Control input.
*/
acceptInputCommand?: Command;
/**
* Optional status bar commands.
*
* These commands will be displayed in the editor's status bar.
*/
statusBarCommands?: Command[];
/**
* Create a new {@link SourceControlResourceGroup resource group}.
*/
createResourceGroup(id: string, label: string): SourceControlResourceGroup;
/**
* Dispose this source control.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
export namespace scm {
/**
* The {@link SourceControlInputBox input box} for the last source control
* created by the extension.
*
* @deprecated Use SourceControl.inputBox instead
*/
export const inputBox: SourceControlInputBox;
/**
* Creates a new {@link SourceControl source control} instance.
*
* @param id An `id` for the source control. Something short, e.g.: `git`.
* @param label A human-readable string for the source control. E.g.: `Git`.
* @param rootUri An optional Uri of the root of the source control. E.g.: `Uri.parse(workspaceRoot)`.
* @return An instance of {@link SourceControl source control}.
*/
export function createSourceControl(id: string, label: string, rootUri?: Uri): SourceControl;
}
/**
* A DebugProtocolMessage is an opaque stand-in type for the [ProtocolMessage](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Base_Protocol_ProtocolMessage) type defined in the Debug Adapter Protocol.
*/
export interface DebugProtocolMessage {
// Properties: see details [here](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Base_Protocol_ProtocolMessage).
}
/**
* A DebugProtocolSource is an opaque stand-in type for the [Source](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Types_Source) type defined in the Debug Adapter Protocol.
*/
export interface DebugProtocolSource {
// Properties: see details [here](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Types_Source).
}
/**
* A DebugProtocolBreakpoint is an opaque stand-in type for the [Breakpoint](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Types_Breakpoint) type defined in the Debug Adapter Protocol.
*/
export interface DebugProtocolBreakpoint {
// Properties: see details [here](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Types_Breakpoint).
}
/**
* Configuration for a debug session.
*/
export interface DebugConfiguration {
/**
* The type of the debug session.
*/
type: string;
/**
* The name of the debug session.
*/
name: string;
/**
* The request type of the debug session.
*/
request: string;
/**
* Additional debug type specific properties.
*/
[key: string]: any;
}
/**
* A debug session.
*/
export interface DebugSession {
/**
* The unique ID of this debug session.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The debug session's type from the {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration}.
*/
readonly type: string;
/**
* The parent session of this debug session, if it was created as a child.
* @see DebugSessionOptions.parentSession
*/
readonly parentSession?: DebugSession;
/**
* The debug session's name is initially taken from the {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration}.
* Any changes will be properly reflected in the UI.
*/
name: string;
/**
* The workspace folder of this session or `undefined` for a folderless setup.
*/
readonly workspaceFolder: WorkspaceFolder | undefined;
/**
* The "resolved" {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration} of this session.
* "Resolved" means that
* - all variables have been substituted and
* - platform specific attribute sections have been "flattened" for the matching platform and removed for non-matching platforms.
*/
readonly configuration: DebugConfiguration;
/**
* Send a custom request to the debug adapter.
*/
customRequest(command: string, args?: any): Thenable<any>;
/**
* Maps a breakpoint in the editor to the corresponding Debug Adapter Protocol (DAP) breakpoint that is managed by the debug adapter of the debug session.
* If no DAP breakpoint exists (either because the editor breakpoint was not yet registered or because the debug adapter is not interested in the breakpoint), the value `undefined` is returned.
*
* @param breakpoint A {@link Breakpoint} in the editor.
* @return A promise that resolves to the Debug Adapter Protocol breakpoint or `undefined`.
*/
getDebugProtocolBreakpoint(breakpoint: Breakpoint): Thenable<DebugProtocolBreakpoint | undefined>;
}
/**
* A custom Debug Adapter Protocol event received from a {@link DebugSession debug session}.
*/
export interface DebugSessionCustomEvent {
/**
* The {@link DebugSession debug session} for which the custom event was received.
*/
readonly session: DebugSession;
/**
* Type of event.
*/
readonly event: string;
/**
* Event specific information.
*/
readonly body: any;
}
/**
* A debug configuration provider allows to add debug configurations to the debug service
* and to resolve launch configurations before they are used to start a debug session.
* A debug configuration provider is registered via {@link debug.registerDebugConfigurationProvider}.
*/
export interface DebugConfigurationProvider {
/**
* Provides {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration} to the debug service. If more than one debug configuration provider is
* registered for the same type, debug configurations are concatenated in arbitrary order.
*
* @param folder The workspace folder for which the configurations are used or `undefined` for a folderless setup.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return An array of {@link DebugConfiguration debug configurations}.
*/
provideDebugConfigurations?(folder: WorkspaceFolder | undefined, token?: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<DebugConfiguration[]>;
/**
* Resolves a {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration} by filling in missing values or by adding/changing/removing attributes.
* If more than one debug configuration provider is registered for the same type, the resolveDebugConfiguration calls are chained
* in arbitrary order and the initial debug configuration is piped through the chain.
* Returning the value 'undefined' prevents the debug session from starting.
* Returning the value 'null' prevents the debug session from starting and opens the underlying debug configuration instead.
*
* @param folder The workspace folder from which the configuration originates from or `undefined` for a folderless setup.
* @param debugConfiguration The {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration} to resolve.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved debug configuration or undefined or null.
*/
resolveDebugConfiguration?(folder: WorkspaceFolder | undefined, debugConfiguration: DebugConfiguration, token?: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<DebugConfiguration>;
/**
* This hook is directly called after 'resolveDebugConfiguration' but with all variables substituted.
* It can be used to resolve or verify a {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration} by filling in missing values or by adding/changing/removing attributes.
* If more than one debug configuration provider is registered for the same type, the 'resolveDebugConfigurationWithSubstitutedVariables' calls are chained
* in arbitrary order and the initial debug configuration is piped through the chain.
* Returning the value 'undefined' prevents the debug session from starting.
* Returning the value 'null' prevents the debug session from starting and opens the underlying debug configuration instead.
*
* @param folder The workspace folder from which the configuration originates from or `undefined` for a folderless setup.
* @param debugConfiguration The {@link DebugConfiguration debug configuration} to resolve.
* @param token A cancellation token.
* @return The resolved debug configuration or undefined or null.
*/
resolveDebugConfigurationWithSubstitutedVariables?(folder: WorkspaceFolder | undefined, debugConfiguration: DebugConfiguration, token?: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<DebugConfiguration>;
}
/**
* Represents a debug adapter executable and optional arguments and runtime options passed to it.
*/
export class DebugAdapterExecutable {
/**
* Creates a description for a debug adapter based on an executable program.
*
* @param command The command or executable path that implements the debug adapter.
* @param args Optional arguments to be passed to the command or executable.
* @param options Optional options to be used when starting the command or executable.
*/
constructor(command: string, args?: string[], options?: DebugAdapterExecutableOptions);
/**
* The command or path of the debug adapter executable.
* A command must be either an absolute path of an executable or the name of an command to be looked up via the PATH environment variable.
* The special value 'node' will be mapped to the editor's built-in Node.js runtime.
*/
readonly command: string;
/**
* The arguments passed to the debug adapter executable. Defaults to an empty array.
*/
readonly args: string[];
/**
* Optional options to be used when the debug adapter is started.
* Defaults to undefined.
*/
readonly options?: DebugAdapterExecutableOptions;
}
/**
* Options for a debug adapter executable.
*/
export interface DebugAdapterExecutableOptions {
/**
* The additional environment of the executed program or shell. If omitted
* the parent process' environment is used. If provided it is merged with
* the parent process' environment.
*/
env?: { [key: string]: string };
/**
* The current working directory for the executed debug adapter.
*/
cwd?: string;
}
/**
* Represents a debug adapter running as a socket based server.
*/
export class DebugAdapterServer {
/**
* The port.
*/
readonly port: number;
/**
* The host.
*/
readonly host?: string;
/**
* Create a description for a debug adapter running as a socket based server.
*/
constructor(port: number, host?: string);
}
/**
* Represents a debug adapter running as a Named Pipe (on Windows)/UNIX Domain Socket (on non-Windows) based server.
*/
export class DebugAdapterNamedPipeServer {
/**
* The path to the NamedPipe/UNIX Domain Socket.
*/
readonly path: string;
/**
* Create a description for a debug adapter running as a Named Pipe (on Windows)/UNIX Domain Socket (on non-Windows) based server.
*/
constructor(path: string);
}
/**
* A debug adapter that implements the Debug Adapter Protocol can be registered with the editor if it implements the DebugAdapter interface.
*/
export interface DebugAdapter extends Disposable {
/**
* An event which fires after the debug adapter has sent a Debug Adapter Protocol message to the editor.
* Messages can be requests, responses, or events.
*/
readonly onDidSendMessage: Event<DebugProtocolMessage>;
/**
* Handle a Debug Adapter Protocol message.
* Messages can be requests, responses, or events.
* Results or errors are returned via onSendMessage events.
* @param message A Debug Adapter Protocol message
*/
handleMessage(message: DebugProtocolMessage): void;
}
/**
* A debug adapter descriptor for an inline implementation.
*/
export class DebugAdapterInlineImplementation {
/**
* Create a descriptor for an inline implementation of a debug adapter.
*/
constructor(implementation: DebugAdapter);
}
export type DebugAdapterDescriptor = DebugAdapterExecutable | DebugAdapterServer | DebugAdapterNamedPipeServer | DebugAdapterInlineImplementation;
export interface DebugAdapterDescriptorFactory {
/**
* 'createDebugAdapterDescriptor' is called at the start of a debug session to provide details about the debug adapter to use.
* These details must be returned as objects of type {@link DebugAdapterDescriptor}.
* Currently two types of debug adapters are supported:
* - a debug adapter executable is specified as a command path and arguments (see {@link DebugAdapterExecutable}),
* - a debug adapter server reachable via a communication port (see {@link DebugAdapterServer}).
* If the method is not implemented the default behavior is this:
* createDebugAdapter(session: DebugSession, executable: DebugAdapterExecutable) {
* if (typeof session.configuration.debugServer === 'number') {
* return new DebugAdapterServer(session.configuration.debugServer);
* }
* return executable;
* }
* @param session The {@link DebugSession debug session} for which the debug adapter will be used.
* @param executable The debug adapter's executable information as specified in the package.json (or undefined if no such information exists).
* @return a {@link DebugAdapterDescriptor debug adapter descriptor} or undefined.
*/
createDebugAdapterDescriptor(session: DebugSession, executable: DebugAdapterExecutable | undefined): ProviderResult<DebugAdapterDescriptor>;
}
/**
* A Debug Adapter Tracker is a means to track the communication between the editor and a Debug Adapter.
*/
export interface DebugAdapterTracker {
/**
* A session with the debug adapter is about to be started.
*/
onWillStartSession?(): void;
/**
* The debug adapter is about to receive a Debug Adapter Protocol message from the editor.
*/
onWillReceiveMessage?(message: any): void;
/**
* The debug adapter has sent a Debug Adapter Protocol message to the editor.
*/
onDidSendMessage?(message: any): void;
/**
* The debug adapter session is about to be stopped.
*/
onWillStopSession?(): void;
/**
* An error with the debug adapter has occurred.
*/
onError?(error: Error): void;
/**
* The debug adapter has exited with the given exit code or signal.
*/
onExit?(code: number | undefined, signal: string | undefined): void;
}
export interface DebugAdapterTrackerFactory {
/**
* The method 'createDebugAdapterTracker' is called at the start of a debug session in order
* to return a "tracker" object that provides read-access to the communication between the editor and a debug adapter.
*
* @param session The {@link DebugSession debug session} for which the debug adapter tracker will be used.
* @return A {@link DebugAdapterTracker debug adapter tracker} or undefined.
*/
createDebugAdapterTracker(session: DebugSession): ProviderResult<DebugAdapterTracker>;
}
/**
* Represents the debug console.
*/
export interface DebugConsole {
/**
* Append the given value to the debug console.
*
* @param value A string, falsy values will not be printed.
*/
append(value: string): void;
/**
* Append the given value and a line feed character
* to the debug console.
*
* @param value A string, falsy values will be printed.
*/
appendLine(value: string): void;
}
/**
* An event describing the changes to the set of {@link Breakpoint breakpoints}.
*/
export interface BreakpointsChangeEvent {
/**
* Added breakpoints.
*/
readonly added: readonly Breakpoint[];
/**
* Removed breakpoints.
*/
readonly removed: readonly Breakpoint[];
/**
* Changed breakpoints.
*/
readonly changed: readonly Breakpoint[];
}
/**
* The base class of all breakpoint types.
*/
export class Breakpoint {
/**
* The unique ID of the breakpoint.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* Is breakpoint enabled.
*/
readonly enabled: boolean;
/**
* An optional expression for conditional breakpoints.
*/
readonly condition?: string;
/**
* An optional expression that controls how many hits of the breakpoint are ignored.
*/
readonly hitCondition?: string;
/**
* An optional message that gets logged when this breakpoint is hit. Embedded expressions within {} are interpolated by the debug adapter.
*/
readonly logMessage?: string;
protected constructor(enabled?: boolean, condition?: string, hitCondition?: string, logMessage?: string);
}
/**
* A breakpoint specified by a source location.
*/
export class SourceBreakpoint extends Breakpoint {
/**
* The source and line position of this breakpoint.
*/
readonly location: Location;
/**
* Create a new breakpoint for a source location.
*/
constructor(location: Location, enabled?: boolean, condition?: string, hitCondition?: string, logMessage?: string);
}
/**
* A breakpoint specified by a function name.
*/
export class FunctionBreakpoint extends Breakpoint {
/**
* The name of the function to which this breakpoint is attached.
*/
readonly functionName: string;
/**
* Create a new function breakpoint.
*/
constructor(functionName: string, enabled?: boolean, condition?: string, hitCondition?: string, logMessage?: string);
}
/**
* Debug console mode used by debug session, see {@link DebugSessionOptions options}.
*/
export enum DebugConsoleMode {
/**
* Debug session should have a separate debug console.
*/
Separate = 0,
/**
* Debug session should share debug console with its parent session.
* This value has no effect for sessions which do not have a parent session.
*/
MergeWithParent = 1
}
/**
* Options for {@link debug.startDebugging starting a debug session}.
*/
export interface DebugSessionOptions {
/**
* When specified the newly created debug session is registered as a "child" session of this
* "parent" debug session.
*/
parentSession?: DebugSession;
/**
* Controls whether lifecycle requests like 'restart' are sent to the newly created session or its parent session.
* By default (if the property is false or missing), lifecycle requests are sent to the new session.
* This property is ignored if the session has no parent session.
*/
lifecycleManagedByParent?: boolean;
/**
* Controls whether this session should have a separate debug console or share it
* with the parent session. Has no effect for sessions which do not have a parent session.
* Defaults to Separate.
*/
consoleMode?: DebugConsoleMode;
/**
* Controls whether this session should run without debugging, thus ignoring breakpoints.
* When this property is not specified, the value from the parent session (if there is one) is used.
*/
noDebug?: boolean;
/**
* Controls if the debug session's parent session is shown in the CALL STACK view even if it has only a single child.
* By default, the debug session will never hide its parent.
* If compact is true, debug sessions with a single child are hidden in the CALL STACK view to make the tree more compact.
*/
compact?: boolean;
}
/**
* A DebugConfigurationProviderTriggerKind specifies when the `provideDebugConfigurations` method of a `DebugConfigurationProvider` is triggered.
* Currently there are two situations: to provide the initial debug configurations for a newly created launch.json or
* to provide dynamically generated debug configurations when the user asks for them through the UI (e.g. via the "Select and Start Debugging" command).
* A trigger kind is used when registering a `DebugConfigurationProvider` with {@link debug.registerDebugConfigurationProvider}.
*/
export enum DebugConfigurationProviderTriggerKind {
/**
* `DebugConfigurationProvider.provideDebugConfigurations` is called to provide the initial debug configurations for a newly created launch.json.
*/
Initial = 1,
/**
* `DebugConfigurationProvider.provideDebugConfigurations` is called to provide dynamically generated debug configurations when the user asks for them through the UI (e.g. via the "Select and Start Debugging" command).
*/
Dynamic = 2
}
/**
* Namespace for debug functionality.
*/
export namespace debug {
/**
* The currently active {@link DebugSession debug session} or `undefined`. The active debug session is the one
* represented by the debug action floating window or the one currently shown in the drop down menu of the debug action floating window.
* If no debug session is active, the value is `undefined`.
*/
export let activeDebugSession: DebugSession | undefined;
/**
* The currently active {@link DebugConsole debug console}.
* If no debug session is active, output sent to the debug console is not shown.
*/
export let activeDebugConsole: DebugConsole;
/**
* List of breakpoints.
*/
export let breakpoints: Breakpoint[];
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the {@link debug.activeDebugSession active debug session}
* has changed. *Note* that the event also fires when the active debug session changes
* to `undefined`.
*/
export const onDidChangeActiveDebugSession: Event<DebugSession | undefined>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when a new {@link DebugSession debug session} has been started.
*/
export const onDidStartDebugSession: Event<DebugSession>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when a custom DAP event is received from the {@link DebugSession debug session}.
*/
export const onDidReceiveDebugSessionCustomEvent: Event<DebugSessionCustomEvent>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when a {@link DebugSession debug session} has terminated.
*/
export const onDidTerminateDebugSession: Event<DebugSession>;
/**
* An {@link Event} that is emitted when the set of breakpoints is added, removed, or changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeBreakpoints: Event<BreakpointsChangeEvent>;
/**
* Register a {@link DebugConfigurationProvider debug configuration provider} for a specific debug type.
* The optional {@link DebugConfigurationProviderTriggerKind triggerKind} can be used to specify when the `provideDebugConfigurations` method of the provider is triggered.
* Currently two trigger kinds are possible: with the value `Initial` (or if no trigger kind argument is given) the `provideDebugConfigurations` method is used to provide the initial debug configurations to be copied into a newly created launch.json.
* With the trigger kind `Dynamic` the `provideDebugConfigurations` method is used to dynamically determine debug configurations to be presented to the user (in addition to the static configurations from the launch.json).
* Please note that the `triggerKind` argument only applies to the `provideDebugConfigurations` method: so the `resolveDebugConfiguration` methods are not affected at all.
* Registering a single provider with resolve methods for different trigger kinds, results in the same resolve methods called multiple times.
* More than one provider can be registered for the same type.
*
* @param type The debug type for which the provider is registered.
* @param provider The {@link DebugConfigurationProvider debug configuration provider} to register.
* @param triggerKind The {@link DebugConfigurationProviderTrigger trigger} for which the 'provideDebugConfiguration' method of the provider is registered. If `triggerKind` is missing, the value `DebugConfigurationProviderTriggerKind.Initial` is assumed.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDebugConfigurationProvider(debugType: string, provider: DebugConfigurationProvider, triggerKind?: DebugConfigurationProviderTriggerKind): Disposable;
/**
* Register a {@link DebugAdapterDescriptorFactory debug adapter descriptor factory} for a specific debug type.
* An extension is only allowed to register a DebugAdapterDescriptorFactory for the debug type(s) defined by the extension. Otherwise an error is thrown.
* Registering more than one DebugAdapterDescriptorFactory for a debug type results in an error.
*
* @param debugType The debug type for which the factory is registered.
* @param factory The {@link DebugAdapterDescriptorFactory debug adapter descriptor factory} to register.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this factory when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDebugAdapterDescriptorFactory(debugType: string, factory: DebugAdapterDescriptorFactory): Disposable;
/**
* Register a debug adapter tracker factory for the given debug type.
*
* @param debugType The debug type for which the factory is registered or '*' for matching all debug types.
* @param factory The {@link DebugAdapterTrackerFactory debug adapter tracker factory} to register.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this factory when being disposed.
*/
export function registerDebugAdapterTrackerFactory(debugType: string, factory: DebugAdapterTrackerFactory): Disposable;
/**
* Start debugging by using either a named launch or named compound configuration,
* or by directly passing a {@link DebugConfiguration}.
* The named configurations are looked up in '.vscode/launch.json' found in the given folder.
* Before debugging starts, all unsaved files are saved and the launch configurations are brought up-to-date.
* Folder specific variables used in the configuration (e.g. '${workspaceFolder}') are resolved against the given folder.
* @param folder The {@link WorkspaceFolder workspace folder} for looking up named configurations and resolving variables or `undefined` for a non-folder setup.
* @param nameOrConfiguration Either the name of a debug or compound configuration or a {@link DebugConfiguration} object.
* @param parentSessionOrOptions Debug session options. When passed a parent {@link DebugSession debug session}, assumes options with just this parent session.
* @return A thenable that resolves when debugging could be successfully started.
*/
export function startDebugging(folder: WorkspaceFolder | undefined, nameOrConfiguration: string | DebugConfiguration, parentSessionOrOptions?: DebugSession | DebugSessionOptions): Thenable<boolean>;
/**
* Stop the given debug session or stop all debug sessions if session is omitted.
* @param session The {@link DebugSession debug session} to stop; if omitted all sessions are stopped.
*/
export function stopDebugging(session?: DebugSession): Thenable<void>;
/**
* Add breakpoints.
* @param breakpoints The breakpoints to add.
*/
export function addBreakpoints(breakpoints: readonly Breakpoint[]): void;
/**
* Remove breakpoints.
* @param breakpoints The breakpoints to remove.
*/
export function removeBreakpoints(breakpoints: readonly Breakpoint[]): void;
/**
* Converts a "Source" descriptor object received via the Debug Adapter Protocol into a Uri that can be used to load its contents.
* If the source descriptor is based on a path, a file Uri is returned.
* If the source descriptor uses a reference number, a specific debug Uri (scheme 'debug') is constructed that requires a corresponding ContentProvider and a running debug session
*
* If the "Source" descriptor has insufficient information for creating the Uri, an error is thrown.
*
* @param source An object conforming to the [Source](https://microsoft.github.io/debug-adapter-protocol/specification#Types_Source) type defined in the Debug Adapter Protocol.
* @param session An optional debug session that will be used when the source descriptor uses a reference number to load the contents from an active debug session.
* @return A uri that can be used to load the contents of the source.
*/
export function asDebugSourceUri(source: DebugProtocolSource, session?: DebugSession): Uri;
}
/**
* Namespace for dealing with installed extensions. Extensions are represented
* by an {@link Extension}-interface which enables reflection on them.
*
* Extension writers can provide APIs to other extensions by returning their API public
* surface from the `activate`-call.
*
* ```javascript
* export function activate(context: vscode.ExtensionContext) {
* let api = {
* sum(a, b) {
* return a + b;
* },
* mul(a, b) {
* return a * b;
* }
* };
* // 'export' public api-surface
* return api;
* }
* ```
* When depending on the API of another extension add an `extensionDependencies`-entry
* to `package.json`, and use the {@link extensions.getExtension getExtension}-function
* and the {@link Extension.exports exports}-property, like below:
*
* ```javascript
* let mathExt = extensions.getExtension('genius.math');
* let importedApi = mathExt.exports;
*
* console.log(importedApi.mul(42, 1));
* ```
*/
export namespace extensions {
/**
* Get an extension by its full identifier in the form of: `publisher.name`.
*
* @param extensionId An extension identifier.
* @return An extension or `undefined`.
*/
export function getExtension<T = any>(extensionId: string): Extension<T> | undefined;
/**
* All extensions currently known to the system.
*/
export const all: readonly Extension<any>[];
/**
* An event which fires when `extensions.all` changes. This can happen when extensions are
* installed, uninstalled, enabled or disabled.
*/
export const onDidChange: Event<void>;
}
/**
* Collapsible state of a {@link CommentThread comment thread}
*/
export enum CommentThreadCollapsibleState {
/**
* Determines an item is collapsed
*/
Collapsed = 0,
/**
* Determines an item is expanded
*/
Expanded = 1
}
/**
* Comment mode of a {@link Comment}
*/
export enum CommentMode {
/**
* Displays the comment editor
*/
Editing = 0,
/**
* Displays the preview of the comment
*/
Preview = 1
}
/**
* A collection of {@link Comment comments} representing a conversation at a particular range in a document.
*/
export interface CommentThread {
/**
* The uri of the document the thread has been created on.
*/
readonly uri: Uri;
/**
* The range the comment thread is located within the document. The thread icon will be shown
* at the first line of the range.
*/
range: Range;
/**
* The ordered comments of the thread.
*/
comments: readonly Comment[];
/**
* Whether the thread should be collapsed or expanded when opening the document.
* Defaults to Collapsed.
*/
collapsibleState: CommentThreadCollapsibleState;
/**
* Whether the thread supports reply.
* Defaults to true.
*/
canReply: boolean;
/**
* Context value of the comment thread. This can be used to contribute thread specific actions.
* For example, a comment thread is given a context value as `editable`. When contributing actions to `comments/commentThread/title`
* using `menus` extension point, you can specify context value for key `commentThread` in `when` expression like `commentThread == editable`.
* ```json
* "contributes": {
* "menus": {
* "comments/commentThread/title": [
* {
* "command": "extension.deleteCommentThread",
* "when": "commentThread == editable"
* }
* ]
* }
* }
* ```
* This will show action `extension.deleteCommentThread` only for comment threads with `contextValue` is `editable`.
*/
contextValue?: string;
/**
* The optional human-readable label describing the {@link CommentThread Comment Thread}
*/
label?: string;
/**
* Dispose this comment thread.
*
* Once disposed, this comment thread will be removed from visible editors and Comment Panel when appropriate.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Author information of a {@link Comment}
*/
export interface CommentAuthorInformation {
/**
* The display name of the author of the comment
*/
name: string;
/**
* The optional icon path for the author
*/
iconPath?: Uri;
}
/**
* Reactions of a {@link Comment}
*/
export interface CommentReaction {
/**
* The human-readable label for the reaction
*/
readonly label: string;
/**
* Icon for the reaction shown in UI.
*/
readonly iconPath: string | Uri;
/**
* The number of users who have reacted to this reaction
*/
readonly count: number;
/**
* Whether the {@link CommentAuthorInformation author} of the comment has reacted to this reaction
*/
readonly authorHasReacted: boolean;
}
/**
* A comment is displayed within the editor or the Comments Panel, depending on how it is provided.
*/
export interface Comment {
/**
* The human-readable comment body
*/
body: string | MarkdownString;
/**
* {@link CommentMode Comment mode} of the comment
*/
mode: CommentMode;
/**
* The {@link CommentAuthorInformation author information} of the comment
*/
author: CommentAuthorInformation;
/**
* Context value of the comment. This can be used to contribute comment specific actions.
* For example, a comment is given a context value as `editable`. When contributing actions to `comments/comment/title`
* using `menus` extension point, you can specify context value for key `comment` in `when` expression like `comment == editable`.
* ```json
* "contributes": {
* "menus": {
* "comments/comment/title": [
* {
* "command": "extension.deleteComment",
* "when": "comment == editable"
* }
* ]
* }
* }
* ```
* This will show action `extension.deleteComment` only for comments with `contextValue` is `editable`.
*/
contextValue?: string;
/**
* Optional reactions of the {@link Comment}
*/
reactions?: CommentReaction[];
/**
* Optional label describing the {@link Comment}
* Label will be rendered next to authorName if exists.
*/
label?: string;
}
/**
* Command argument for actions registered in `comments/commentThread/context`.
*/
export interface CommentReply {
/**
* The active {@link CommentThread comment thread}
*/
thread: CommentThread;
/**
* The value in the comment editor
*/
text: string;
}
/**
* Commenting range provider for a {@link CommentController comment controller}.
*/
export interface CommentingRangeProvider {
/**
* Provide a list of ranges which allow new comment threads creation or null for a given document
*/
provideCommentingRanges(document: TextDocument, token: CancellationToken): ProviderResult<Range[]>;
}
/**
* Represents a {@link CommentController comment controller}'s {@link CommentController.options options}.
*/
export interface CommentOptions {
/**
* An optional string to show on the comment input box when it's collapsed.
*/
prompt?: string;
/**
* An optional string to show as placeholder in the comment input box when it's focused.
*/
placeHolder?: string;
}
/**
* A comment controller is able to provide {@link CommentThread comments} support to the editor and
* provide users various ways to interact with comments.
*/
export interface CommentController {
/**
* The id of this comment controller.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The human-readable label of this comment controller.
*/
readonly label: string;
/**
* Comment controller options
*/
options?: CommentOptions;
/**
* Optional commenting range provider. Provide a list {@link Range ranges} which support commenting to any given resource uri.
*
* If not provided, users can leave comments in any document opened in the editor.
*/
commentingRangeProvider?: CommentingRangeProvider;
/**
* Create a {@link CommentThread comment thread}. The comment thread will be displayed in visible text editors (if the resource matches)
* and Comments Panel once created.
*
* @param uri The uri of the document the thread has been created on.
* @param range The range the comment thread is located within the document.
* @param comments The ordered comments of the thread.
*/
createCommentThread(uri: Uri, range: Range, comments: readonly Comment[]): CommentThread;
/**
* Optional reaction handler for creating and deleting reactions on a {@link Comment}.
*/
reactionHandler?: (comment: Comment, reaction: CommentReaction) => Thenable<void>;
/**
* Dispose this comment controller.
*
* Once disposed, all {@link CommentThread comment threads} created by this comment controller will also be removed from the editor
* and Comments Panel.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
namespace comments {
/**
* Creates a new {@link CommentController comment controller} instance.
*
* @param id An `id` for the comment controller.
* @param label A human-readable string for the comment controller.
* @return An instance of {@link CommentController comment controller}.
*/
export function createCommentController(id: string, label: string): CommentController;
}
//#endregion
/**
* Represents a session of a currently logged in user.
*/
export interface AuthenticationSession {
/**
* The identifier of the authentication session.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The access token.
*/
readonly accessToken: string;
/**
* The account associated with the session.
*/
readonly account: AuthenticationSessionAccountInformation;
/**
* The permissions granted by the session's access token. Available scopes
* are defined by the {@link AuthenticationProvider}.
*/
readonly scopes: readonly string[];
}
/**
* The information of an account associated with an {@link AuthenticationSession}.
*/
export interface AuthenticationSessionAccountInformation {
/**
* The unique identifier of the account.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The human-readable name of the account.
*/
readonly label: string;
}
/**
* Options to be used when getting an {@link AuthenticationSession} from an {@link AuthenticationProvider}.
*/
export interface AuthenticationGetSessionOptions {
/**
* Whether login should be performed if there is no matching session.
*
* If true, a modal dialog will be shown asking the user to sign in. If false, a numbered badge will be shown
* on the accounts activity bar icon. An entry for the extension will be added under the menu to sign in. This
* allows quietly prompting the user to sign in.
*
* If there is a matching session but the extension has not been granted access to it, setting this to true
* will also result in an immediate modal dialog, and false will add a numbered badge to the accounts icon.
*
* Defaults to false.
*/
createIfNone?: boolean;
/**
* Whether the existing user session preference should be cleared.
*
* For authentication providers that support being signed into multiple accounts at once, the user will be
* prompted to select an account to use when {@link authentication.getSession getSession} is called. This preference
* is remembered until {@link authentication.getSession getSession} is called with this flag.
*
* Defaults to false.
*/
clearSessionPreference?: boolean;
}
/**
* Basic information about an {@link AuthenticationProvider}
*/
export interface AuthenticationProviderInformation {
/**
* The unique identifier of the authentication provider.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* The human-readable name of the authentication provider.
*/
readonly label: string;
}
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when an {@link AuthenticationSession} is added, removed, or changed.
*/
export interface AuthenticationSessionsChangeEvent {
/**
* The {@link AuthenticationProvider} that has had its sessions change.
*/
readonly provider: AuthenticationProviderInformation;
}
/**
* Options for creating an {@link AuthenticationProvider}.
*/
export interface AuthenticationProviderOptions {
/**
* Whether it is possible to be signed into multiple accounts at once with this provider.
* If not specified, will default to false.
*/
readonly supportsMultipleAccounts?: boolean;
}
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when an {@link AuthenticationSession} is added, removed, or changed.
*/
export interface AuthenticationProviderAuthenticationSessionsChangeEvent {
/**
* The {@link AuthenticationSession AuthenticationSessions} of the {@link AuthenticationProvider} that have been added.
*/
readonly added: readonly AuthenticationSession[] | undefined;
/**
* The {@link AuthenticationSession AuthenticationSessions} of the {@link AuthenticationProvider} that have been removed.
*/
readonly removed: readonly AuthenticationSession[] | undefined;
/**
* The {@link AuthenticationSession AuthenticationSessions} of the {@link AuthenticationProvider} that have been changed.
* A session changes when its data excluding the id are updated. An example of this is a session refresh that results in a new
* access token being set for the session.
*/
readonly changed: readonly AuthenticationSession[] | undefined;
}
/**
* A provider for performing authentication to a service.
*/
export interface AuthenticationProvider {
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the array of sessions has changed, or data
* within a session has changed.
*/
readonly onDidChangeSessions: Event<AuthenticationProviderAuthenticationSessionsChangeEvent>;
/**
* Get a list of sessions.
* @param scopes An optional list of scopes. If provided, the sessions returned should match
* these permissions, otherwise all sessions should be returned.
* @returns A promise that resolves to an array of authentication sessions.
*/
getSessions(scopes?: readonly string[]): Thenable<readonly AuthenticationSession[]>;
/**
* Prompts a user to login.
*
* If login is successful, the onDidChangeSessions event should be fired.
*
* If login fails, a rejected promise should be returned.
*
* If the provider has specified that it does not support multiple accounts,
* then this should never be called if there is already an existing session matching these
* scopes.
* @param scopes A list of scopes, permissions, that the new session should be created with.
* @returns A promise that resolves to an authentication session.
*/
createSession(scopes: readonly string[]): Thenable<AuthenticationSession>;
/**
* Removes the session corresponding to session id.
*
* If the removal is successful, the onDidChangeSessions event should be fired.
*
* If a session cannot be removed, the provider should reject with an error message.
* @param sessionId The id of the session to remove.
*/
removeSession(sessionId: string): Thenable<void>;
}
/**
* Namespace for authentication.
*/
export namespace authentication {
/**
* Get an authentication session matching the desired scopes. Rejects if a provider with providerId is not
* registered, or if the user does not consent to sharing authentication information with
* the extension. If there are multiple sessions with the same scopes, the user will be shown a
* quickpick to select which account they would like to use.
*
* Currently, there are only two authentication providers that are contributed from built in extensions
* to the editor that implement GitHub and Microsoft authentication: their providerId's are 'github' and 'microsoft'.
* @param providerId The id of the provider to use
* @param scopes A list of scopes representing the permissions requested. These are dependent on the authentication provider
* @param options The {@link AuthenticationGetSessionOptions} to use
* @returns A thenable that resolves to an authentication session
*/
export function getSession(providerId: string, scopes: readonly string[], options: AuthenticationGetSessionOptions & { createIfNone: true }): Thenable<AuthenticationSession>;
/**
* Get an authentication session matching the desired scopes. Rejects if a provider with providerId is not
* registered, or if the user does not consent to sharing authentication information with
* the extension. If there are multiple sessions with the same scopes, the user will be shown a
* quickpick to select which account they would like to use.
*
* Currently, there are only two authentication providers that are contributed from built in extensions
* to the editor that implement GitHub and Microsoft authentication: their providerId's are 'github' and 'microsoft'.
* @param providerId The id of the provider to use
* @param scopes A list of scopes representing the permissions requested. These are dependent on the authentication provider
* @param options The {@link AuthenticationGetSessionOptions} to use
* @returns A thenable that resolves to an authentication session if available, or undefined if there are no sessions
*/
export function getSession(providerId: string, scopes: readonly string[], options?: AuthenticationGetSessionOptions): Thenable<AuthenticationSession | undefined>;
/**
* An {@link Event} which fires when the authentication sessions of an authentication provider have
* been added, removed, or changed.
*/
export const onDidChangeSessions: Event<AuthenticationSessionsChangeEvent>;
/**
* Register an authentication provider.
*
* There can only be one provider per id and an error is being thrown when an id
* has already been used by another provider. Ids are case-sensitive.
*
* @param id The unique identifier of the provider.
* @param label The human-readable name of the provider.
* @param provider The authentication provider provider.
* @params options Additional options for the provider.
* @return A {@link Disposable} that unregisters this provider when being disposed.
*/
export function registerAuthenticationProvider(id: string, label: string, provider: AuthenticationProvider, options?: AuthenticationProviderOptions): Disposable;
}
/**
* Namespace for testing functionality. Tests are published by registering
* {@link TestController} instances, then adding {@link TestItem TestItems}.
* Controllers may also describe how to run tests by creating one or more
* {@link TestRunProfile} instances.
*/
export namespace tests {
/**
* Creates a new test controller.
*
* @param id Identifier for the controller, must be globally unique.
* @param label A human-readable label for the controller.
* @returns An instance of the {@link TestController}.
*/
export function createTestController(id: string, label: string): TestController;
}
/**
* The kind of executions that {@link TestRunProfile TestRunProfiles} control.
*/
export enum TestRunProfileKind {
Run = 1,
Debug = 2,
Coverage = 3,
}
/**
* Tags can be associated with {@link TestItem TestItems} and
* {@link TestRunProfile TestRunProfiles}. A profile with a tag can only
* execute tests that include that tag in their {@link TestItem.tags} array.
*/
export class TestTag {
/**
* ID of the test tag. `TestTag` instances with the same ID are considered
* to be identical.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* Creates a new TestTag instance.
* @param id ID of the test tag.
*/
constructor(id: string);
}
/**
* A TestRunProfile describes one way to execute tests in a {@link TestController}.
*/
export interface TestRunProfile {
/**
* Label shown to the user in the UI.
*
* Note that the label has some significance if the user requests that
* tests be re-run in a certain way. For example, if tests were run
* normally and the user requests to re-run them in debug mode, the editor
* will attempt use a configuration with the same label of the `Debug`
* kind. If there is no such configuration, the default will be used.
*/
label: string;
/**
* Configures what kind of execution this profile controls. If there
* are no profiles for a kind, it will not be available in the UI.
*/
readonly kind: TestRunProfileKind;
/**
* Controls whether this profile is the default action that will
* be taken when its kind is actioned. For example, if the user clicks
* the generic "run all" button, then the default profile for
* {@link TestRunProfileKind.Run} will be executed, although the
* user can configure this.
*/
isDefault: boolean;
/**
* Associated tag for the profile. If this is set, only {@link TestItem}
* instances with the same tag will be eligible to execute in this profile.
*/
tag: TestTag | undefined;
/**
* If this method is present, a configuration gear will be present in the
* UI, and this method will be invoked when it's clicked. When called,
* you can take other editor actions, such as showing a quick pick or
* opening a configuration file.
*/
configureHandler: (() => void) | undefined;
/**
* Handler called to start a test run. When invoked, the function should call
* {@link TestController.createTestRun} at least once, and all test runs
* associated with the request should be created before the function returns
* or the returned promise is resolved.
*
* @param request Request information for the test run.
* @param cancellationToken Token that signals the used asked to abort the
* test run. If cancellation is requested on this token, all {@link TestRun}
* instances associated with the request will be
* automatically cancelled as well.
*/
runHandler: (request: TestRunRequest, token: CancellationToken) => Thenable<void> | void;
/**
* Deletes the run profile.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* Entry point to discover and execute tests. It contains {@link TestController.items} which
* are used to populate the editor UI, and is associated with
* {@link TestController.createRunProfile run profiles} to allow
* for tests to be executed.
*/
export interface TestController {
/**
* The id of the controller passed in {@link vscode.tests.createTestController}.
* This must be globally unique.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* Human-readable label for the test controller.
*/
label: string;
/**
* A collection of "top-level" {@link TestItem} instances, which can in
* turn have their own {@link TestItem.children children} to form the
* "test tree."
*
* The extension controls when to add tests. For example, extensions should
* add tests for a file when {@link vscode.workspace.onDidOpenTextDocument}
* fires in order for decorations for tests within a file to be visible.
*
* However, the editor may sometimes explicitly request children using the
* {@link resolveHandler} See the documentation on that method for more details.
*/
readonly items: TestItemCollection;
/**
* Creates a profile used for running tests. Extensions must create
* at least one profile in order for tests to be run.
* @param label A human-readable label for this profile.
* @param kind Configures what kind of execution this profile manages.
* @param runHandler Function called to start a test run.
* @param isDefault Whether this is the default action for its kind.
* @param tag Profile test tag.
* @returns An instance of a {@link TestRunProfile}, which is automatically
* associated with this controller.
*/
createRunProfile(label: string, kind: TestRunProfileKind, runHandler: (request: TestRunRequest, token: CancellationToken) => Thenable<void> | void, isDefault?: boolean, tag?: TestTag): TestRunProfile;
/**
* A function provided by the extension that the editor may call to request
* children of a test item, if the {@link TestItem.canResolveChildren} is
* `true`. When called, the item should discover children and call
* {@link vscode.tests.createTestItem} as children are discovered.
*
* Generally the extension manages the lifecycle of test items, but under
* certain conditions the editor may request the children of a specific
* item to be loaded. For example, if the user requests to re-run tests
* after reloading the editor, the editor may need to call this method
* to resolve the previously-run tests.
*
* The item in the explorer will automatically be marked as "busy" until
* the function returns or the returned thenable resolves.
*
* @param item An unresolved test item for which children are being
* requested, or `undefined` to resolve the controller's initial {@link items}.
*/
resolveHandler?: (item: TestItem | undefined) => Thenable<void> | void;
/**
* Creates a {@link TestRun}. This should be called by the
* {@link TestRunProfile} when a request is made to execute tests, and may
* also be called if a test run is detected externally. Once created, tests
* that are included in the request will be moved into the queued state.
*
* All runs created using the same `request` instance will be grouped
* together. This is useful if, for example, a single suite of tests is
* run on multiple platforms.
*
* @param request Test run request. Only tests inside the `include` may be
* modified, and tests in its `exclude` are ignored.
* @param name The human-readable name of the run. This can be used to
* disambiguate multiple sets of results in a test run. It is useful if
* tests are run across multiple platforms, for example.
* @param persist Whether the results created by the run should be
* persisted in the editor. This may be false if the results are coming from
* a file already saved externally, such as a coverage information file.
* @returns An instance of the {@link TestRun}. It will be considered "running"
* from the moment this method is invoked until {@link TestRun.end} is called.
*/
createTestRun(request: TestRunRequest, name?: string, persist?: boolean): TestRun;
/**
* Creates a new managed {@link TestItem} instance. It can be added into
* the {@link TestItem.children} of an existing item, or into the
* {@link TestController.items}.
*
* @param id Identifier for the TestItem. The test item's ID must be unique
* in the {@link TestItemCollection} it's added to.
* @param label Human-readable label of the test item.
* @param uri URI this TestItem is associated with. May be a file or directory.
*/
createTestItem(id: string, label: string, uri?: Uri): TestItem;
/**
* Unregisters the test controller, disposing of its associated tests
* and unpersisted results.
*/
dispose(): void;
}
/**
* A TestRunRequest is a precursor to a {@link TestRun}, which in turn is
* created by passing a request to {@link tests.runTests}. The TestRunRequest
* contains information about which tests should be run, which should not be
* run, and how they are run (via the {@link profile}).
*
* In general, TestRunRequests are created by the editor and pass to
* {@link TestRunProfile.runHandler}, however you can also create test
* requests and runs outside of the `runHandler`.
*/
export class TestRunRequest {
/**
* A filter for specific tests to run. If given, the extension should run
* all of the included tests and all their children, excluding any tests
* that appear in {@link TestRunRequest.exclude}. If this property is
* undefined, then the extension should simply run all tests.
*
* The process of running tests should resolve the children of any test
* items who have not yet been resolved.
*/
readonly include: TestItem[] | undefined;
/**
* An array of tests the user has marked as excluded from the test included
* in this run; exclusions should apply after inclusions.
*
* May be omitted if no exclusions were requested. Test controllers should
* not run excluded tests or any children of excluded tests.
*/
readonly exclude: TestItem[] | undefined;
/**
* The profile used for this request. This will always be defined
* for requests issued from the editor UI, though extensions may
* programmatically create requests not associated with any profile.
*/
readonly profile: TestRunProfile | undefined;
/**
* @param tests Array of specific tests to run, or undefined to run all tests
* @param exclude An array of tests to exclude from the run.
* @param profile The run profile used for this request.
*/
constructor(include?: readonly TestItem[], exclude?: readonly TestItem[], profile?: TestRunProfile);
}
/**
* Options given to {@link TestController.runTests}
*/
export interface TestRun {
/**
* The human-readable name of the run. This can be used to
* disambiguate multiple sets of results in a test run. It is useful if
* tests are run across multiple platforms, for example.
*/
readonly name: string | undefined;
/**
* A cancellation token which will be triggered when the test run is
* canceled from the UI.
*/
readonly token: CancellationToken;
/**
* Whether the test run will be persisted across reloads by the editor.
*/
readonly isPersisted: boolean;
/**
* Indicates a test is queued for later execution.
* @param test Test item to update.
*/
enqueued(test: TestItem): void;
/**
* Indicates a test has started running.
* @param test Test item to update.
*/
started(test: TestItem): void;
/**
* Indicates a test has been skipped.
* @param test Test item to update.
*/
skipped(test: TestItem): void;
/**
* Indicates a test has failed. You should pass one or more
* {@link TestMessage TestMessages} to describe the failure.
* @param test Test item to update.
* @param messages Messages associated with the test failure.
* @param duration How long the test took to execute, in milliseconds.
*/
failed(test: TestItem, message: TestMessage | readonly TestMessage[], duration?: number): void;
/**
* Indicates a test has errored. You should pass one or more
* {@link TestMessage TestMessages} to describe the failure. This differs
* from the "failed" state in that it indicates a test that couldn't be
* executed at all, from a compilation error for example.
* @param test Test item to update.
* @param messages Messages associated with the test failure.
* @param duration How long the test took to execute, in milliseconds.
*/
errored(test: TestItem, message: TestMessage | readonly TestMessage[], duration?: number): void;
/**
* Indicates a test has passed.
* @param test Test item to update.
* @param duration How long the test took to execute, in milliseconds.
*/
passed(test: TestItem, duration?: number): void;
/**
* Appends raw output from the test runner. On the user's request, the
* output will be displayed in a terminal. ANSI escape sequences,
* such as colors and text styles, are supported.
*
* @param output Output text to append.
* @param location Indicate that the output was logged at the given
* location.
* @param test Test item to associate the output with.
*/
appendOutput(output: string, location?: Location, test?: TestItem): void;
/**
* Signals that the end of the test run. Any tests included in the run whose
* states have not been updated will have their state reset.
*/
end(): void;
}
/**
* Collection of test items, found in {@link TestItem.children} and
* {@link TestController.items}.
*/
export interface TestItemCollection {
/**
* Gets the number of items in the collection.
*/
readonly size: number;
/**
* Replaces the items stored by the collection.
* @param items Items to store.
*/
replace(items: readonly TestItem[]): void;
/**
* Iterate over each entry in this collection.
*
* @param callback Function to execute for each entry.
* @param thisArg The `this` context used when invoking the handler function.
*/
forEach(callback: (item: TestItem, collection: TestItemCollection) => unknown, thisArg?: unknown): void;
/**
* Adds the test item to the children. If an item with the same ID already
* exists, it'll be replaced.
* @param items Item to add.
*/
add(item: TestItem): void;
/**
* Removes a single test item from the collection.
* @param itemId Item ID to delete.
*/
delete(itemId: string): void;
/**
* Efficiently gets a test item by ID, if it exists, in the children.
* @param itemId Item ID to get.
* @returns The found item or undefined if it does not exist.
*/
get(itemId: string): TestItem | undefined;
}
/**
* An item shown in the "test explorer" view.
*
* A `TestItem` can represent either a test suite or a test itself, since
* they both have similar capabilities.
*/
export interface TestItem {
/**
* Identifier for the `TestItem`. This is used to correlate
* test results and tests in the document with those in the workspace
* (test explorer). This cannot change for the lifetime of the `TestItem`,
* and must be unique among its parent's direct children.
*/
readonly id: string;
/**
* URI this `TestItem` is associated with. May be a file or directory.
*/
readonly uri: Uri | undefined;
/**
* The children of this test item. For a test suite, this may contain the
* individual test cases or nested suites.
*/
readonly children: TestItemCollection;
/**
* The parent of this item. It's set automatically, and is undefined
* top-level items in the {@link TestController.items} and for items that
* aren't yet included in another item's {@link children}.
*/
readonly parent: TestItem | undefined;
/**
* Tags associated with this test item. May be used in combination with
* {@link TestRunProfile.tags}, or simply as an organizational feature.
*/
tags: readonly TestTag[];
/**
* Indicates whether this test item may have children discovered by resolving.
*
* If true, this item is shown as expandable in the Test Explorer view and
* expanding the item will cause {@link TestController.resolveHandler}
* to be invoked with the item.
*
* Default to `false`.
*/
canResolveChildren: boolean;
/**
* Controls whether the item is shown as "busy" in the Test Explorer view.
* This is useful for showing status while discovering children.
*
* Defaults to `false`.
*/
busy: boolean;
/**
* Display name describing the test case.
*/
label: string;
/**
* Optional description that appears next to the label.
*/
description?: string;
/**
* Location of the test item in its {@link uri}.
*
* This is only meaningful if the `uri` points to a file.
*/
range: Range | undefined;
/**
* Optional error encountered while loading the test.
*
* Note that this is not a test result and should only be used to represent errors in
* test discovery, such as syntax errors.
*/
error: string | MarkdownString | undefined;
}
/**
* Message associated with the test state. Can be linked to a specific
* source range -- useful for assertion failures, for example.
*/
export class TestMessage {
/**
* Human-readable message text to display.
*/
message: string | MarkdownString;
/**
* Expected test output. If given with {@link actualOutput}, a diff view will be shown.
*/
expectedOutput?: string;
/**
* Actual test output. If given with {@link expectedOutput}, a diff view will be shown.
*/
actualOutput?: string;
/**
* Associated file location.
*/
location?: Location;
/**
* Creates a new TestMessage that will present as a diff in the editor.
* @param message Message to display to the user.
* @param expected Expected output.
* @param actual Actual output.
*/
static diff(message: string | MarkdownString, expected: string, actual: string): TestMessage;
/**
* Creates a new TestMessage instance.
* @param message The message to show to the user.
*/
constructor(message: string | MarkdownString);
}
}
/**
* Thenable is a common denominator between ES6 promises, Q, jquery.Deferred, WinJS.Promise,
* and others. This API makes no assumption about what promise library is being used which
* enables reusing existing code without migrating to a specific promise implementation. Still,
* we recommend the use of native promises which are available in this editor.
*/
interface Thenable<T> {
/**
* Attaches callbacks for the resolution and/or rejection of the Promise.
* @param onfulfilled The callback to execute when the Promise is resolved.
* @param onrejected The callback to execute when the Promise is rejected.
* @returns A Promise for the completion of which ever callback is executed.
*/
then<TResult>(onfulfilled?: (value: T) => TResult | Thenable<TResult>, onrejected?: (reason: any) => TResult | Thenable<TResult>): Thenable<TResult>;
then<TResult>(onfulfilled?: (value: T) => TResult | Thenable<TResult>, onrejected?: (reason: any) => void): Thenable<TResult>;
}